Movatterモバイル変換


[0]ホーム

URL:


[RFC Home] [TEXT|PDF|HTML] [Tracker] [IPR] [Errata] [Info page]

Obsoleted by:7530 PROPOSED STANDARD
Errata Exist
Network Working Group                                         S. SheplerRequest for Comments: 3530                                  B. CallaghanObsoletes:3010                                              D. RobinsonCategory: Standards Track                                     R. Thurlow                                                  Sun Microsystems, Inc.                                                                C. Beame                                                        Hummingbird Ltd.                                                               M. Eisler                                                               D. Noveck                                                 Network Appliance, Inc.                                                              April 2003Network File System (NFS) version 4 ProtocolStatus of this Memo   This document specifies an Internet standards track protocol for the   Internet community, and requests discussion and suggestions for   improvements.  Please refer to the current edition of the "Internet   Official Protocol Standards" (STD 1) for the standardization state   and status of this protocol.  Distribution of this memo is unlimited.Copyright Notice   Copyright (C) The Internet Society (2003).  All Rights Reserved.Abstract   The Network File System (NFS) version 4 is a distributed filesystem   protocol which owes heritage to NFS protocol version 2,RFC 1094, and   version 3,RFC 1813.  Unlike earlier versions, the NFS version 4   protocol supports traditional file access while integrating support   for file locking and the mount protocol.  In addition, support for   strong security (and its negotiation), compound operations, client   caching, and internationalization have been added.  Of course,   attention has been applied to making NFS version 4 operate well in an   Internet environment.   This document replacesRFC 3010 as the definition of the NFS version   4 protocol.Key Words   The key words "MUST", "MUST NOT", "REQUIRED", "SHALL", "SHALL NOT",   "SHOULD", "SHOULD NOT", "RECOMMENDED", "MAY", and "OPTIONAL" in this   document are to be interpreted as described in [RFC2119].Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                     [Page 1]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003Table of Contents1.   Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81.1.  Changes sinceRFC 3010 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81.2.  NFS version 4 Goals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91.3.  Inconsistencies of this Document withSection 18 . .91.4.  Overview of NFS version 4 Features . . . . . . . . .101.4.1.  RPC and Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101.4.2.  Procedure and Operation Structure. . . . . .101.4.3.  Filesystem Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111.4.3.1.  Filehandle Types . . . . . . . . .111.4.3.2.  Attribute Types. . . . . . . . . .12                      1.4.3.3.  Filesystem Replication and                                Migration. . . . . . . . . . . . .131.4.4.  OPEN and CLOSE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131.4.5.  File locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131.4.6.  Client Caching and Delegation. . . . . . . .131.5.  General Definitions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142.   Protocol Data Types. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162.1.  Basic Data Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162.2.  Structured Data Types. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183.   RPC and Security Flavor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233.1.  Ports and Transports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233.1.1.  Client Retransmission Behavior . . . . . . .243.2.  Security Flavors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253.2.1.  Security mechanisms for NFS version 4. . . .25                      3.2.1.1.  Kerberos V5 as a security triple .   253.2.1.2.  LIPKEY as a security triple. . . .263.2.1.3.  SPKM-3 as a security triple. . . .273.3.  Security Negotiation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273.3.1.  SECINFO. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283.3.2.  Security Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283.4.  Callback RPC Authentication. . . . . . . . . . . . .284.  Filehandles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .304.1.  Obtaining the First Filehandle . . . . . . . . . . .304.1.1.  Root Filehandle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314.1.2.  Public Filehandle. . . . . . . . . . . . . .314.2.  Filehandle Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314.2.1.  General Properties of a Filehandle . . . . .324.2.2.  Persistent Filehandle. . . . . . . . . . . .324.2.3.  Volatile Filehandle. . . . . . . . . . . . .33              4.2.4.  One Method of Constructing a                      Volatile Filehandle. . . . . . . . . . . . .344.3.  Client Recovery from Filehandle Expiration . . . . .355.   File Attributes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .355.1.  Mandatory Attributes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .375.2.  Recommended Attributes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .375.3.  Named Attributes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                     [Page 2]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20035.4.  Classification of Attributes . . . . . . . . . . . .385.5.  Mandatory Attributes - Definitions . . . . . . . . .395.6.  Recommended Attributes - Definitions . . . . . . . .415.7.  Time Access. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .465.8.  Interpreting owner and owner_group . . . . . . . . .475.9.  Character Case Attributes. . . . . . . . . . . . . .495.10. Quota Attributes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .495.11. Access Control Lists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .505.11.1.  ACE type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .515.11.2.  ACE Access Mask. . . . . . . . . . . . . .525.11.3.  ACE flag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .545.11.4.  ACE who  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .555.11.5.  Mode Attribute . . . . . . . . . . . . . .565.11.6.  Mode and ACL Attribute . . . . . . . . . .575.11.7.  mounted_on_fileid. . . . . . . . . . . . .576.  Filesystem Migration and Replication  . . . . . . . . . . .586.1.  Replication. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .586.2.  Migration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .596.3.  Interpretation of the fs_locations Attribute . . . .606.4.  Filehandle Recovery for Migration or Replication . .617.  NFS Server Name Space . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .617.1.  Server Exports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .617.2.  Browsing Exports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .627.3.  Server Pseudo Filesystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . .627.4.  Multiple Roots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .637.5.  Filehandle Volatility. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .637.6.  Exported Root. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .637.7.  Mount Point Crossing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .637.8.  Security Policy and Name Space Presentation. . . . .648.   File Locking and Share Reservations. . . . . . . . . . . .658.1.  Locking. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .658.1.1.    Client ID. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .668.1.2.    Server Release of Clientid . . . . . . . .698.1.3.    lock_owner and stateid Definition. . . . .698.1.4.    Use of the stateid and Locking . . . . . .718.1.5.    Sequencing of Lock Requests. . . . . . . .738.1.6.    Recovery from Replayed Requests. . . . . .748.1.7.    Releasing lock_owner State . . . . . . . .748.1.8.    Use of Open Confirmation . . . . . . . . .758.2.  Lock Ranges. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .768.3.  Upgrading and Downgrading Locks. . . . . . . . . . .768.4.  Blocking Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .778.5.  Lease Renewal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .778.6.  Crash Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .788.6.1.   Client Failure and Recovery. . . . . . . .798.6.2.   Server Failure and Recovery. . . . . . . .798.6.3.   Network Partitions and Recovery. . . . . .818.7.   Recovery from a Lock Request Timeout or Abort . . .85Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                     [Page 3]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20038.8.   Server Revocation of Locks. . . . . . . . . . . . .858.9.   Share Reservations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .868.10.  OPEN/CLOSE Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87               8.10.1.  Close and Retention of State                        Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .888.11.  Open Upgrade and Downgrade. . . . . . . . . . . . .888.12.  Short and Long Leases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89        8.13.  Clocks, Propagation Delay, and Calculating Lease               Expiration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .898.14.  Migration, Replication and State. . . . . . . . . .908.14.1.  Migration and State. . . . . . . . . . . .908.14.2.  Replication and State. . . . . . . . . . .918.14.3.  Notification of Migrated Lease . . . . . .928.14.4.  Migration and the Lease_time Attribute . .929.  Client-Side Caching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .939.1.   Performance Challenges for Client-Side Caching. . .939.2.   Delegation and Callbacks. . . . . . . . . . . . . .949.2.1.  Delegation Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . .969.3.   Data Caching. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .989.3.1.   Data Caching and OPENs . . . . . . . . . .989.3.2.   Data Caching and File Locking. . . . . . .999.3.3.   Data Caching and Mandatory File Locking. .1019.3.4.   Data Caching and File Identity . . . . . .1019.4.   Open Delegation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1029.4.1.   Open Delegation and Data Caching . . . . .1049.4.2.   Open Delegation and File Locks . . . . . .1069.4.3.   Handling of CB_GETATTR . . . . . . . . . .1069.4.4.   Recall of Open Delegation. . . . . . . . .109               9.4.5.   Clients that Fail to Honor                        Delegation Recalls . . . . . . . . . . . .1119.4.6.   Delegation Revocation. . . . . . . . . . .1129.5.   Data Caching and Revocation . . . . . . . . . . . .112               9.5.1.   Revocation Recovery for Write Open                        Delegation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1139.6.   Attribute Caching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113        9.7.   Data and Metadata Caching and Memory Mapped Files .  1159.8.   Name Caching  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1189.9.   Directory Caching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11910.  Minor Versioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12011.  Internationalization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12211.1.  Stringprep profile for the utf8str_cs type. . . . .123               11.1.1.  Intended applicability of the                        nfs4_cs_prep profile . . . . . . . . . . .12311.1.2.  Character repertoire of nfs4_cs_prep . . .12411.1.3.  Mapping used by nfs4_cs_prep . . . . . . .12411.1.4.  Normalization used by nfs4_cs_prep . . . .12411.1.5.  Prohibited output for nfs4_cs_prep . . . .12511.1.6.  Bidirectional output for nfs4_cs_prep. . .125Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                     [Page 4]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 200311.2.  Stringprep profile for the utf8str_cis type . . . .125               11.2.1.  Intended applicability of the                        nfs4_cis_prep profile. . . . . . . . . . .12511.2.2.  Character repertoire of nfs4_cis_prep  . .12511.2.3.  Mapping used by nfs4_cis_prep  . . . . . .12511.2.4.  Normalization used by nfs4_cis_prep  . . .12511.2.5.  Prohibited output for nfs4_cis_prep  . . .12611.2.6.  Bidirectional output for nfs4_cis_prep . .12611.3.  Stringprep profile for the utf8str_mixed type . . .126               11.3.1.  Intended applicability of the                        nfs4_mixed_prep profile. . . . . . . . . .126               11.3.2.  Character repertoire of nfs4_mixed_prep  .  12611.3.3.  Mapping used by nfs4_cis_prep  . . . . . .12611.3.4.  Normalization used by nfs4_mixed_prep  . .12711.3.5.  Prohibited output for nfs4_mixed_prep  . .127               11.3.6.  Bidirectional output for nfs4_mixed_prep .  12711.4.  UTF-8 Related Errors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12712.  Error Definitions  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12813.  NFS version 4 Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13413.1.  Compound Procedure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13413.2.  Evaluation of a Compound Request. . . . . . . . . .13513.3.  Synchronous Modifying Operations. . . . . . . . . .13613.4.  Operation Values. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13614.  NFS version 4 Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13614.1.  Procedure 0: NULL - No Operation. . . . . . . . . .13614.2.  Procedure 1: COMPOUND - Compound Operations . . . .137               14.2.1.   Operation 3: ACCESS - Check Access                         Rights. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14014.2.2.   Operation 4: CLOSE - Close File . . . . .142               14.2.3.   Operation 5: COMMIT - Commit                         Cached Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144               14.2.4.   Operation 6: CREATE - Create a                         Non-Regular File Object . . . . . . . . .147               14.2.5.   Operation 7: DELEGPURGE -                         Purge Delegations Awaiting Recovery . . .150               14.2.6.   Operation 8: DELEGRETURN - Return                         Delegation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15114.2.7.   Operation 9: GETATTR - Get Attributes . .152               14.2.8.   Operation 10: GETFH - Get Current                         Filehandle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153               14.2.9.   Operation 11: LINK - Create Link to a                         File. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15414.2.10.  Operation 12: LOCK - Create Lock  . . . .15614.2.11.  Operation 13: LOCKT - Test For Lock . . .16014.2.12.  Operation 14: LOCKU - Unlock File . . . .16214.2.13.  Operation 15: LOOKUP - Lookup Filename. .163               14.2.14.  Operation 16: LOOKUPP - Lookup                         Parent Directory. . . . . . . . . . . . .165Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                     [Page 5]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003               14.2.15.  Operation 17: NVERIFY - Verify                         Difference in Attributes  . . . . . . . .166               14.2.16.  Operation 18: OPEN - Open a Regular                         File. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168               14.2.17.  Operation 19: OPENATTR - Open Named                         Attribute Directory . . . . . . . . . . .178               14.2.18.  Operation 20: OPEN_CONFIRM -                         Confirm Open . . . . . . . . . . . . . .180               14.2.19.  Operation 21: OPEN_DOWNGRADE -                         Reduce Open File Access . . . . . . . . .182               14.2.20.  Operation 22: PUTFH - Set                         Current Filehandle. . . . . . . . . . . .184               14.2.21.  Operation 23: PUTPUBFH -                         Set Public Filehandle . . . . . . . . . .185               14.2.22.  Operation 24: PUTROOTFH -                         Set Root Filehandle . . . . . . . . . . .18614.2.23.  Operation 25: READ - Read from File . . .187               14.2.24.  Operation 26: READDIR -                         Read Directory. . . . . . . . . . . . . .190               14.2.25.  Operation 27: READLINK -                         Read Symbolic Link. . . . . . . . . . . .193               14.2.26.  Operation 28: REMOVE -                         Remove Filesystem Object. . . . . . . . .195               14.2.27.  Operation 29: RENAME -                         Rename Directory Entry. . . . . . . . . .19714.2.28.  Operation 30: RENEW - Renew a Lease . . .200               14.2.29.  Operation 31: RESTOREFH -                         Restore Saved Filehandle. . . . . . . . .201               14.2.30.  Operation 32: SAVEFH - Save                         Current Filehandle. . . . . . . . . . . .202               14.2.31.  Operation 33: SECINFO - Obtain                         Available Security. . . . . . . . . . . .20314.2.32.  Operation 34: SETATTR - Set Attributes. .206               14.2.33.  Operation 35: SETCLIENTID -                         Negotiate Clientid. . . . . . . . . . . .209               14.2.34.  Operation 36: SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM -                         Confirm Clientid. . . . . . . . . . . . .213               14.2.35.  Operation 37: VERIFY -                         Verify Same Attributes. . . . . . . . . .21714.2.36.  Operation 38: WRITE - Write to File . . .218               14.2.37.  Operation 39: RELEASE_LOCKOWNER -                         Release Lockowner State . . . . . . . . .223               14.2.38.  Operation 10044: ILLEGAL -                         Illegal operation . . . . . . . . . . . .22415.  NFS version 4 Callback Procedures  . . . . . . . . . . . .22515.1.  Procedure 0: CB_NULL - No Operation . . . . . . . .225        15.2.  Procedure 1: CB_COMPOUND - Compound               Operations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                     [Page 6]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003               15.2.1.  Operation 3: CB_GETATTR - Get                        Attributes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228               15.2.2.  Operation 4: CB_RECALL -                        Recall an Open Delegation. . . . . . . . .229               15.2.3.  Operation 10044: CB_ILLEGAL -                        Illegal Callback Operation . . . . . . . .23016.  Security Considerations  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23117.  IANA Considerations  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23217.1.  Named Attribute Definition. . . . . . . . . . . . .23217.2.  ONC RPC Network Identifiers (netids). . . . . . . .23218.  RPC definition file  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23419.  Acknowledgements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26820.  Normative References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26821.  Informative References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27022.  Authors' Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27322.1.  Editor's Address. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27322.2.  Authors' Addresses. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27423.  Full Copyright Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                     [Page 7]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20031.  Introduction1.1.  Changes sinceRFC 3010   This definition of the NFS version 4 protocol replaces or obsoletes   the definition present in [RFC3010].  While portions of the two   documents have remained the same, there have been substantive changes   in others.  The changes made between [RFC3010] and this document   represent implementation experience and further review of the   protocol.  While some modifications were made for ease of   implementation or clarification, most updates represent errors or   situations where the [RFC3010] definition were untenable.   The following list is not all inclusive of all changes but presents   some of the most notable changes or additions made:   o  The state model has added an open_owner4 identifier.  This was      done to accommodate Posix based clients and the model they use for      file locking.  For Posix clients, an open_owner4 would correspond      to a file descriptor potentially shared amongst a set of processes      and the lock_owner4 identifier would correspond to a process that      is locking a file.   o  Clarifications and error conditions were added for the handling of      the owner and group attributes.  Since these attributes are string      based (as opposed to the numeric uid/gid of previous versions of      NFS), translations may not be available and hence the changes      made.   o  Clarifications for the ACL and mode attributes to address      evaluation and partial support.   o  For identifiers that are defined as XDR opaque, limits were set on      their size.   o  Added the mounted_on_filed attribute to allow Posix clients to      correctly construct local mounts.   o  Modified the SETCLIENTID/SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM operations to deal      correctly with confirmation details along with adding the ability      to specify new client callback information.  Also added      clarification of the callback information itself.   o  Added a new operation LOCKOWNER_RELEASE to enable notifying the      server that a lock_owner4 will no longer be used by the client.   o  RENEW operation changes to identify the client correctly and allow      for additional error returns.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                     [Page 8]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   o  Verify error return possibilities for all operations.   o  Remove use of the pathname4 data type from LOOKUP and OPEN in      favor of having the client construct a sequence of LOOKUP      operations to achieive the same effect.   o  Clarification of the internationalization issues and adoption of      the new stringprep profile framework.1.2.  NFS Version 4 Goals   The NFS version 4 protocol is a further revision of the NFS protocol   defined already by versions 2 [RFC1094] and 3 [RFC1813].  It retains   the essential characteristics of previous versions: design for easy   recovery, independent of transport protocols, operating systems and   filesystems, simplicity, and good performance.  The NFS version 4   revision has the following goals:   o  Improved access and good performance on the Internet.      The protocol is designed to transit firewalls easily, perform well      where latency is high and bandwidth is low, and scale to very      large numbers of clients per server.   o  Strong security with negotiation built into the protocol.      The protocol builds on the work of the ONCRPC working group in      supporting the RPCSEC_GSS protocol.  Additionally, the NFS version      4 protocol provides a mechanism to allow clients and servers the      ability to negotiate security and require clients and servers to      support a minimal set of security schemes.   o  Good cross-platform interoperability.      The protocol features a filesystem model that provides a useful,      common set of features that does not unduly favor one filesystem      or operating system over another.   o  Designed for protocol extensions.      The protocol is designed to accept standard extensions that do not      compromise backward compatibility.1.3.  Inconsistencies of this Document withSection 18Section 18, RPC Definition File, contains the definitions in XDR   description language of the constructs used by the protocol.  Prior   toSection 18, several of the constructs are reproduced for purposesShepler, et al.             Standards Track                     [Page 9]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   of explanation.  The reader is warned of the possibility of errors in   the reproduced constructs outside ofSection 18.  For any part of the   document that is inconsistent withSection 18,Section 18 is to be   considered authoritative.1.4.  Overview of NFS version 4 Features   To provide a reasonable context for the reader, the major features of   NFS version 4 protocol will be reviewed in brief.  This will be done   to provide an appropriate context for both the reader who is familiar   with the previous versions of the NFS protocol and the reader that is   new to the NFS protocols.  For the reader new to the NFS protocols,   there is still a fundamental knowledge that is expected.  The reader   should be familiar with the XDR and RPC protocols as described in   [RFC1831] and [RFC1832].  A basic knowledge of filesystems and   distributed filesystems is expected as well.1.4.1.  RPC and Security   As with previous versions of NFS, the External Data Representation   (XDR) and Remote Procedure Call (RPC) mechanisms used for the NFS   version 4 protocol are those defined in [RFC1831] and [RFC1832].  To   meet end to end security requirements, the RPCSEC_GSS framework   [RFC2203] will be used to extend the basic RPC security.  With the   use of RPCSEC_GSS, various mechanisms can be provided to offer   authentication, integrity, and privacy to the NFS version 4 protocol.   Kerberos V5 will be used as described in [RFC1964] to provide one   security framework.  The LIPKEY GSS-API mechanism described in   [RFC2847] will be used to provide for the use of user password and   server public key by the NFS version 4 protocol.  With the use of   RPCSEC_GSS, other mechanisms may also be specified and used for NFS   version 4 security.   To enable in-band security negotiation, the NFS version 4 protocol   has added a new operation which provides the client a method of   querying the server about its policies regarding which security   mechanisms must be used for access to the server's filesystem   resources.  With this, the client can securely match the security   mechanism that meets the policies specified at both the client and   server.1.4.2.  Procedure and Operation Structure   A significant departure from the previous versions of the NFS   protocol is the introduction of the COMPOUND procedure.  For the NFS   version 4 protocol, there are two RPC procedures, NULL and COMPOUND.   The COMPOUND procedure is defined in terms of operations and these   operations correspond more closely to the traditional NFS procedures.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 10]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   With the use of the COMPOUND procedure, the client is able to build   simple or complex requests.  These COMPOUND requests allow for a   reduction in the number of RPCs needed for logical filesystem   operations.  For example, without previous contact with a server a   client will be able to read data from a file in one request by   combining LOOKUP, OPEN, and READ operations in a single COMPOUND RPC.   With previous versions of the NFS protocol, this type of single   request was not possible.   The model used for COMPOUND is very simple.  There is no logical OR   or ANDing of operations.  The operations combined within a COMPOUND   request are evaluated in order by the server.  Once an operation   returns a failing result, the evaluation ends and the results of all   evaluated operations are returned to the client.   The NFS version 4 protocol continues to have the client refer to a   file or directory at the server by a "filehandle".  The COMPOUND   procedure has a method of passing a filehandle from one operation to   another within the sequence of operations.  There is a concept of a   "current filehandle" and "saved filehandle".  Most operations use the   "current filehandle" as the filesystem object to operate upon.  The   "saved filehandle" is used as temporary filehandle storage within a   COMPOUND procedure as well as an additional operand for certain   operations.1.4.3.  Filesystem Model   The general filesystem model used for the NFS version 4 protocol is   the same as previous versions.  The server filesystem is hierarchical   with the regular files contained within being treated as opaque byte   streams.  In a slight departure, file and directory names are encoded   with UTF-8 to deal with the basics of internationalization.   The NFS version 4 protocol does not require a separate protocol to   provide for the initial mapping between path name and filehandle.   Instead of using the older MOUNT protocol for this mapping, the   server provides a ROOT filehandle that represents the logical root or   top of the filesystem tree provided by the server.  The server   provides multiple filesystems by gluing them together with pseudo   filesystems.  These pseudo filesystems provide for potential gaps in   the path names between real filesystems.1.4.3.1.  Filehandle Types   In previous versions of the NFS protocol, the filehandle provided by   the server was guaranteed to be valid or persistent for the lifetime   of the filesystem object to which it referred.  For some server   implementations, this persistence requirement has been difficult toShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 11]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   meet.  For the NFS version 4 protocol, this requirement has been   relaxed by introducing another type of filehandle, volatile.  With   persistent and volatile filehandle types, the server implementation   can match the abilities of the filesystem at the server along with   the operating environment.  The client will have knowledge of the   type of filehandle being provided by the server and can be prepared   to deal with the semantics of each.1.4.3.2.  Attribute Types   The NFS version 4 protocol introduces three classes of filesystem or   file attributes.  Like the additional filehandle type, the   classification of file attributes has been done to ease server   implementations along with extending the overall functionality of the   NFS protocol.  This attribute model is structured to be extensible   such that new attributes can be introduced in minor revisions of the   protocol without requiring significant rework.   The three classifications are: mandatory, recommended and named   attributes.  This is a significant departure from the previous   attribute model used in the NFS protocol.  Previously, the attributes   for the filesystem and file objects were a fixed set of mainly UNIX   attributes.  If the server or client did not support a particular   attribute, it would have to simulate the attribute the best it could.   Mandatory attributes are the minimal set of file or filesystem   attributes that must be provided by the server and must be properly   represented by the server.  Recommended attributes represent   different filesystem types and operating environments.  The   recommended attributes will allow for better interoperability and the   inclusion of more operating environments.  The mandatory and   recommended attribute sets are traditional file or filesystem   attributes.  The third type of attribute is the named attribute.  A   named attribute is an opaque byte stream that is associated with a   directory or file and referred to by a string name.  Named attributes   are meant to be used by client applications as a method to associate   application specific data with a regular file or directory.   One significant addition to the recommended set of file attributes is   the Access Control List (ACL) attribute.  This attribute provides for   directory and file access control beyond the model used in previous   versions of the NFS protocol.  The ACL definition allows for   specification of user and group level access control.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 12]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20031.4.3.3.  Filesystem Replication and Migration   With the use of a special file attribute, the ability to migrate or   replicate server filesystems is enabled within the protocol.  The   filesystem locations attribute provides a method for the client to   probe the server about the location of a filesystem.  In the event of   a migration of a filesystem, the client will receive an error when   operating on the filesystem and it can then query as to the new file   system location.  Similar steps are used for replication, the client   is able to query the server for the multiple available locations of a   particular filesystem.  From this information, the client can use its   own policies to access the appropriate filesystem location.1.4.4.  OPEN and CLOSE   The NFS version 4 protocol introduces OPEN and CLOSE operations.  The   OPEN operation provides a single point where file lookup, creation,   and share semantics can be combined.  The CLOSE operation also   provides for the release of state accumulated by OPEN.1.4.5.  File locking   With the NFS version 4 protocol, the support for byte range file   locking is part of the NFS protocol.  The file locking support is   structured so that an RPC callback mechanism is not required.  This   is a departure from the previous versions of the NFS file locking   protocol, Network Lock Manager (NLM).  The state associated with file   locks is maintained at the server under a lease-based model.  The   server defines a single lease period for all state held by a NFS   client.  If the client does not renew its lease within the defined   period, all state associated with the client's lease may be released   by the server.  The client may renew its lease with use of the RENEW   operation or implicitly by use of other operations (primarily READ).1.4.6.  Client Caching and Delegation   The file, attribute, and directory caching for the NFS version 4   protocol is similar to previous versions.  Attributes and directory   information are cached for a duration determined by the client.  At   the end of a predefined timeout, the client will query the server to   see if the related filesystem object has been updated.   For file data, the client checks its cache validity when the file is   opened.  A query is sent to the server to determine if the file has   been changed.  Based on this information, the client determines if   the data cache for the file should kept or released.  Also, when the   file is closed, any modified data is written to the server.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 13]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   If an application wants to serialize access to file data, file   locking of the file data ranges in question should be used.   The major addition to NFS version 4 in the area of caching is the   ability of the server to delegate certain responsibilities to the   client.  When the server grants a delegation for a file to a client,   the client is guaranteed certain semantics with respect to the   sharing of that file with other clients.  At OPEN, the server may   provide the client either a read or write delegation for the file.   If the client is granted a read delegation, it is assured that no   other client has the ability to write to the file for the duration of   the delegation.  If the client is granted a write delegation, the   client is assured that no other client has read or write access to   the file.   Delegations can be recalled by the server.  If another client   requests access to the file in such a way that the access conflicts   with the granted delegation, the server is able to notify the initial   client and recall the delegation.  This requires that a callback path   exist between the server and client.  If this callback path does not   exist, then delegations can not be granted.  The essence of a   delegation is that it allows the client to locally service operations   such as OPEN, CLOSE, LOCK, LOCKU, READ, WRITE without immediate   interaction with the server.1.5.  General Definitions   The following definitions are provided for the purpose of providing   an appropriate context for the reader.   Client    The "client" is the entity that accesses the NFS server's             resources.  The client may be an application which contains             the logic to access the NFS server directly.  The client             may also be the traditional operating system client remote             filesystem services for a set of applications.             In the case of file locking the client is the entity that             maintains a set of locks on behalf of one or more             applications.  This client is responsible for crash or             failure recovery for those locks it manages.             Note that multiple clients may share the same transport and             multiple clients may exist on the same network node.   Clientid  A 64-bit quantity used as a unique, short-hand reference to             a client supplied Verifier and ID.  The server is             responsible for supplying the Clientid.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 14]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   Lease     An interval of time defined by the server for which the             client is irrevocably granted a lock.  At the end of a             lease period the lock may be revoked if the lease has not             been extended.  The lock must be revoked if a conflicting             lock has been granted after the lease interval.             All leases granted by a server have the same fixed             interval.  Note that the fixed interval was chosen to             alleviate the expense a server would have in maintaining             state about variable length leases across server failures.   Lock      The term "lock" is used to refer to both record (byte-             range) locks as well as share reservations unless             specifically stated otherwise.   Server    The "Server" is the entity responsible for coordinating             client access to a set of filesystems.   Stable Storage             NFS version 4 servers must be able to recover without data             loss from multiple power failures (including cascading             power failures, that is, several power failures in quick             succession), operating system failures, and hardware             failure of components other than the storage medium itself             (for example, disk, nonvolatile RAM).             Some examples of stable storage that are allowable for an             NFS server include:             1. Media commit of data, that is, the modified data has                been successfully written to the disk media, for                example, the disk platter.             2. An immediate reply disk drive with battery-backed on-                drive intermediate storage or uninterruptible power                system (UPS).             3. Server commit of data with battery-backed intermediate                storage and recovery software.             4. Cache commit with uninterruptible power system (UPS) and                recovery software.   Stateid   A 128-bit quantity returned by a server that uniquely             defines the open and locking state provided by the server             for a specific open or lock owner for a specific file.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 15]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003             Stateids composed of all bits 0 or all bits 1 have special             meaning and are reserved values.   Verifier  A 64-bit quantity generated by the client that the server             can use to determine if the client has restarted and lost             all previous lock state.2.  Protocol Data Types   The syntax and semantics to describe the data types of the NFS   version 4 protocol are defined in the XDR [RFC1832] and RPC [RFC1831]   documents.  The next sections build upon the XDR data types to define   types and structures specific to this protocol.2.1.  Basic Data Types   Data Type       Definition   ____________________________________________________________________   int32_t         typedef int             int32_t;   uint32_t        typedef unsigned int    uint32_t;   int64_t         typedef hyper           int64_t;   uint64_t        typedef unsigned hyper  uint64_t;   attrlist4       typedef opaque        attrlist4<>;                   Used for file/directory attributes   bitmap4         typedef uint32_t        bitmap4<>;                   Used in attribute array encoding.   changeid4       typedef       uint64_t        changeid4;                   Used in definition of change_info   clientid4       typedef uint64_t        clientid4;                   Shorthand reference to client identification   component4      typedef utf8str_cs      component4;                   Represents path name components   count4          typedef uint32_t        count4;                   Various count parameters (READ, WRITE, COMMIT)   length4         typedef uint64_t        length4;                   Describes LOCK lengthsShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 16]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   linktext4       typedef utf8str_cs      linktext4;                   Symbolic link contents   mode4           typedef uint32_t        mode4;                   Mode attribute data type   nfs_cookie4     typedef uint64_t        nfs_cookie4;                   Opaque cookie value for READDIR   nfs_fh4         typedef opaque          nfs_fh4<NFS4_FHSIZE>;                   Filehandle definition; NFS4_FHSIZE is defined as 128   nfs_ftype4      enum nfs_ftype4;                   Various defined file types   nfsstat4        enum nfsstat4;                   Return value for operations   offset4         typedef uint64_t        offset4;                   Various offset designations (READ, WRITE,                   LOCK, COMMIT)   pathname4       typedef component4      pathname4<>;                   Represents path name for LOOKUP, OPEN and others   qop4            typedef uint32_t        qop4;                   Quality of protection designation in SECINFO   sec_oid4        typedef opaque          sec_oid4<>;                   Security Object Identifier                   The sec_oid4 data type is not really opaque.                   Instead contains an ASN.1 OBJECT IDENTIFIER as used                   by GSS-API in the mech_type argument to                   GSS_Init_sec_context.  See [RFC2743] for details.   seqid4          typedef uint32_t        seqid4;                   Sequence identifier used for file locking   utf8string      typedef opaque          utf8string<>;                   UTF-8 encoding for strings   utf8str_cis     typedef opaque          utf8str_cis;                   Case-insensitive UTF-8 string   utf8str_cs      typedef opaque          utf8str_cs;                   Case-sensitive UTF-8 stringShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 17]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   utf8str_mixed   typedef opaque          utf8str_mixed;                   UTF-8 strings with a case sensitive prefix and                   a case insensitive suffix.   verifier4       typedef opaque        verifier4[NFS4_VERIFIER_SIZE];                   Verifier used for various operations (COMMIT,                   CREATE, OPEN, READDIR, SETCLIENTID,                   SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM, WRITE) NFS4_VERIFIER_SIZE is                   defined as 8.2.2.  Structured Data Types   nfstime4                  struct nfstime4 {                          int64_t seconds;                          uint32_t nseconds;                  }   The nfstime4 structure gives the number of seconds and nanoseconds   since midnight or 0 hour January 1, 1970 Coordinated Universal Time   (UTC).  Values greater than zero for the seconds field denote dates   after the 0 hour January 1, 1970.  Values less than zero for the   seconds field denote dates before the 0 hour January 1, 1970.  In   both cases, the nseconds field is to be added to the seconds field   for the final time representation.  For example, if the time to be   represented is one-half second before 0 hour January 1, 1970, the   seconds field would have a value of negative one (-1) and the   nseconds fields would have a value of one-half second (500000000).   Values greater than 999,999,999 for nseconds are considered invalid.   This data type is used to pass time and date information.  A server   converts to and from its local representation of time when processing   time values, preserving as much accuracy as possible.  If the   precision of timestamps stored for a filesystem object is less than   defined, loss of precision can occur.  An adjunct time maintenance   protocol is recommended to reduce client and server time skew.   time_how4                  enum time_how4 {                          SET_TO_SERVER_TIME4 = 0,                          SET_TO_CLIENT_TIME4 = 1                  };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 18]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   settime4                  union settime4 switch (time_how4 set_it) {                   case SET_TO_CLIENT_TIME4:                           nfstime4       time;                   default:                           void;                  };   The above definitions are used as the attribute definitions to set   time values.  If set_it is SET_TO_SERVER_TIME4, then the server uses   its local representation of time for the time value.   specdata4                  struct specdata4 {                          uint32_t specdata1; /* major device number */                          uint32_t specdata2; /* minor device number */                  };   This data type represents additional information for the device file   types NF4CHR and NF4BLK.   fsid4                  struct fsid4 {                    uint64_t        major;                    uint64_t        minor;                  };   This type is the filesystem identifier that is used as a mandatory   attribute.   fs_location4                  struct fs_location4 {                          utf8str_cis    server<>;                          pathname4     rootpath;                  };   fs_locations4                  struct fs_locations4 {                          pathname4     fs_root;                          fs_location4  locations<>;                  };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 19]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   The fs_location4 and fs_locations4 data types are used for the   fs_locations recommended attribute which is used for migration and   replication support.   fattr4                  struct fattr4 {                          bitmap4       attrmask;                          attrlist4     attr_vals;                  };   The fattr4 structure is used to represent file and directory   attributes.   The bitmap is a counted array of 32 bit integers used to contain bit   values.  The position of the integer in the array that contains bit n   can be computed from the expression (n / 32) and its bit within that   integer is (n mod 32).                           0            1         +-----------+-----------+-----------+--         |  count    | 31  ..  0 | 63  .. 32 |         +-----------+-----------+-----------+--   change_info4                  struct change_info4 {                          bool          atomic;                          changeid4     before;                          changeid4     after;                  };   This structure is used with the CREATE, LINK, REMOVE, RENAME   operations to let the client know the value of the change attribute   for the directory in which the target filesystem object resides.   clientaddr4                  struct clientaddr4 {                          /* see struct rpcb inRFC 1833 */                          string r_netid<>;    /* network id */                          string r_addr<>;     /* universal address */                  };   The clientaddr4 structure is used as part of the SETCLIENTID   operation to either specify the address of the client that is using a   clientid or as part of the callback registration.  TheShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 20]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   r_netid and r_addr fields are specified in [RFC1833], but they are   underspecified in [RFC1833] as far as what they should look like for   specific protocols.   For TCP over IPv4 and for UDP over IPv4, the format of r_addr is the   US-ASCII string:      h1.h2.h3.h4.p1.p2   The prefix, "h1.h2.h3.h4", is the standard textual form for   representing an IPv4 address, which is always four octets long.   Assuming big-endian ordering, h1, h2, h3, and h4, are respectively,   the first through fourth octets each converted to ASCII-decimal.   Assuming big-endian ordering, p1 and p2 are, respectively, the first   and second octets each converted to ASCII-decimal.  For example, if a   host, in big-endian order, has an address of 0x0A010307 and there is   a service listening on, in big endian order, port 0x020F (decimal   527), then the complete universal address is "10.1.3.7.2.15".   For TCP over IPv4 the value of r_netid is the string "tcp".  For UDP   over IPv4 the value of r_netid is the string "udp".   For TCP over IPv6 and for UDP over IPv6, the format of r_addr is the   US-ASCII string:         x1:x2:x3:x4:x5:x6:x7:x8.p1.p2   The suffix "p1.p2" is the service port, and is computed the same way   as with universal addresses for TCP and UDP over IPv4.  The prefix,   "x1:x2:x3:x4:x5:x6:x7:x8", is the standard textual form for   representing an IPv6 address as defined inSection 2.2 of [RFC2373].   Additionally, the two alternative forms specified inSection 2.2 of   [RFC2373] are also acceptable.   For TCP over IPv6 the value of r_netid is the string "tcp6".  For UDP   over IPv6 the value of r_netid is the string "udp6".   cb_client4                  struct cb_client4 {                          unsigned int  cb_program;                          clientaddr4   cb_location;                  };   This structure is used by the client to inform the server of its call   back address; includes the program number and client address.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 21]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   nfs_client_id4                  struct nfs_client_id4 {                          verifier4     verifier;                          opaque        id<NFS4_OPAQUE_LIMIT>;                  };   This structure is part of the arguments to the SETCLIENTID operation.   NFS4_OPAQUE_LIMIT is defined as 1024.   open_owner4                  struct open_owner4 {                          clientid4     clientid;                          opaque        owner<NFS4_OPAQUE_LIMIT>;                  };   This structure is used to identify the owner of open state.   NFS4_OPAQUE_LIMIT is defined as 1024.   lock_owner4                  struct lock_owner4 {                          clientid4     clientid;                          opaque        owner<NFS4_OPAQUE_LIMIT>;                  };   This structure is used to identify the owner of file locking state.   NFS4_OPAQUE_LIMIT is defined as 1024.   open_to_lock_owner4                  struct open_to_lock_owner4 {                          seqid4          open_seqid;                          stateid4        open_stateid;                          seqid4          lock_seqid;                          lock_owner4     lock_owner;                  };   This structure is used for the first LOCK operation done for an   open_owner4.  It provides both the open_stateid and lock_owner such   that the transition is made from a valid open_stateid sequence to   that of the new lock_stateid sequence.  Using this mechanism avoids   the confirmation of the lock_owner/lock_seqid pair since it is tied   to established state in the form of the open_stateid/open_seqid.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 22]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   stateid4                  struct stateid4 {                    uint32_t        seqid;                    opaque          other[12];                  };   This structure is used for the various state sharing mechanisms   between the client and server.  For the client, this data structure   is read-only.  The starting value of the seqid field is undefined.   The server is required to increment the seqid field monotonically at   each transition of the stateid.  This is important since the client   will inspect the seqid in OPEN stateids to determine the order of   OPEN processing done by the server.3.  RPC and Security Flavor   The NFS version 4 protocol is a Remote Procedure Call (RPC)   application that uses RPC version 2 and the corresponding eXternal   Data Representation (XDR) as defined in [RFC1831] and [RFC1832].  The   RPCSEC_GSS security flavor as defined in [RFC2203] MUST be used as   the mechanism to deliver stronger security for the NFS version 4   protocol.3.1.  Ports and Transports   Historically, NFS version 2 and version 3 servers have resided on   port 2049.  The registered port 2049 [RFC3232] for the NFS protocol   should be the default configuration.  Using the registered port for   NFS services means the NFS client will not need to use the RPC   binding protocols as described in [RFC1833]; this will allow NFS to   transit firewalls.   Where an NFS version 4 implementation supports operation over the IP   network protocol, the supported transports between NFS and IP MUST be   among the IETF-approved congestion control transport protocols, which   include TCP and SCTP.  To enhance the possibilities for   interoperability, an NFS version 4 implementation MUST support   operation over the TCP transport protocol, at least until such time   as a standards track RFC revises this requirement to use a different   IETF-approved congestion control transport protocol.   If TCP is used as the transport, the client and server SHOULD use   persistent connections.  This will prevent the weakening of TCP's   congestion control via short lived connections and will improve   performance for the WAN environment by eliminating the need for SYN   handshakes.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 23]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   As noted in the Security Considerations section, the authentication   model for NFS version 4 has moved from machine-based to principal-   based.  However, this modification of the authentication model does   not imply a technical requirement to move the TCP connection   management model from whole machine-based to one based on a per user   model.  In particular, NFS over TCP client implementations have   traditionally multiplexed traffic for multiple users over a common   TCP connection between an NFS client and server.  This has been true,   regardless whether the NFS client is using AUTH_SYS, AUTH_DH,   RPCSEC_GSS or any other flavor.  Similarly, NFS over TCP server   implementations have assumed such a model and thus scale the   implementation of TCP connection management in proportion to the   number of expected client machines.  It is intended that NFS version   4 will not modify this connection management model.  NFS version 4   clients that violate this assumption can expect scaling issues on the   server and hence reduced service.   Note that for various timers, the client and server should avoid   inadvertent synchronization of those timers.  For further discussion   of the general issue refer to [Floyd].3.1.1.  Client Retransmission Behavior   When processing a request received over a reliable transport such as   TCP, the NFS version 4 server MUST NOT silently drop the request,   except if the transport connection has been broken.  Given such a   contract between NFS version 4 clients and servers, clients MUST NOT   retry a request unless one or both of the following are true:   o  The transport connection has been broken   o  The procedure being retried is the NULL procedure   Since reliable transports, such as TCP, do not always synchronously   inform a peer when the other peer has broken the connection (for   example, when an NFS server reboots), the NFS version 4 client may   want to actively "probe" the connection to see if has been broken.   Use of the NULL procedure is one recommended way to do so.  So, when   a client experiences a remote procedure call timeout (of some   arbitrary implementation specific amount), rather than retrying the   remote procedure call, it could instead issue a NULL procedure call   to the server.  If the server has died, the transport connection   break will eventually be indicated to the NFS version 4 client.  The   client can then reconnect, and then retry the original request.  If   the NULL procedure call gets a response, the connection has not   broken.  The client can decide to wait longer for the original   request's response, or it can break the transport connection and   reconnect before re-sending the original request.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 24]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   For callbacks from the server to the client, the same rules apply,   but the server doing the callback becomes the client, and the client   receiving the callback becomes the server.3.2.  Security Flavors   Traditional RPC implementations have included AUTH_NONE, AUTH_SYS,   AUTH_DH, and AUTH_KRB4 as security flavors.  With [RFC2203] an   additional security flavor of RPCSEC_GSS has been introduced which   uses the functionality of GSS-API [RFC2743].  This allows for the use   of various security mechanisms by the RPC layer without the   additional implementation overhead of adding RPC security flavors.   For NFS version 4, the RPCSEC_GSS security flavor MUST be used to   enable the mandatory security mechanism.  Other flavors, such as,   AUTH_NONE, AUTH_SYS, and AUTH_DH MAY be implemented as well.3.2.1.  Security mechanisms for NFS version 4   The use of RPCSEC_GSS requires selection of: mechanism, quality of   protection, and service (authentication, integrity, privacy).  The   remainder of this document will refer to these three parameters of   the RPCSEC_GSS security as the security triple.3.2.1.1.  Kerberos V5 as a security triple   The Kerberos V5 GSS-API mechanism as described in [RFC1964] MUST be   implemented and provide the following security triples.   column descriptions:   1 == number of pseudo flavor   2 == name of pseudo flavor   3 == mechanism's OID   4 == mechanism's algorithm(s)   5 == RPCSEC_GSS service   1      2     3                    4             5   --------------------------------------------------------------------   390003 krb5  1.2.840.113554.1.2.2 DES MAC MD5   rpc_gss_svc_none   390004 krb5i 1.2.840.113554.1.2.2 DES MAC MD5   rpc_gss_svc_integrity   390005 krb5p 1.2.840.113554.1.2.2 DES MAC MD5   rpc_gss_svc_privacy                                     for integrity,                                     and 56 bit DES                                     for privacy.   Note that the pseudo flavor is presented here as a mapping aid to the   implementor.  Because this NFS protocol includes a method to   negotiate security and it understands the GSS-API mechanism, theShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 25]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   pseudo flavor is not needed.  The pseudo flavor is needed for NFS   version 3 since the security negotiation is done via the MOUNT   protocol.   For a discussion of NFS' use of RPCSEC_GSS and Kerberos V5, please   see [RFC2623].   Users and implementors are warned that 56 bit DES is no longer   considered state of the art in terms of resistance to brute force   attacks.  Once a revision to [RFC1964] is available that adds support   for AES, implementors are urged to incorporate AES into their NFSv4   over Kerberos V5 protocol stacks, and users are similarly urged to   migrate to the use of AES.3.2.1.2.  LIPKEY as a security triple   The LIPKEY GSS-API mechanism as described in [RFC2847] MUST be   implemented and provide the following security triples.  The   definition of the columns matches the previous subsection "Kerberos   V5 as security triple"   1      2        3                   4              5   --------------------------------------------------------------------   390006 lipkey   1.3.6.1.5.5.9       negotiated  rpc_gss_svc_none   390007 lipkey-i 1.3.6.1.5.5.9       negotiated  rpc_gss_svc_integrity   390008 lipkey-p 1.3.6.1.5.5.9       negotiated  rpc_gss_svc_privacy   The mechanism algorithm is listed as "negotiated".  This is because   LIPKEY is layered on SPKM-3 and in SPKM-3 [RFC2847] the   confidentiality and integrity algorithms are negotiated.  Since   SPKM-3 specifies HMAC-MD5 for integrity as MANDATORY, 128 bit   cast5CBC for confidentiality for privacy as MANDATORY, and further   specifies that HMAC-MD5 and cast5CBC MUST be listed first before   weaker algorithms, specifying "negotiated" in column 4 does not   impair interoperability.  In the event an SPKM-3 peer does not   support the mandatory algorithms, the other peer is free to accept or   reject the GSS-API context creation.   Because SPKM-3 negotiates the algorithms, subsequent calls to   LIPKEY's GSS_Wrap() and GSS_GetMIC() by RPCSEC_GSS will use a quality   of protection value of 0 (zero).  Seesection 5.2 of [RFC2025] for an   explanation.   LIPKEY uses SPKM-3 to create a secure channel in which to pass a user   name and password from the client to the server.  Once the user name   and password have been accepted by the server, calls to the LIPKEY   context are redirected to the SPKM-3 context.  See [RFC2847] for more   details.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 26]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20033.2.1.3.  SPKM-3 as a security triple   The SPKM-3 GSS-API mechanism as described in [RFC2847] MUST be   implemented and provide the following security triples.  The   definition of the columns matches the previous subsection "Kerberos   V5 as security triple".   1      2        3                   4              5   --------------------------------------------------------------------   390009 spkm3    1.3.6.1.5.5.1.3     negotiated  rpc_gss_svc_none   390010 spkm3i   1.3.6.1.5.5.1.3     negotiated  rpc_gss_svc_integrity   390011 spkm3p   1.3.6.1.5.5.1.3     negotiated  rpc_gss_svc_privacy   For a discussion as to why the mechanism algorithm is listed as   "negotiated", see the previous section "LIPKEY as a security triple."   Because SPKM-3 negotiates the algorithms, subsequent calls to SPKM-   3's GSS_Wrap() and GSS_GetMIC() by RPCSEC_GSS will use a quality of   protection value of 0 (zero).  Seesection 5.2 of [RFC2025] for an   explanation.   Even though LIPKEY is layered over SPKM-3, SPKM-3 is specified as a   mandatory set of triples to handle the situations where the initiator   (the client) is anonymous or where the initiator has its own   certificate.  If the initiator is anonymous, there will not be a user   name and password to send to the target (the server).  If the   initiator has its own certificate, then using passwords is   superfluous.3.3.  Security Negotiation   With the NFS version 4 server potentially offering multiple security   mechanisms, the client needs a method to determine or negotiate which   mechanism is to be used for its communication with the server.  The   NFS server may have multiple points within its filesystem name space   that are available for use by NFS clients.  In turn the NFS server   may be configured such that each of these entry points may have   different or multiple security mechanisms in use.   The security negotiation between client and server must be done with   a secure channel to eliminate the possibility of a third party   intercepting the negotiation sequence and forcing the client and   server to choose a lower level of security than required or desired.   See the section "Security Considerations" for further discussion.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 27]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20033.3.1.  SECINFO   The new SECINFO operation will allow the client to determine, on a   per filehandle basis, what security triple is to be used for server   access.  In general, the client will not have to use the SECINFO   operation except during initial communication with the server or when   the client crosses policy boundaries at the server.  It is possible   that the server's policies change during the client's interaction   therefore forcing the client to negotiate a new security triple.3.3.2.  Security Error   Based on the assumption that each NFS version 4 client and server   must support a minimum set of security (i.e., LIPKEY, SPKM-3, and   Kerberos-V5 all under RPCSEC_GSS), the NFS client will start its   communication with the server with one of the minimal security   triples.  During communication with the server, the client may   receive an NFS error of NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC.  This error allows the   server to notify the client that the security triple currently being   used is not appropriate for access to the server's filesystem   resources.  The client is then responsible for determining what   security triples are available at the server and choose one which is   appropriate for the client.  See the section for the "SECINFO"   operation for further discussion of how the client will respond to   the NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC error and use SECINFO.3.4.  Callback RPC Authentication   Except as noted elsewhere in this section, the callback RPC   (described later) MUST mutually authenticate the NFS server to the   principal that acquired the clientid (also described later), using   the security flavor the original SETCLIENTID operation used.   For AUTH_NONE, there are no principals, so this is a non-issue.   AUTH_SYS has no notions of mutual authentication or a server   principal, so the callback from the server simply uses the AUTH_SYS   credential that the user used when he set up the delegation.   For AUTH_DH, one commonly used convention is that the server uses the   credential corresponding to this AUTH_DH principal:         unix.host@domain   where host and domain are variables corresponding to the name of   server host and directory services domain in which it lives such as a   Network Information System domain or a DNS domain.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 28]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   Because LIPKEY is layered over SPKM-3, it is permissible for the   server to use SPKM-3 and not LIPKEY for the callback even if the   client used LIPKEY for SETCLIENTID.   Regardless of what security mechanism under RPCSEC_GSS is being used,   the NFS server, MUST identify itself in GSS-API via a   GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE name type.  GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE   names are of the form:         service@hostname   For NFS, the "service" element is         nfs   Implementations of security mechanisms will convert nfs@hostname to   various different forms.  For Kerberos V5 and LIPKEY, the following   form is RECOMMENDED:         nfs/hostname   For Kerberos V5, nfs/hostname would be a server principal in the   Kerberos Key Distribution Center database.  This is the same   principal the client acquired a GSS-API context for when it issued   the SETCLIENTID operation, therefore, the realm name for the server   principal must be the same for the callback as it was for the   SETCLIENTID.   For LIPKEY, this would be the username passed to the target (the NFS   version 4 client that receives the callback).   It should be noted that LIPKEY may not work for callbacks, since the   LIPKEY client uses a user id/password.  If the NFS client receiving   the callback can authenticate the NFS server's user name/password   pair, and if the user that the NFS server is authenticating to has a   public key certificate, then it works.   In situations where the NFS client uses LIPKEY and uses a per-host   principal for the SETCLIENTID operation, instead of using LIPKEY for   SETCLIENTID, it is RECOMMENDED that SPKM-3 with mutual authentication   be used.  This effectively means that the client will use a   certificate to authenticate and identify the initiator to the target   on the NFS server.  Using SPKM-3 and not LIPKEY has the following   advantages:   o  When the server does a callback, it must authenticate to the      principal used in the SETCLIENTID.  Even if LIPKEY is used,      because LIPKEY is layered over SPKM-3, the NFS client will need toShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 29]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003      have a certificate that corresponds to the principal used in the      SETCLIENTID operation.  From an administrative perspective, having      a user name, password, and certificate for both the client and      server is redundant.   o  LIPKEY was intended to minimize additional infrastructure      requirements beyond a certificate for the target, and the      expectation is that existing password infrastructure can be      leveraged for the initiator.  In some environments, a per-host      password does not exist yet.  If certificates are used for any      per-host principals, then additional password infrastructure is      not needed.   o  In cases when a host is both an NFS client and server, it can      share the same per-host certificate.4.  Filehandles   The filehandle in the NFS protocol is a per server unique identifier   for a filesystem object.  The contents of the filehandle are opaque   to the client.  Therefore, the server is responsible for translating   the filehandle to an internal representation of the filesystem   object.4.1.  Obtaining the First Filehandle   The operations of the NFS protocol are defined in terms of one or   more filehandles.  Therefore, the client needs a filehandle to   initiate communication with the server.  With the NFS version 2   protocol [RFC1094] and the NFS version 3 protocol [RFC1813], there   exists an ancillary protocol to obtain this first filehandle.  The   MOUNT protocol, RPC program number 100005, provides the mechanism of   translating a string based filesystem path name to a filehandle which   can then be used by the NFS protocols.   The MOUNT protocol has deficiencies in the area of security and use   via firewalls.  This is one reason that the use of the public   filehandle was introduced in [RFC2054] and [RFC2055].  With the use   of the public filehandle in combination with the LOOKUP operation in   the NFS version 2 and 3 protocols, it has been demonstrated that the   MOUNT protocol is unnecessary for viable interaction between NFS   client and server.   Therefore, the NFS version 4 protocol will not use an ancillary   protocol for translation from string based path names to a   filehandle.  Two special filehandles will be used as starting points   for the NFS client.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 30]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20034.1.1.  Root Filehandle   The first of the special filehandles is the ROOT filehandle.  The   ROOT filehandle is the "conceptual" root of the filesystem name space   at the NFS server.  The client uses or starts with the ROOT   filehandle by employing the PUTROOTFH operation.  The PUTROOTFH   operation instructs the server to set the "current" filehandle to the   ROOT of the server's file tree.  Once this PUTROOTFH operation is   used, the client can then traverse the entirety of the server's file   tree with the LOOKUP operation.  A complete discussion of the server   name space is in the section "NFS Server Name Space".4.1.2.  Public Filehandle   The second special filehandle is the PUBLIC filehandle.  Unlike the   ROOT filehandle, the PUBLIC filehandle may be bound or represent an   arbitrary filesystem object at the server.  The server is responsible   for this binding.  It may be that the PUBLIC filehandle and the ROOT   filehandle refer to the same filesystem object.  However, it is up to   the administrative software at the server and the policies of the   server administrator to define the binding of the PUBLIC filehandle   and server filesystem object.  The client may not make any   assumptions about this binding.  The client uses the PUBLIC   filehandle via the PUTPUBFH operation.4.2.  Filehandle Types   In the NFS version 2 and 3 protocols, there was one type of   filehandle with a single set of semantics.  This type of filehandle   is termed "persistent" in NFS Version 4.  The semantics of a   persistent filehandle remain the same as before.  A new type of   filehandle introduced in NFS Version 4 is the "volatile" filehandle,   which attempts to accommodate certain server environments.   The volatile filehandle type was introduced to address server   functionality or implementation issues which make correct   implementation of a persistent filehandle infeasible.  Some server   environments do not provide a filesystem level invariant that can be   used to construct a persistent filehandle.  The underlying server   filesystem may not provide the invariant or the server's filesystem   programming interfaces may not provide access to the needed   invariant.  Volatile filehandles may ease the implementation of   server functionality such as hierarchical storage management or   filesystem reorganization or migration.  However, the volatile   filehandle increases the implementation burden for the client.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 31]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   Since the client will need to handle persistent and volatile   filehandles differently, a file attribute is defined which may be   used by the client to determine the filehandle types being returned   by the server.4.2.1.  General Properties of a Filehandle   The filehandle contains all the information the server needs to   distinguish an individual file.  To the client, the filehandle is   opaque.  The client stores filehandles for use in a later request and   can compare two filehandles from the same server for equality by   doing a byte-by-byte comparison.  However, the client MUST NOT   otherwise interpret the contents of filehandles.  If two filehandles   from the same server are equal, they MUST refer to the same file.   Servers SHOULD try to maintain a one-to-one correspondence between   filehandles and files but this is not required.  Clients MUST use   filehandle comparisons only to improve performance, not for correct   behavior.  All clients need to be prepared for situations in which it   cannot be determined whether two filehandles denote the same object   and in such cases, avoid making invalid assumptions which might cause   incorrect behavior.  Further discussion of filehandle and attribute   comparison in the context of data caching is presented in the section   "Data Caching and File Identity".   As an example, in the case that two different path names when   traversed at the server terminate at the same filesystem object, the   server SHOULD return the same filehandle for each path.  This can   occur if a hard link is used to create two file names which refer to   the same underlying file object and associated data.  For example, if   paths /a/b/c and /a/d/c refer to the same file, the server SHOULD   return the same filehandle for both path names traversals.4.2.2.  Persistent Filehandle   A persistent filehandle is defined as having a fixed value for the   lifetime of the filesystem object to which it refers.  Once the   server creates the filehandle for a filesystem object, the server   MUST accept the same filehandle for the object for the lifetime of   the object.  If the server restarts or reboots the NFS server must   honor the same filehandle value as it did in the server's previous   instantiation.  Similarly, if the filesystem is migrated, the new NFS   server must honor the same filehandle as the old NFS server.   The persistent filehandle will be become stale or invalid when the   filesystem object is removed.  When the server is presented with a   persistent filehandle that refers to a deleted object, it MUST return   an error of NFS4ERR_STALE.  A filehandle may become stale when the   filesystem containing the object is no longer available.  The fileShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 32]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   system may become unavailable if it exists on removable media and the   media is no longer available at the server or the filesystem in whole   has been destroyed or the filesystem has simply been removed from the   server's name space (i.e., unmounted in a UNIX environment).4.2.3.  Volatile Filehandle   A volatile filehandle does not share the same longevity   characteristics of a persistent filehandle.  The server may determine   that a volatile filehandle is no longer valid at many different   points in time.  If the server can definitively determine that a   volatile filehandle refers to an object that has been removed, the   server should return NFS4ERR_STALE to the client (as is the case for   persistent filehandles).  In all other cases where the server   determines that a volatile filehandle can no longer be used, it   should return an error of NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED.   The mandatory attribute "fh_expire_type" is used by the client to   determine what type of filehandle the server is providing for a   particular filesystem.  This attribute is a bitmask with the   following values:   FH4_PERSISTENT             The value of FH4_PERSISTENT is used to indicate a             persistent filehandle, which is valid until the object is             removed from the filesystem.  The server will not return             NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED for this filehandle.  FH4_PERSISTENT is             defined as a value in which none of the bits specified             below are set.   FH4_VOLATILE_ANY             The filehandle may expire at any time, except as             specifically excluded (i.e., FH4_NO_EXPIRE_WITH_OPEN).   FH4_NOEXPIRE_WITH_OPEN             May only be set when FH4_VOLATILE_ANY is set.  If this bit             is set, then the meaning of FH4_VOLATILE_ANY is qualified             to exclude any expiration of the filehandle when it is             open.   FH4_VOL_MIGRATION             The filehandle will expire as a result of migration.  If             FH4_VOL_ANY is set, FH4_VOL_MIGRATION is redundant.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 33]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   FH4_VOL_RENAME             The filehandle will expire during rename.  This includes a             rename by the requesting client or a rename by any other             client.  If FH4_VOL_ANY is set, FH4_VOL_RENAME is             redundant.   Servers which provide volatile filehandles that may expire while open   (i.e., if FH4_VOL_MIGRATION or FH4_VOL_RENAME is set or if   FH4_VOLATILE_ANY is set and FH4_NOEXPIRE_WITH_OPEN not set), should   deny a RENAME or REMOVE that would affect an OPEN file of any of the   components leading to the OPEN file.  In addition, the server should   deny all RENAME or REMOVE requests during the grace period upon   server restart.   Note that the bits FH4_VOL_MIGRATION and FH4_VOL_RENAME allow the   client to determine that expiration has occurred whenever a specific   event occurs, without an explicit filehandle expiration error from   the server.  FH4_VOL_ANY does not provide this form of information.   In situations where the server will expire many, but not all   filehandles upon migration (e.g., all but those that are open),   FH4_VOLATILE_ANY (in this case with FH4_NOEXPIRE_WITH_OPEN) is a   better choice since the client may not assume that all filehandles   will expire when migration occurs, and it is likely that additional   expirations will occur (as a result of file CLOSE) that are separated   in time from the migration event itself.4.2.4.  One Method of Constructing a Volatile Filehandle   A volatile filehandle, while opaque to the client could contain:   [volatile bit = 1 | server boot time | slot | generation number]   o  slot is an index in the server volatile filehandle table   o  generation number is the generation number for the table      entry/slot   When the client presents a volatile filehandle, the server makes the   following checks, which assume that the check for the volatile bit   has passed.  If the server boot time is less than the current server   boot time, return NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED.  If slot is out of range, return   NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE.  If the generation number does not match, return   NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED.   When the server reboots, the table is gone (it is volatile).   If volatile bit is 0, then it is a persistent filehandle with a   different structure following it.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 34]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20034.3.  Client Recovery from Filehandle Expiration   If possible, the client SHOULD recover from the receipt of an   NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED error.  The client must take on additional   responsibility so that it may prepare itself to recover from the   expiration of a volatile filehandle.  If the server returns   persistent filehandles, the client does not need these additional   steps.   For volatile filehandles, most commonly the client will need to store   the component names leading up to and including the filesystem object   in question.  With these names, the client should be able to recover   by finding a filehandle in the name space that is still available or   by starting at the root of the server's filesystem name space.   If the expired filehandle refers to an object that has been removed   from the filesystem, obviously the client will not be able to recover   from the expired filehandle.   It is also possible that the expired filehandle refers to a file that   has been renamed.  If the file was renamed by another client, again   it is possible that the original client will not be able to recover.   However, in the case that the client itself is renaming the file and   the file is open, it is possible that the client may be able to   recover.  The client can determine the new path name based on the   processing of the rename request.  The client can then regenerate the   new filehandle based on the new path name.  The client could also use   the compound operation mechanism to construct a set of operations   like:           RENAME A B           LOOKUP B           GETFH   Note that the COMPOUND procedure does not provide atomicity.  This   example only reduces the overhead of recovering from an expired   filehandle.5.  File Attributes   To meet the requirements of extensibility and increased   interoperability with non-UNIX platforms, attributes must be handled   in a flexible manner.  The NFS version 3 fattr3 structure contains a   fixed list of attributes that not all clients and servers are able to   support or care about.  The fattr3 structure can not be extended as   new needs arise and it provides no way to indicate non-support.  With   the NFS version 4 protocol, the client is able query what attributes   the server supports and construct requests with only those supported   attributes (or a subset thereof).Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 35]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   To this end, attributes are divided into three groups: mandatory,   recommended, and named.  Both mandatory and recommended attributes   are supported in the NFS version 4 protocol by a specific and well-   defined encoding and are identified by number.  They are requested by   setting a bit in the bit vector sent in the GETATTR request; the   server response includes a bit vector to list what attributes were   returned in the response.  New mandatory or recommended attributes   may be added to the NFS protocol between major revisions by   publishing a standards-track RFC which allocates a new attribute   number value and defines the encoding for the attribute.  See the   section "Minor Versioning" for further discussion.   Named attributes are accessed by the new OPENATTR operation, which   accesses a hidden directory of attributes associated with a file   system object.  OPENATTR takes a filehandle for the object and   returns the filehandle for the attribute hierarchy.  The filehandle   for the named attributes is a directory object accessible by LOOKUP   or READDIR and contains files whose names represent the named   attributes and whose data bytes are the value of the attribute.  For   example:      LOOKUP     "foo"       ; look up file      GETATTR    attrbits      OPENATTR               ; access foo's named attributes      LOOKUP     "x11icon"   ; look up specific attribute      READ       0,4096      ; read stream of bytes   Named attributes are intended for data needed by applications rather   than by an NFS client implementation.  NFS implementors are strongly   encouraged to define their new attributes as recommended attributes   by bringing them to the IETF standards-track process.   The set of attributes which are classified as mandatory is   deliberately small since servers must do whatever it takes to support   them.  A server should support as many of the recommended attributes   as possible but by their definition, the server is not required to   support all of them.  Attributes are deemed mandatory if the data is   both needed by a large number of clients and is not otherwise   reasonably computable by the client when support is not provided on   the server.   Note that the hidden directory returned by OPENATTR is a convenience   for protocol processing.  The client should not make any assumptions   about the server's implementation of named attributes and whether the   underlying filesystem at the server has a named attribute directory   or not.  Therefore, operations such as SETATTR and GETATTR on the   named attribute directory are undefined.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 36]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20035.1.  Mandatory Attributes   These MUST be supported by every NFS version 4 client and server in   order to ensure a minimum level of interoperability.  The server must   store and return these attributes and the client must be able to   function with an attribute set limited to these attributes.  With   just the mandatory attributes some client functionality may be   impaired or limited in some ways.  A client may ask for any of these   attributes to be returned by setting a bit in the GETATTR request and   the server must return their value.5.2.  Recommended Attributes   These attributes are understood well enough to warrant support in the   NFS version 4 protocol.  However, they may not be supported on all   clients and servers.  A client may ask for any of these attributes to   be returned by setting a bit in the GETATTR request but must handle   the case where the server does not return them.  A client may ask for   the set of attributes the server supports and should not request   attributes the server does not support.  A server should be tolerant   of requests for unsupported attributes and simply not return them   rather than considering the request an error.  It is expected that   servers will support all attributes they comfortably can and only   fail to support attributes which are difficult to support in their   operating environments.  A server should provide attributes whenever   they don't have to "tell lies" to the client.  For example, a file   modification time should be either an accurate time or should not be   supported by the server.  This will not always be comfortable to   clients but the client is better positioned decide whether and how to   fabricate or construct an attribute or whether to do without the   attribute.5.3.  Named Attributes   These attributes are not supported by direct encoding in the NFS   Version 4 protocol but are accessed by string names rather than   numbers and correspond to an uninterpreted stream of bytes which are   stored with the filesystem object.  The name space for these   attributes may be accessed by using the OPENATTR operation.  The   OPENATTR operation returns a filehandle for a virtual "attribute   directory" and further perusal of the name space may be done using   READDIR and LOOKUP operations on this filehandle.  Named attributes   may then be examined or changed by normal READ and WRITE and CREATE   operations on the filehandles returned from READDIR and LOOKUP.   Named attributes may have attributes.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 37]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   It is recommended that servers support arbitrary named attributes.  A   client should not depend on the ability to store any named attributes   in the server's filesystem.  If a server does support named   attributes, a client which is also able to handle them should be able   to copy a file's data and meta-data with complete transparency from   one location to another; this would imply that names allowed for   regular directory entries are valid for named attribute names as   well.   Names of attributes will not be controlled by this document or other   IETF standards track documents.  See the section "IANA   Considerations" for further discussion.5.4.  Classification of Attributes   Each of the Mandatory and Recommended attributes can be classified in   one of three categories: per server, per filesystem, or per   filesystem object.  Note that it is possible that some per filesystem   attributes may vary within the filesystem.  See the "homogeneous"   attribute for its definition.  Note that the attributes   time_access_set and time_modify_set are not listed in this section   because they are write-only attributes corresponding to time_access   and time_modify, and are used in a special instance of SETATTR.   o  The per server attribute is:         lease_time   o  The per filesystem attributes are:      supp_attr, fh_expire_type, link_support, symlink_support,      unique_handles, aclsupport, cansettime, case_insensitive,      case_preserving, chown_restricted, files_avail, files_free,      files_total, fs_locations, homogeneous, maxfilesize, maxname,      maxread, maxwrite, no_trunc, space_avail, space_free, space_total,      time_delta   o  The per filesystem object attributes are:      type, change, size, named_attr, fsid, rdattr_error, filehandle,      ACL, archive, fileid, hidden, maxlink, mimetype, mode, numlinks,      owner, owner_group, rawdev, space_used, system, time_access,      time_backup, time_create, time_metadata, time_modify,      mounted_on_fileid   For quota_avail_hard, quota_avail_soft, and quota_used see their   definitions below for the appropriate classification.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 38]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20035.5.  Mandatory Attributes - Definitions   Name              #    DataType     Access   Description   ___________________________________________________________________   supp_attr         0    bitmap       READ     The bit vector which                                                would retrieve all                                                mandatory and                                                recommended attributes                                                that are supported for                                                this object.  The                                                scope of this                                                attribute applies to                                                all objects with a                                                matching fsid.   type              1    nfs4_ftype   READ     The type of the object                                                (file, directory,                                                symlink, etc.)   fh_expire_type    2    uint32       READ     Server uses this to                                                specify filehandle                                                expiration behavior to                                                the client.  See the                                                section "Filehandles"                                                for additional                                                description.   change            3    uint64       READ     A value created by the                                                server that the client                                                can use to determine                                                if file data,                                                directory contents or                                                attributes of the                                                object have been                                                modified.  The server                                                may return the                                                object's time_metadata                                                attribute for this                                                attribute's value but                                                only if the filesystem                                                object can not be                                                updated more                                                frequently than the                                                resolution of                                                time_metadata.   size              4    uint64       R/W      The size of the object                                                in bytes.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 39]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   link_support      5    bool         READ     True, if the object's                                                filesystem supports                                                hard links.   symlink_support   6    bool         READ     True, if the object's                                                filesystem supports                                                symbolic links.   named_attr        7    bool         READ     True, if this object                                                has named attributes.                                                In other words, object                                                has a non-empty named                                                attribute directory.   fsid              8    fsid4        READ     Unique filesystem                                                identifier for the                                                filesystem holding                                                this object.  fsid                                                contains major and                                                minor components each                                                of which are uint64.   unique_handles    9    bool         READ     True, if two distinct                                                filehandles guaranteed                                                to refer to two                                                different filesystem                                                objects.   lease_time        10   nfs_lease4   READ     Duration of leases at                                                server in seconds.   rdattr_error      11   enum         READ     Error returned from                                                getattr during                                                readdir.   filehandle        19   nfs_fh4      READ     The filehandle of this                                                object (primarily for                                                readdir requests).Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 40]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20035.6.  Recommended Attributes - Definitions   Name                #    Data Type      Access   Description   _____________________________________________________________________   ACL                 12   nfsace4<>      R/W      The access control                                                    list for the object.   aclsupport          13   uint32         READ     Indicates what types                                                    of ACLs are                                                    supported on the                                                    current filesystem.   archive             14   bool           R/W      True, if this file                                                    has been archived                                                    since the time of                                                    last modification                                                    (deprecated in favor                                                    of time_backup).   cansettime          15   bool           READ     True, if the server                                                    is able to change                                                    the times for a                                                    filesystem object as                                                    specified in a                                                    SETATTR operation.   case_insensitive    16   bool           READ     True, if filename                                                    comparisons on this                                                    filesystem are case                                                    insensitive.   case_preserving     17   bool           READ     True, if filename                                                    case on this                                                    filesystem are                                                    preserved.   chown_restricted    18   bool           READ     If TRUE, the server                                                    will reject any                                                    request to change                                                    either the owner or                                                    the group associated                                                    with a file if the                                                    caller is not a                                                    privileged user (for                                                    example, "root" in                                                    UNIX operating                                                    environments or in                                                    Windows 2000 theShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 41]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003                                                    "Take Ownership"                                                    privilege).   fileid              20   uint64         READ     A number uniquely                                                    identifying the file                                                    within the                                                    filesystem.   files_avail         21   uint64         READ     File slots available                                                    to this user on the                                                    filesystem                                                    containing this                                                    object - this should                                                    be the smallest                                                    relevant limit.   files_free          22   uint64         READ     Free file slots on                                                    the filesystem                                                    containing this                                                    object - this should                                                    be the smallest                                                    relevant limit.   files_total         23   uint64         READ     Total file slots on                                                    the filesystem                                                    containing this                                                    object.   fs_locations        24   fs_locations   READ     Locations where this                                                    filesystem may be                                                    found.  If the                                                    server returns                                                    NFS4ERR_MOVED                                                    as an error, this                                                    attribute MUST be                                                    supported.   hidden              25   bool           R/W      True, if the file is                                                    considered hidden                                                    with respect to the                                                    Windows API.   homogeneous         26   bool           READ     True, if this                                                    object's filesystem                                                    is homogeneous,                                                    i.e., are per                                                    filesystem                                                    attributes the sameShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 42]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003                                                    for all filesystem's                                                    objects?   maxfilesize         27   uint64         READ     Maximum supported                                                    file size for the                                                    filesystem of this                                                    object.   maxlink             28   uint32         READ     Maximum number of                                                    links for this                                                    object.   maxname             29   uint32         READ     Maximum filename                                                    size supported for                                                    this object.   maxread             30   uint64         READ     Maximum read size                                                    supported for this                                                    object.   maxwrite            31   uint64         READ     Maximum write size                                                    supported for this                                                    object.  This                                                    attribute SHOULD be                                                    supported if the                                                    file is writable.                                                    Lack of this                                                    attribute can                                                    lead to the client                                                    either wasting                                                    bandwidth or not                                                    receiving the best                                                    performance.   mimetype            32   utf8<>         R/W      MIME body                                                    type/subtype of this                                                    object.   mode                33   mode4          R/W      UNIX-style mode and                                                    permission bits for                                                    this object.   no_trunc            34   bool           READ     True, if a name                                                    longer than name_max                                                    is used, an error be                                                    returned and name is                                                    not truncated.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 43]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   numlinks            35   uint32         READ     Number of hard links                                                    to this object.   owner               36   utf8<>         R/W      The string name of                                                    the owner of this                                                    object.   owner_group         37   utf8<>         R/W      The string name of                                                    the group ownership                                                    of this object.   quota_avail_hard    38   uint64         READ     For definition see                                                    "Quota Attributes"                                                    section below.   quota_avail_soft    39   uint64         READ     For definition see                                                    "Quota Attributes"                                                    section below.   quota_used          40   uint64         READ     For definition see                                                    "Quota Attributes"                                                    section below.   rawdev              41   specdata4      READ     Raw device                                                    identifier.  UNIX                                                    device major/minor                                                    node information.                                                    If the value of                                                    type is not                                                    NF4BLK or NF4CHR,                                                    the value return                                                    SHOULD NOT be                                                    considered useful.   space_avail         42   uint64         READ     Disk space in bytes                                                    available to this                                                    user on the                                                    filesystem                                                    containing this                                                    object - this should                                                    be the smallest                                                    relevant limit.   space_free          43   uint64         READ     Free disk space in                                                    bytes on the                                                    filesystem                                                    containing this                                                    object - this shouldShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 44]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003                                                    be the smallest                                                    relevant limit.   space_total         44   uint64         READ     Total disk space in                                                    bytes on the                                                    filesystem                                                    containing this                                                    object.   space_used          45   uint64         READ     Number of filesystem                                                    bytes allocated to                                                    this object.   system              46   bool           R/W      True, if this file                                                    is a "system" file                                                    with respect to the                                                    Windows API.   time_access         47   nfstime4       READ     The time of last                                                    access to the object                                                    by a read that was                                                    satisfied by the                                                    server.   time_access_set     48   settime4       WRITE    Set the time of last                                                    access to the                                                    object.  SETATTR                                                    use only.   time_backup         49   nfstime4       R/W      The time of last                                                    backup of the                                                    object.   time_create         50   nfstime4       R/W      The time of creation                                                    of the object.  This                                                    attribute does not                                                    have any relation to                                                    the traditional UNIX                                                    file attribute                                                    "ctime" or "change                                                    time".   time_delta          51   nfstime4       READ     Smallest useful                                                    server time                                                    granularity.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 45]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   time_metadata       52   nfstime4       READ     The time of last                                                    meta-data                                                    modification of the                                                    object.   time_modify         53   nfstime4       READ     The time of last                                                    modification to the                                                    object.   time_modify_set     54   settime4       WRITE    Set the time of last                                                    modification to the                                                    object.  SETATTR use                                                    only.   mounted_on_fileid   55   uint64         READ     Like fileid, but if                                                    the target                                                    filehandle is the                                                    root of a filesystem                                                    return the fileid of                                                    the underlying                                                    directory.5.7.  Time Access   As defined above, the time_access attribute represents the time of   last access to the object by a read that was satisfied by the server.   The notion of what is an "access" depends on server's operating   environment and/or the server's filesystem semantics.  For example,   for servers obeying POSIX semantics, time_access would be updated   only by the READLINK, READ, and READDIR operations and not any of the   operations that modify the content of the object.  Of course, setting   the corresponding time_access_set attribute is another way to modify   the time_access attribute.   Whenever the file object resides on a writable filesystem, the server   should make best efforts to record time_access into stable storage.   However, to mitigate the performance effects of doing so, and most   especially whenever the server is satisfying the read of the object's   content from its cache, the server MAY cache access time updates and   lazily write them to stable storage.  It is also acceptable to give   administrators of the server the option to disable time_access   updates.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 46]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20035.8.  Interpreting owner and owner_group   The recommended attributes "owner" and "owner_group" (and also users   and groups within the "acl" attribute) are represented in terms of a   UTF-8 string.  To avoid a representation that is tied to a particular   underlying implementation at the client or server, the use of the   UTF-8 string has been chosen.  Note thatsection 6.1 of [RFC2624]   provides additional rationale.  It is expected that the client and   server will have their own local representation of owner and   owner_group that is used for local storage or presentation to the end   user.  Therefore, it is expected that when these attributes are   transferred between the client and server that the local   representation is translated to a syntax of the form   "user@dns_domain".  This will allow for a client and server that do   not use the same local representation the ability to translate to a   common syntax that can be interpreted by both.   Similarly, security principals may be represented in different ways   by different security mechanisms.  Servers normally translate these   representations into a common format, generally that used by local   storage, to serve as a means of identifying the users corresponding   to these security principals.  When these local identifiers are   translated to the form of the owner attribute, associated with files   created by such principals they identify, in a common format, the   users associated with each corresponding set of security principals.   The translation used to interpret owner and group strings is not   specified as part of the protocol.  This allows various solutions to   be employed.  For example, a local translation table may be consulted   that maps between a numeric id to the user@dns_domain syntax.  A name   service may also be used to accomplish the translation.  A server may   provide a more general service, not limited by any particular   translation (which would only translate a limited set of possible   strings) by storing the owner and owner_group attributes in local   storage without any translation or it may augment a translation   method by storing the entire string for attributes for which no   translation is available while using the local representation for   those cases in which a translation is available.   Servers that do not provide support for all possible values of the   owner and owner_group attributes, should return an error   (NFS4ERR_BADOWNER) when a string is presented that has no   translation, as the value to be set for a SETATTR of the owner,   owner_group, or acl attributes.  When a server does accept an owner   or owner_group value as valid on a SETATTR (and similarly for the   owner and group strings in an acl), it is promising to return that   same string when a corresponding GETATTR is done.  Configuration   changes and ill-constructed name translations (those that containShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 47]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   aliasing) may make that promise impossible to honor.  Servers should   make appropriate efforts to avoid a situation in which these   attributes have their values changed when no real change to ownership   has occurred.   The "dns_domain" portion of the owner string is meant to be a DNS   domain name.  For example, user@ietf.org.  Servers should accept as   valid a set of users for at least one domain.  A server may treat   other domains as having no valid translations.  A more general   service is provided when a server is capable of accepting users for   multiple domains, or for all domains, subject to security   constraints.   In the case where there is no translation available to the client or   server, the attribute value must be constructed without the "@".   Therefore, the absence of the @ from the owner or owner_group   attribute signifies that no translation was available at the sender   and that the receiver of the attribute should not use that string as   a basis for translation into its own internal format.  Even though   the attribute value can not be translated, it may still be useful.   In the case of a client, the attribute string may be used for local   display of ownership.   To provide a greater degree of compatibility with previous versions   of NFS (i.e., v2 and v3), which identified users and groups by 32-bit   unsigned uid's and gid's, owner and group strings that consist of   decimal numeric values with no leading zeros can be given a special   interpretation by clients and servers which choose to provide such   support.  The receiver may treat such a user or group string as   representing the same user as would be represented by a v2/v3 uid or   gid having the corresponding numeric value.  A server is not   obligated to accept such a string, but may return an NFS4ERR_BADOWNER   instead.  To avoid this mechanism being used to subvert user and   group translation, so that a client might pass all of the owners and   groups in numeric form, a server SHOULD return an NFS4ERR_BADOWNER   error when there is a valid translation for the user or owner   designated in this way.  In that case, the client must use the   appropriate name@domain string and not the special form for   compatibility.   The owner string "nobody" may be used to designate an anonymous user,   which will be associated with a file created by a security principal   that cannot be mapped through normal means to the owner attribute.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 48]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20035.9.  Character Case Attributes   With respect to the case_insensitive and case_preserving attributes,   each UCS-4 character (which UTF-8 encodes) has a "long descriptive   name" [RFC1345] which may or may not included the word "CAPITAL" or   "SMALL".  The presence of SMALL or CAPITAL allows an NFS server to   implement unambiguous and efficient table driven mappings for case   insensitive comparisons, and non-case-preserving storage.  For   general character handling and internationalization issues, see the   section "Internationalization".5.10.  Quota Attributes   For the attributes related to filesystem quotas, the following   definitions apply:   quota_avail_soft         The value in bytes which represents the amount of additional         disk space that can be allocated to this file or directory         before the user may reasonably be warned.  It is understood         that this space may be consumed by allocations to other files         or directories though there is a rule as to which other files         or directories.   quota_avail_hard         The value in bytes which represent the amount of additional         disk space beyond the current allocation that can be allocated         to this file or directory before further allocations will be         refused.  It is understood that this space may be consumed by         allocations to other files or directories.   quota_used         The value in bytes which represent the amount of disc space         used by this file or directory and possibly a number of other         similar files or directories, where the set of "similar" meets         at least the criterion that allocating space to any file or         directory in the set will reduce the "quota_avail_hard" of         every other file or directory in the set.         Note that there may be a number of distinct but overlapping         sets of files or directories for which a quota_used value is         maintained (e.g., "all files with a given owner", "all files         with a given group owner", etc.).         The server is at liberty to choose any of those sets but should         do so in a repeatable way.  The rule may be configured per-         filesystem or may be "choose the set with the smallest quota".Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 49]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20035.11.  Access Control Lists   The NFS version 4 ACL attribute is an array of access control entries   (ACE).  Although, the client can read and write the ACL attribute,   the NFSv4 model is the server does all access control based on the   server's interpretation of the ACL.  If at any point the client wants   to check access without issuing an operation that modifies or reads   data or metadata, the client can use the OPEN and ACCESS operations   to do so.  There are various access control entry types, as defined   in the Section "ACE type".  The server is able to communicate which   ACE types are supported by returning the appropriate value within the   aclsupport attribute.  Each ACE covers one or more operations on a   file or directory as described in the Section "ACE Access Mask".  It   may also contain one or more flags that modify the semantics of the   ACE as defined in the Section "ACE flag".   The NFS ACE attribute is defined as follows:         typedef uint32_t        acetype4;         typedef uint32_t        aceflag4;         typedef uint32_t        acemask4;         struct nfsace4 {                 acetype4        type;                 aceflag4        flag;                 acemask4        access_mask;                 utf8str_mixed   who;         };   To determine if a request succeeds, each nfsace4 entry is processed   in order by the server.  Only ACEs which have a "who" that matches   the requester are considered.  Each ACE is processed until all of the   bits of the requester's access have been ALLOWED.  Once a bit (see   below) has been ALLOWED by an ACCESS_ALLOWED_ACE, it is no longer   considered in the processing of later ACEs.  If an ACCESS_DENIED_ACE   is encountered where the requester's access still has unALLOWED bits   in common with the "access_mask" of the ACE, the request is denied.   However, unlike the ALLOWED and DENIED ACE types, the ALARM and AUDIT   ACE types do not affect a requester's access, and instead are for   triggering events as a result of a requester's access attempt.   Therefore, all AUDIT and ALARM ACEs are processed until end of the   ACL.  When the ACL is fully processed, if there are bits in   requester's mask that have not been considered whether the server   allows or denies the access is undefined.  If there is a mode   attribute on the file, then this cannot happen, since the mode's   MODE4_*OTH bits will map to EVERYONE@ ACEs that unambiguously specify   the requester's access.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 50]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   The NFS version 4 ACL model is quite rich.  Some server platforms may   provide access control functionality that goes beyond the UNIX-style   mode attribute, but which is not as rich as the NFS ACL model.  So   that users can take advantage of this more limited functionality, the   server may indicate that it supports ACLs as long as it follows the   guidelines for mapping between its ACL model and the NFS version 4   ACL model.   The situation is complicated by the fact that a server may have   multiple modules that enforce ACLs.  For example, the enforcement for   NFS version 4 access may be different from the enforcement for local   access, and both may be different from the enforcement for access   through other protocols such as SMB.  So it may be useful for a   server to accept an ACL even if not all of its modules are able to   support it.   The guiding principle in all cases is that the server must not accept   ACLs that appear to make the file more secure than it really is.5.11.1.  ACE type   Type         Description   _____________________________________________________   ALLOW        Explicitly grants the access defined in                acemask4 to the file or directory.   DENY         Explicitly denies the access defined in                acemask4 to the file or directory.   AUDIT        LOG (system dependent) any access                attempt to a file or directory which                uses any of the access methods specified                in acemask4.   ALARM        Generate a system ALARM (system                dependent) when any access attempt is                made to a file or directory for the                access methods specified in acemask4.   A server need not support all of the above ACE types.  The bitmask   constants used to represent the above definitions within the   aclsupport attribute are as follows:      const ACL4_SUPPORT_ALLOW_ACL    = 0x00000001;      const ACL4_SUPPORT_DENY_ACL     = 0x00000002;      const ACL4_SUPPORT_AUDIT_ACL    = 0x00000004;      const ACL4_SUPPORT_ALARM_ACL    = 0x00000008;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 51]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   The semantics of the "type" field follow the descriptions provided   above.   The constants used for the type field (acetype4) are as follows:      const ACE4_ACCESS_ALLOWED_ACE_TYPE      = 0x00000000;      const ACE4_ACCESS_DENIED_ACE_TYPE       = 0x00000001;      const ACE4_SYSTEM_AUDIT_ACE_TYPE        = 0x00000002;      const ACE4_SYSTEM_ALARM_ACE_TYPE        = 0x00000003;   Clients should not attempt to set an ACE unless the server claims   support for that ACE type.  If the server receives a request to set   an ACE that it cannot store, it MUST reject the request with   NFS4ERR_ATTRNOTSUPP.  If the server receives a request to set an ACE   that it can store but cannot enforce, the server SHOULD reject the   request with NFS4ERR_ATTRNOTSUPP.   Example: suppose a server can enforce NFS ACLs for NFS access but   cannot enforce ACLs for local access.  If arbitrary processes can run   on the server, then the server SHOULD NOT indicate ACL support.  On   the other hand, if only trusted administrative programs run locally,   then the server may indicate ACL support.5.11.2.  ACE Access Mask   The access_mask field contains values based on the following:   Access                 Description   _______________________________________________________________   READ_DATA              Permission to read the data of the file   LIST_DIRECTORY         Permission to list the contents of a                          directory   WRITE_DATA             Permission to modify the file's data   ADD_FILE               Permission to add a new file to a                          directory   APPEND_DATA            Permission to append data to a file   ADD_SUBDIRECTORY       Permission to create a subdirectory to a                          directory   READ_NAMED_ATTRS       Permission to read the named attributes                          of a file   WRITE_NAMED_ATTRS      Permission to write the named attributes                          of a file   EXECUTE                Permission to execute a file   DELETE_CHILD           Permission to delete a file or directory                          within a directory   READ_ATTRIBUTES        The ability to read basic attributes                          (non-acls) of a file   WRITE_ATTRIBUTES       Permission to change basic attributesShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 52]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003                          (non-acls) of a file   DELETE                 Permission to Delete the file   READ_ACL               Permission to Read the ACL   WRITE_ACL              Permission to Write the ACL   WRITE_OWNER            Permission to change the owner   SYNCHRONIZE            Permission to access file locally at the                          server with synchronous reads and writes   The bitmask constants used for the access mask field are as follows:   const ACE4_READ_DATA            = 0x00000001;   const ACE4_LIST_DIRECTORY       = 0x00000001;   const ACE4_WRITE_DATA           = 0x00000002;   const ACE4_ADD_FILE             = 0x00000002;   const ACE4_APPEND_DATA          = 0x00000004;   const ACE4_ADD_SUBDIRECTORY     = 0x00000004;   const ACE4_READ_NAMED_ATTRS     = 0x00000008;   const ACE4_WRITE_NAMED_ATTRS    = 0x00000010;   const ACE4_EXECUTE              = 0x00000020;   const ACE4_DELETE_CHILD         = 0x00000040;   const ACE4_READ_ATTRIBUTES      = 0x00000080;   const ACE4_WRITE_ATTRIBUTES     = 0x00000100;   const ACE4_DELETE               = 0x00010000;   const ACE4_READ_ACL             = 0x00020000;   const ACE4_WRITE_ACL            = 0x00040000;   const ACE4_WRITE_OWNER          = 0x00080000;   const ACE4_SYNCHRONIZE          = 0x00100000;   Server implementations need not provide the granularity of control   that is implied by this list of masks.  For example, POSIX-based   systems might not distinguish APPEND_DATA (the ability to append to a   file) from WRITE_DATA (the ability to modify existing contents); both   masks would be tied to a single "write" permission.  When such a   server returns attributes to the client, it would show both   APPEND_DATA and WRITE_DATA if and only if the write permission is   enabled.   If a server receives a SETATTR request that it cannot accurately   implement, it should error in the direction of more restricted   access.  For example, suppose a server cannot distinguish overwriting   data from appending new data, as described in the previous paragraph.   If a client submits an ACE where APPEND_DATA is set but WRITE_DATA is   not (or vice versa), the server should reject the request with   NFS4ERR_ATTRNOTSUPP.  Nonetheless, if the ACE has type DENY, the   server may silently turn on the other bit, so that both APPEND_DATA   and WRITE_DATA are denied.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 53]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20035.11.3.  ACE flag   The "flag" field contains values based on the following descriptions.   ACE4_FILE_INHERIT_ACE      Can be placed on a directory and indicates that this ACE should be      added to each new non-directory file created.   ACE4_DIRECTORY_INHERIT_ACE      Can be placed on a directory and indicates that this ACE should be      added to each new directory created.   ACE4_INHERIT_ONLY_ACE      Can be placed on a directory but does not apply to the directory,      only to newly created files/directories as specified by the above      two flags.   ACE4_NO_PROPAGATE_INHERIT_ACE      Can be placed on a directory.  Normally when a new directory is      created and an ACE exists on the parent directory which is marked      ACL4_DIRECTORY_INHERIT_ACE, two ACEs are placed on the new      directory.  One for the directory itself and one which is an      inheritable ACE for newly created directories.  This flag tells      the server to not place an ACE on the newly created directory      which is inheritable by subdirectories of the created directory.   ACE4_SUCCESSFUL_ACCESS_ACE_FLAG   ACL4_FAILED_ACCESS_ACE_FLAG      The ACE4_SUCCESSFUL_ACCESS_ACE_FLAG (SUCCESS) and      ACE4_FAILED_ACCESS_ACE_FLAG (FAILED) flag bits relate only to      ACE4_SYSTEM_AUDIT_ACE_TYPE (AUDIT) and ACE4_SYSTEM_ALARM_ACE_TYPE      (ALARM) ACE types.  If during the processing of the file's ACL,      the server encounters an AUDIT or ALARM ACE that matches the      principal attempting the OPEN, the server notes that fact, and the      presence, if any, of the SUCCESS and FAILED flags encountered in      the AUDIT or ALARM ACE.  Once the server completes the ACL      processing, and the share reservation processing, and the OPEN      call, it then notes if the OPEN succeeded or failed.  If the OPEN      succeeded, and if the SUCCESS flag was set for a matching AUDIT or      ALARM, then the appropriate AUDIT or ALARM event occurs.  If the      OPEN failed, and if the FAILED flag was set for the matching AUDIT      or ALARM, then the appropriate AUDIT or ALARM event occurs.      Clearly either or both of the SUCCESS or FAILED can be set, but if      neither is set, the AUDIT or ALARM ACE is not useful.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 54]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003      The previously described processing applies to that of the ACCESS      operation as well.  The difference being that "success" or      "failure" does not mean whether ACCESS returns NFS4_OK or not.      Success means whether ACCESS returns all requested and supported      bits.  Failure means whether ACCESS failed to return a bit that      was requested and supported.   ACE4_IDENTIFIER_GROUP      Indicates that the "who" refers to a GROUP as defined under UNIX.   The bitmask constants used for the flag field are as follows:   const ACE4_FILE_INHERIT_ACE             = 0x00000001;   const ACE4_DIRECTORY_INHERIT_ACE        = 0x00000002;   const ACE4_NO_PROPAGATE_INHERIT_ACE     = 0x00000004;   const ACE4_INHERIT_ONLY_ACE             = 0x00000008;   const ACE4_SUCCESSFUL_ACCESS_ACE_FLAG   = 0x00000010;   const ACE4_FAILED_ACCESS_ACE_FLAG       = 0x00000020;   const ACE4_IDENTIFIER_GROUP             = 0x00000040;   A server need not support any of these flags.  If the server supports   flags that are similar to, but not exactly the same as, these flags,   the implementation may define a mapping between the protocol-defined   flags and the implementation-defined flags.  Again, the guiding   principle is that the file not appear to be more secure than it   really is.   For example, suppose a client tries to set an ACE with   ACE4_FILE_INHERIT_ACE set but not ACE4_DIRECTORY_INHERIT_ACE.  If the   server does not support any form of ACL inheritance, the server   should reject the request with NFS4ERR_ATTRNOTSUPP.  If the server   supports a single "inherit ACE" flag that applies to both files and   directories, the server may reject the request (i.e., requiring the   client to set both the file and directory inheritance flags).  The   server may also accept the request and silently turn on the   ACE4_DIRECTORY_INHERIT_ACE flag.5.11.4.  ACE who   There are several special identifiers ("who") which need to be   understood universally, rather than in the context of a particular   DNS domain.  Some of these identifiers cannot be understood when an   NFS client accesses the server, but have meaning when a local process   accesses the file.  The ability to display and modify these   permissions is permitted over NFS, even if none of the access methods   on the server understands the identifiers.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 55]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   Who                    Description   _______________________________________________________________   "OWNER"                The owner of the file.   "GROUP"                The group associated with the file.   "EVERYONE"             The world.   "INTERACTIVE"          Accessed from an interactive terminal.   "NETWORK"              Accessed via the network.   "DIALUP"               Accessed as a dialup user to the server.   "BATCH"                Accessed from a batch job.   "ANONYMOUS"            Accessed without any authentication.   "AUTHENTICATED"        Any authenticated user (opposite of                          ANONYMOUS)   "SERVICE"              Access from a system service.   To avoid conflict, these special identifiers are distinguish by an   appended "@" and should appear in the form "xxxx@" (note: no domain   name after the "@").  For example: ANONYMOUS@.5.11.5.  Mode Attribute   The NFS version 4 mode attribute is based on the UNIX mode bits.  The   following bits are defined:      const MODE4_SUID = 0x800;  /* set user id on execution */      const MODE4_SGID = 0x400;  /* set group id on execution */      const MODE4_SVTX = 0x200;  /* save text even after use */      const MODE4_RUSR = 0x100;  /* read permission: owner */      const MODE4_WUSR = 0x080;  /* write permission: owner */      const MODE4_XUSR = 0x040;  /* execute permission: owner */      const MODE4_RGRP = 0x020;  /* read permission: group */      const MODE4_WGRP = 0x010;  /* write permission: group */      const MODE4_XGRP = 0x008;  /* execute permission: group */      const MODE4_ROTH = 0x004;  /* read permission: other */      const MODE4_WOTH = 0x002;  /* write permission: other */      const MODE4_XOTH = 0x001;  /* execute permission: other */   Bits MODE4_RUSR, MODE4_WUSR, and MODE4_XUSR apply to the principal   identified in the owner attribute.  Bits MODE4_RGRP, MODE4_WGRP, and   MODE4_XGRP apply to the principals identified in the owner_group   attribute.  Bits MODE4_ROTH, MODE4_WOTH, MODE4_XOTH apply to any   principal that does not match that in the owner group, and does not   have a group matching that of the owner_group attribute.   The remaining bits are not defined by this protocol and MUST NOT be   used.  The minor version mechanism must be used to define further bit   usage.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 56]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   Note that in UNIX, if a file has the MODE4_SGID bit set and no   MODE4_XGRP bit set, then READ and WRITE must use mandatory file   locking.5.11.6.  Mode and ACL Attribute   The server that supports both mode and ACL must take care to   synchronize the MODE4_*USR, MODE4_*GRP, and MODE4_*OTH bits with the   ACEs which have respective who fields of "OWNER@", "GROUP@", and   "EVERYONE@" so that the client can see semantically equivalent access   permissions exist whether the client asks for owner, owner_group and   mode attributes, or for just the ACL.   Because the mode attribute includes bits (e.g., MODE4_SVTX) that have   nothing to do with ACL semantics, it is permitted for clients to   specify both the ACL attribute and mode in the same SETATTR   operation.  However, because there is no prescribed order for   processing the attributes in a SETATTR, the client must ensure that   ACL attribute, if specified without mode, would produce the desired   mode bits, and conversely, the mode attribute if specified without   ACL, would produce the desired "OWNER@", "GROUP@", and "EVERYONE@"   ACEs.5.11.7.  mounted_on_fileid   UNIX-based operating environments connect a filesystem into the   namespace by connecting (mounting) the filesystem onto the existing   file object (the mount point, usually a directory) of an existing   filesystem.  When the mount point's parent directory is read via an   API like readdir(), the return results are directory entries, each   with a component name and a fileid.  The fileid of the mount point's   directory entry will be different from the fileid that the stat()   system call returns.  The stat() system call is returning the fileid   of the root of the mounted filesystem, whereas readdir() is returning   the fileid stat() would have returned before any filesystems were   mounted on the mount point.   Unlike NFS version 3, NFS version 4 allows a client's LOOKUP request   to cross other filesystems.  The client detects the filesystem   crossing whenever the filehandle argument of LOOKUP has an fsid   attribute different from that of the filehandle returned by LOOKUP.   A UNIX-based client will consider this a "mount point crossing".   UNIX has a legacy scheme for allowing a process to determine its   current working directory.  This relies on readdir() of a mount   point's parent and stat() of the mount point returning fileids as   previously described.  The mounted_on_fileid attribute corresponds to   the fileid that readdir() would have returned as described   previously.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 57]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   While the NFS version 4 client could simply fabricate a fileid   corresponding to what mounted_on_fileid provides (and if the server   does not support mounted_on_fileid, the client has no choice), there   is a risk that the client will generate a fileid that conflicts with   one that is already assigned to another object in the filesystem.   Instead, if the server can provide the mounted_on_fileid, the   potential for client operational problems in this area is eliminated.   If the server detects that there is no mounted point at the target   file object, then the value for mounted_on_fileid that it returns is   the same as that of the fileid attribute.   The mounted_on_fileid attribute is RECOMMENDED, so the server SHOULD   provide it if possible, and for a UNIX-based server, this is   straightforward.  Usually, mounted_on_fileid will be requested during   a READDIR operation, in which case it is trivial (at least for UNIX-   based servers) to return mounted_on_fileid since it is equal to the   fileid of a directory entry returned by readdir().  If   mounted_on_fileid is requested in a GETATTR operation, the server   should obey an invariant that has it returning a value that is equal   to the file object's entry in the object's parent directory, i.e.,   what readdir() would have returned.  Some operating environments   allow a series of two or more filesystems to be mounted onto a single   mount point.  In this case, for the server to obey the aforementioned   invariant, it will need to find the base mount point, and not the   intermediate mount points.6.  Filesystem Migration and Replication   With the use of the recommended attribute "fs_locations", the NFS   version 4 server has a method of providing filesystem migration or   replication services.  For the purposes of migration and replication,   a filesystem will be defined as all files that share a given fsid   (both major and minor values are the same).   The fs_locations attribute provides a list of filesystem locations.   These locations are specified by providing the server name (either   DNS domain or IP address) and the path name representing the root of   the filesystem.  Depending on the type of service being provided, the   list will provide a new location or a set of alternate locations for   the filesystem.  The client will use this information to redirect its   requests to the new server.6.1.  Replication   It is expected that filesystem replication will be used in the case   of read-only data.  Typically, the filesystem will be replicated on   two or more servers.  The fs_locations attribute will provide theShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 58]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   list of these locations to the client.  On first access of the   filesystem, the client should obtain the value of the fs_locations   attribute.  If, in the future, the client finds the server   unresponsive, the client may attempt to use another server specified   by fs_locations.   If applicable, the client must take the appropriate steps to recover   valid filehandles from the new server.  This is described in more   detail in the following sections.6.2.  Migration   Filesystem migration is used to move a filesystem from one server to   another.  Migration is typically used for a filesystem that is   writable and has a single copy.  The expected use of migration is for   load balancing or general resource reallocation.  The protocol does   not specify how the filesystem will be moved between servers.  This   server-to-server transfer mechanism is left to the server   implementor.  However, the method used to communicate the migration   event between client and server is specified here.   Once the servers participating in the migration have completed the   move of the filesystem, the error NFS4ERR_MOVED will be returned for   subsequent requests received by the original server.  The   NFS4ERR_MOVED error is returned for all operations except PUTFH and   GETATTR.  Upon receiving the NFS4ERR_MOVED error, the client will   obtain the value of the fs_locations attribute.  The client will then   use the contents of the attribute to redirect its requests to the   specified server.  To facilitate the use of GETATTR, operations such   as PUTFH must also be accepted by the server for the migrated file   system's filehandles.  Note that if the server returns NFS4ERR_MOVED,   the server MUST support the fs_locations attribute.   If the client requests more attributes than just fs_locations, the   server may return fs_locations only.  This is to be expected since   the server has migrated the filesystem and may not have a method of   obtaining additional attribute data.   The server implementor needs to be careful in developing a migration   solution.  The server must consider all of the state information   clients may have outstanding at the server.  This includes but is not   limited to locking/share state, delegation state, and asynchronous   file writes which are represented by WRITE and COMMIT verifiers.  The   server should strive to minimize the impact on its clients during and   after the migration process.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 59]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20036.3.  Interpretation of the fs_locations Attribute   The fs_location attribute is structured in the following way:   struct fs_location {           utf8str_cis     server<>;           pathname4       rootpath;   };   struct fs_locations {           pathname4       fs_root;           fs_location     locations<>;   };   The fs_location struct is used to represent the location of a   filesystem by providing a server name and the path to the root of the   filesystem.  For a multi-homed server or a set of servers that use   the same rootpath, an array of server names may be provided.  An   entry in the server array is an UTF8 string and represents one of a   traditional DNS host name, IPv4 address, or IPv6 address.  It is not   a requirement that all servers that share the same rootpath be listed   in one fs_location struct.  The array of server names is provided for   convenience.  Servers that share the same rootpath may also be listed   in separate fs_location entries in the fs_locations attribute.   The fs_locations struct and attribute then contains an array of   locations.  Since the name space of each server may be constructed   differently, the "fs_root" field is provided.  The path represented   by fs_root represents the location of the filesystem in the server's   name space.  Therefore, the fs_root path is only associated with the   server from which the fs_locations attribute was obtained.  The   fs_root path is meant to aid the client in locating the filesystem at   the various servers listed.   As an example, there is a replicated filesystem located at two   servers (servA and servB).  At servA the filesystem is located at   path "/a/b/c".  At servB the filesystem is located at path "/x/y/z".   In this example the client accesses the filesystem first at servA   with a multi-component lookup path of "/a/b/c/d".  Since the client   used a multi-component lookup to obtain the filehandle at "/a/b/c/d",   it is unaware that the filesystem's root is located in servA's name   space at "/a/b/c".  When the client switches to servB, it will need   to determine that the directory it first referenced at servA is now   represented by the path "/x/y/z/d" on servB.  To facilitate this, the   fs_locations attribute provided by servA would have a fs_root value   of "/a/b/c" and two entries in fs_location.  One entry in fs_location   will be for itself (servA) and the other will be for servB with aShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 60]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   path of "/x/y/z".  With this information, the client is able to   substitute "/x/y/z" for the "/a/b/c" at the beginning of its access   path and construct "/x/y/z/d" to use for the new server.   See the section "Security Considerations" for a discussion on the   recommendations for the security flavor to be used by any GETATTR   operation that requests the "fs_locations" attribute.6.4.  Filehandle Recovery for Migration or Replication   Filehandles for filesystems that are replicated or migrated generally   have the same semantics as for filesystems that are not replicated or   migrated.  For example, if a filesystem has persistent filehandles   and it is migrated to another server, the filehandle values for the   filesystem will be valid at the new server.   For volatile filehandles, the servers involved likely do not have a   mechanism to transfer filehandle format and content between   themselves.  Therefore, a server may have difficulty in determining   if a volatile filehandle from an old server should return an error of   NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED.  Therefore, the client is informed, with the use   of the fh_expire_type attribute, whether volatile filehandles will   expire at the migration or replication event.  If the bit   FH4_VOL_MIGRATION is set in the fh_expire_type attribute, the client   must treat the volatile filehandle as if the server had returned the   NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED error.  At the migration or replication event in   the presence of the FH4_VOL_MIGRATION bit, the client will not   present the original or old volatile filehandle to the new server.   The client will start its communication with the new server by   recovering its filehandles using the saved file names.7.  NFS Server Name Space7.1.  Server Exports   On a UNIX server the name space describes all the files reachable by   pathnames under the root directory or "/".  On a Windows NT server   the name space constitutes all the files on disks named by mapped   disk letters.  NFS server administrators rarely make the entire   server's filesystem name space available to NFS clients.  More often   portions of the name space are made available via an "export"   feature.  In previous versions of the NFS protocol, the root   filehandle for each export is obtained through the MOUNT protocol;   the client sends a string that identifies the export of name space   and the server returns the root filehandle for it.  The MOUNT   protocol supports an EXPORTS procedure that will enumerate the   server's exports.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 61]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20037.2.  Browsing Exports   The NFS version 4 protocol provides a root filehandle that clients   can use to obtain filehandles for these exports via a multi-component   LOOKUP.  A common user experience is to use a graphical user   interface (perhaps a file "Open" dialog window) to find a file via   progressive browsing through a directory tree.  The client must be   able to move from one export to another export via single-component,   progressive LOOKUP operations.   This style of browsing is not well supported by the NFS version 2 and   3 protocols.  The client expects all LOOKUP operations to remain   within a single server filesystem.  For example, the device attribute   will not change.  This prevents a client from taking name space paths   that span exports.   An automounter on the client can obtain a snapshot of the server's   name space using the EXPORTS procedure of the MOUNT protocol.  If it   understands the server's pathname syntax, it can create an image of   the server's name space on the client.  The parts of the name space   that are not exported by the server are filled in with a "pseudo   filesystem" that allows the user to browse from one mounted   filesystem to another.  There is a drawback to this representation of   the server's name space on the client: it is static.  If the server   administrator adds a new export the client will be unaware of it.7.3.  Server Pseudo Filesystem   NFS version 4 servers avoid this name space inconsistency by   presenting all the exports within the framework of a single server   name space.  An NFS version 4 client uses LOOKUP and READDIR   operations to browse seamlessly from one export to another.  Portions   of the server name space that are not exported are bridged via a   "pseudo filesystem" that provides a view of exported directories   only.  A pseudo filesystem has a unique fsid and behaves like a   normal, read only filesystem.   Based on the construction of the server's name space, it is possible   that multiple pseudo filesystems may exist.  For example,   /a         pseudo filesystem   /a/b       real filesystem   /a/b/c     pseudo filesystem   /a/b/c/d   real filesystem   Each of the pseudo filesystems are considered separate entities and   therefore will have a unique fsid.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 62]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20037.4.  Multiple Roots   The DOS and Windows operating environments are sometimes described as   having "multiple roots".  Filesystems are commonly represented as   disk letters.  MacOS represents filesystems as top level names.  NFS   version 4 servers for these platforms can construct a pseudo file   system above these root names so that disk letters or volume names   are simply directory names in the pseudo root.7.5.  Filehandle Volatility   The nature of the server's pseudo filesystem is that it is a logical   representation of filesystem(s) available from the server.   Therefore, the pseudo filesystem is most likely constructed   dynamically when the server is first instantiated.  It is expected   that the pseudo filesystem may not have an on disk counterpart from   which persistent filehandles could be constructed.  Even though it is   preferable that the server provide persistent filehandles for the   pseudo filesystem, the NFS client should expect that pseudo file   system filehandles are volatile.  This can be confirmed by checking   the associated "fh_expire_type" attribute for those filehandles in   question.  If the filehandles are volatile, the NFS client must be   prepared to recover a filehandle value (e.g., with a multi-component   LOOKUP) when receiving an error of NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED.7.6.  Exported Root   If the server's root filesystem is exported, one might conclude that   a pseudo-filesystem is not needed.  This would be wrong.  Assume the   following filesystems on a server:         /       disk1  (exported)         /a      disk2  (not exported)         /a/b    disk3  (exported)   Because disk2 is not exported, disk3 cannot be reached with simple   LOOKUPs.  The server must bridge the gap with a pseudo-filesystem.7.7.  Mount Point Crossing   The server filesystem environment may be constructed in such a way   that one filesystem contains a directory which is 'covered' or   mounted upon by a second filesystem.  For example:         /a/b            (filesystem 1)         /a/b/c/d        (filesystem 2)Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 63]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   The pseudo filesystem for this server may be constructed to look   like:         /               (place holder/not exported)         /a/b            (filesystem 1)         /a/b/c/d        (filesystem 2)   It is the server's responsibility to present the pseudo filesystem   that is complete to the client.  If the client sends a lookup request   for the path "/a/b/c/d", the server's response is the filehandle of   the filesystem "/a/b/c/d".  In previous versions of the NFS protocol,   the server would respond with the filehandle of directory "/a/b/c/d"   within the filesystem "/a/b".   The NFS client will be able to determine if it crosses a server mount   point by a change in the value of the "fsid" attribute.7.8.  Security Policy and Name Space Presentation   The application of the server's security policy needs to be carefully   considered by the implementor.  One may choose to limit the   viewability of portions of the pseudo filesystem based on the   server's perception of the client's ability to authenticate itself   properly.  However, with the support of multiple security mechanisms   and the ability to negotiate the appropriate use of these mechanisms,   the server is unable to properly determine if a client will be able   to authenticate itself.  If, based on its policies, the server   chooses to limit the contents of the pseudo filesystem, the server   may effectively hide filesystems from a client that may otherwise   have legitimate access.   As suggested practice, the server should apply the security policy of   a shared resource in the server's namespace to the components of the   resource's ancestors.  For example:         /         /a/b         /a/b/c   The /a/b/c directory is a real filesystem and is the shared resource.   The security policy for /a/b/c is Kerberos with integrity.  The   server should apply the same security policy to /, /a, and /a/b.   This allows for the extension of the protection of the server's   namespace to the ancestors of the real shared resource.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 64]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   For the case of the use of multiple, disjoint security mechanisms in   the server's resources, the security for a particular object in the   server's namespace should be the union of all security mechanisms of   all direct descendants.8.  File Locking and Share Reservations   Integrating locking into the NFS protocol necessarily causes it to be   stateful.  With the inclusion of share reservations the protocol   becomes substantially more dependent on state than the traditional   combination of NFS and NLM [XNFS].  There are three components to   making this state manageable:   o  Clear division between client and server   o  Ability to reliably detect inconsistency in state between client      and server   o  Simple and robust recovery mechanisms   In this model, the server owns the state information.  The client   communicates its view of this state to the server as needed.  The   client is also able to detect inconsistent state before modifying a   file.   To support Win32 share reservations it is necessary to atomically   OPEN or CREATE files.  Having a separate share/unshare operation   would not allow correct implementation of the Win32 OpenFile API.  In   order to correctly implement share semantics, the previous NFS   protocol mechanisms used when a file is opened or created (LOOKUP,   CREATE, ACCESS) need to be replaced.  The NFS version 4 protocol has   an OPEN operation that subsumes the NFS version 3 methodology of   LOOKUP, CREATE, and ACCESS.  However, because many operations require   a filehandle, the traditional LOOKUP is preserved to map a file name   to filehandle without establishing state on the server.  The policy   of granting access or modifying files is managed by the server based   on the client's state.  These mechanisms can implement policy ranging   from advisory only locking to full mandatory locking.8.1.  Locking   It is assumed that manipulating a lock is rare when compared to READ   and WRITE operations.  It is also assumed that crashes and network   partitions are relatively rare.  Therefore it is important that the   READ and WRITE operations have a lightweight mechanism to indicate if   they possess a held lock.  A lock request contains the heavyweight   information required to establish a lock and uniquely define the lock   owner.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 65]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   The following sections describe the transition from the heavy weight   information to the eventual stateid used for most client and server   locking and lease interactions.8.1.1.  Client ID   For each LOCK request, the client must identify itself to the server.   This is done in such a way as to allow for correct lock   identification and crash recovery.  A sequence of a SETCLIENTID   operation followed by a SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM operation is required to   establish the identification onto the server.  Establishment of   identification by a new incarnation of the client also has the effect   of immediately breaking any leased state that a previous incarnation   of the client might have had on the server, as opposed to forcing the   new client incarnation to wait for the leases to expire.  Breaking   the lease state amounts to the server removing all lock, share   reservation, and, where the server is not supporting the   CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV claim type, all delegation state associated with   same client with the same identity.  For discussion of delegation   state recovery, see the section "Delegation Recovery".   Client identification is encapsulated in the following structure:         struct nfs_client_id4 {                 verifier4     verifier;                 opaque        id<NFS4_OPAQUE_LIMIT>;         };   The first field, verifier is a client incarnation verifier that is   used to detect client reboots.  Only if the verifier is different   from that which the server has previously recorded the client (as   identified by the second field of the structure, id) does the server   start the process of canceling the client's leased state.   The second field, id is a variable length string that uniquely   defines the client.   There are several considerations for how the client generates the id   string:   o  The string should be unique so that multiple clients do not      present the same string.  The consequences of two clients      presenting the same string range from one client getting an error      to one client having its leased state abruptly and unexpectedly      canceled.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 66]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   o  The string should be selected so the subsequent incarnations      (e.g., reboots) of the same client cause the client to present the      same string.  The implementor is cautioned against an approach      that requires the string to be recorded in a local file because      this precludes the use of the implementation in an environment      where there is no local disk and all file access is from an NFS      version 4 server.   o  The string should be different for each server network address      that the client accesses, rather than common to all server network      addresses.  The reason is that it may not be possible for the      client to tell if the same server is listening on multiple network      addresses.  If the client issues SETCLIENTID with the same id      string to each network address of such a server, the server will      think it is the same client, and each successive SETCLIENTID will      cause the server to begin the process of removing the client's      previous leased state.   o  The algorithm for generating the string should not assume that the      client's network address won't change.  This includes changes      between client incarnations and even changes while the client is      stilling running in its current incarnation.  This means that if      the client includes just the client's and server's network address      in the id string, there is a real risk, after the client gives up      the network address, that another client, using a similar      algorithm for generating the id string, will generate a      conflicting id string.   Given the above considerations, an example of a well generated id   string is one that includes:   o  The server's network address.   o  The client's network address.   o  For a user level NFS version 4 client, it should contain      additional information to distinguish the client from other user      level clients running on the same host, such as a process id or      other unique sequence.   o  Additional information that tends to be unique, such as one or      more of:      -  The client machine's serial number (for privacy reasons, it is         best to perform some one way function on the serial number).      -  A MAC address.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 67]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003      -  The timestamp of when the NFS version 4 software was first         installed on the client (though this is subject to the         previously mentioned caution about using information that is         stored in a file, because the file might only be accessible         over NFS version 4).      -  A true random number.  However since this number ought to be         the same between client incarnations, this shares the same         problem as that of the using the timestamp of the software         installation.   As a security measure, the server MUST NOT cancel a client's leased   state if the principal established the state for a given id string is   not the same as the principal issuing the SETCLIENTID.   Note that SETCLIENTID and SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM has a secondary purpose   of establishing the information the server needs to make callbacks to   the client for purpose of supporting delegations.  It is permitted to   change this information via SETCLIENTID and SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM   within the same incarnation of the client without removing the   client's leased state.   Once a SETCLIENTID and SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM sequence has successfully   completed, the client uses the shorthand client identifier, of type   clientid4, instead of the longer and less compact nfs_client_id4   structure.  This shorthand client identifier (a clientid) is assigned   by the server and should be chosen so that it will not conflict with   a clientid previously assigned by the server.  This applies across   server restarts or reboots.  When a clientid is presented to a server   and that clientid is not recognized, as would happen after a server   reboot, the server will reject the request with the error   NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID.  When this happens, the client must obtain a   new clientid by use of the SETCLIENTID operation and then proceed to   any other necessary recovery for the server reboot case (See the   section "Server Failure and Recovery").   The client must also employ the SETCLIENTID operation when it   receives a NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID error using a stateid derived from   its current clientid, since this also indicates a server reboot which   has invalidated the existing clientid (see the next section   "lock_owner and stateid Definition" for details).   See the detailed descriptions of SETCLIENTID and SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM   for a complete specification of the operations.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 68]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20038.1.2.  Server Release of Clientid   If the server determines that the client holds no associated state   for its clientid, the server may choose to release the clientid.  The   server may make this choice for an inactive client so that resources   are not consumed by those intermittently active clients.  If the   client contacts the server after this release, the server must ensure   the client receives the appropriate error so that it will use the   SETCLIENTID/SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM sequence to establish a new identity.   It should be clear that the server must be very hesitant to release a   clientid since the resulting work on the client to recover from such   an event will be the same burden as if the server had failed and   restarted.  Typically a server would not release a clientid unless   there had been no activity from that client for many minutes.   Note that if the id string in a SETCLIENTID request is properly   constructed, and if the client takes care to use the same principal   for each successive use of SETCLIENTID, then, barring an active   denial of service attack, NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE should never be   returned.   However, client bugs, server bugs, or perhaps a deliberate change of   the principal owner of the id string (such as the case of a client   that changes security flavors, and under the new flavor, there is no   mapping to the previous owner) will in rare cases result in   NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE.   In that event, when the server gets a SETCLIENTID for a client id   that currently has no state, or it has state, but the lease has   expired, rather than returning NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE, the server MUST   allow the SETCLIENTID, and confirm the new clientid if followed by   the appropriate SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM.8.1.3.  lock_owner and stateid Definition   When requesting a lock, the client must present to the server the   clientid and an identifier for the owner of the requested lock.   These two fields are referred to as the lock_owner and the definition   of those fields are:   o  A clientid returned by the server as part of the client's use of      the SETCLIENTID operation.   o  A variable length opaque array used to uniquely define the owner      of a lock managed by the client.      This may be a thread id, process id, or other unique value.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 69]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   When the server grants the lock, it responds with a unique stateid.   The stateid is used as a shorthand reference to the lock_owner, since   the server will be maintaining the correspondence between them.   The server is free to form the stateid in any manner that it chooses   as long as it is able to recognize invalid and out-of-date stateids.   This requirement includes those stateids generated by earlier   instances of the server.  From this, the client can be properly   notified of a server restart.  This notification will occur when the   client presents a stateid to the server from a previous   instantiation.   The server must be able to distinguish the following situations and   return the error as specified:   o  The stateid was generated by an earlier server instance (i.e.,      before a server reboot).  The error NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID should      be returned.   o  The stateid was generated by the current server instance but the      stateid no longer designates the current locking state for the      lockowner-file pair in question (i.e., one or more locking      operations has occurred).  The error NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID should be      returned.      This error condition will only occur when the client issues a      locking request which changes a stateid while an I/O request that      uses that stateid is outstanding.   o  The stateid was generated by the current server instance but the      stateid does not designate a locking state for any active      lockowner-file pair.  The error NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID should be      returned.      This error condition will occur when there has been a logic error      on the part of the client or server.  This should not happen.   One mechanism that may be used to satisfy these requirements is for   the server to,   o  divide the "other" field of each stateid into two fields:      -  A server verifier which uniquely designates a particular server         instantiation.      -  An index into a table of locking-state structures.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 70]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   o  utilize the "seqid" field of each stateid, such that seqid is      monotonically incremented for each stateid that is associated with      the same index into the locking-state table.   By matching the incoming stateid and its field values with the state   held at the server, the server is able to easily determine if a   stateid is valid for its current instantiation and state.  If the   stateid is not valid, the appropriate error can be supplied to the   client.8.1.4.  Use of the stateid and Locking   All READ, WRITE and SETATTR operations contain a stateid.  For the   purposes of this section, SETATTR operations which change the size   attribute of a file are treated as if they are writing the area   between the old and new size (i.e., the range truncated or added to   the file by means of the SETATTR), even where SETATTR is not   explicitly mentioned in the text.   If the lock_owner performs a READ or WRITE in a situation in which it   has established a lock or share reservation on the server (any OPEN   constitutes a share reservation) the stateid (previously returned by   the server) must be used to indicate what locks, including both   record locks and share reservations, are held by the lockowner.  If   no state is established by the client, either record lock or share   reservation, a stateid of all bits 0 is used.  Regardless whether a   stateid of all bits 0, or a stateid returned by the server is used,   if there is a conflicting share reservation or mandatory record lock   held on the file, the server MUST refuse to service the READ or WRITE   operation.   Share reservations are established by OPEN operations and by their   nature are mandatory in that when the OPEN denies READ or WRITE   operations, that denial results in such operations being rejected   with error NFS4ERR_LOCKED.  Record locks may be implemented by the   server as either mandatory or advisory, or the choice of mandatory or   advisory behavior may be determined by the server on the basis of the   file being accessed (for example, some UNIX-based servers support a   "mandatory lock bit" on the mode attribute such that if set, record   locks are required on the file before I/O is possible).  When record   locks are advisory, they only prevent the granting of conflicting   lock requests and have no effect on READs or WRITEs.  Mandatory   record locks, however, prevent conflicting I/O operations.  When they   are attempted, they are rejected with NFS4ERR_LOCKED.  When the   client gets NFS4ERR_LOCKED on a file it knows it has the proper share   reservation for, it will need to issue a LOCK request on the regionShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 71]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   of the file that includes the region the I/O was to be performed on,   with an appropriate locktype (i.e., READ*_LT for a READ operation,   WRITE*_LT for a WRITE operation).   With NFS version 3, there was no notion of a stateid so there was no   way to tell if the application process of the client sending the READ   or WRITE operation had also acquired the appropriate record lock on   the file.  Thus there was no way to implement mandatory locking.   With the stateid construct, this barrier has been removed.   Note that for UNIX environments that support mandatory file locking,   the distinction between advisory and mandatory locking is subtle.  In   fact, advisory and mandatory record locks are exactly the same in so   far as the APIs and requirements on implementation.  If the mandatory   lock attribute is set on the file, the server checks to see if the   lockowner has an appropriate shared (read) or exclusive (write)   record lock on the region it wishes to read or write to.  If there is   no appropriate lock, the server checks if there is a conflicting lock   (which can be done by attempting to acquire the conflicting lock on   the behalf of the lockowner, and if successful, release the lock   after the READ or WRITE is done), and if there is, the server returns   NFS4ERR_LOCKED.   For Windows environments, there are no advisory record locks, so the   server always checks for record locks during I/O requests.   Thus, the NFS version 4 LOCK operation does not need to distinguish   between advisory and mandatory record locks.  It is the NFS version 4   server's processing of the READ and WRITE operations that introduces   the distinction.   Every stateid other than the special stateid values noted in this   section, whether returned by an OPEN-type operation (i.e., OPEN,   OPEN_DOWNGRADE), or by a LOCK-type operation (i.e., LOCK or LOCKU),   defines an access mode for the file (i.e., READ, WRITE, or READ-   WRITE) as established by the original OPEN which began the stateid   sequence, and as modified by subsequent OPENs and OPEN_DOWNGRADEs   within that stateid sequence.  When a READ, WRITE, or SETATTR which   specifies the size attribute, is done, the operation is subject to   checking against the access mode to verify that the operation is   appropriate given the OPEN with which the operation is associated.   In the case of WRITE-type operations (i.e., WRITEs and SETATTRs which   set size), the server must verify that the access mode allows writing   and return an NFS4ERR_OPENMODE error if it does not.  In the case, of   READ, the server may perform the corresponding check on the access   mode, or it may choose to allow READ on opens for WRITE only, to   accommodate clients whose write implementation may unavoidably doShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 72]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   reads (e.g., due to buffer cache constraints).  However, even if   READs are allowed in these circumstances, the server MUST still check   for locks that conflict with the READ (e.g., another open specify   denial of READs).  Note that a server which does enforce the access   mode check on READs need not explicitly check for conflicting share   reservations since the existence of OPEN for read access guarantees   that no conflicting share reservation can exist.   A stateid of all bits 1 (one) MAY allow READ operations to bypass   locking checks at the server.  However, WRITE operations with a   stateid with bits all 1 (one) MUST NOT bypass locking checks and are   treated exactly the same as if a stateid of all bits 0 were used.   A lock may not be granted while a READ or WRITE operation using one   of the special stateids is being performed and the range of the lock   request conflicts with the range of the READ or WRITE operation.  For   the purposes of this paragraph, a conflict occurs when a shared lock   is requested and a WRITE operation is being performed, or an   exclusive lock is requested and either a READ or a WRITE operation is   being performed.  A SETATTR that sets size is treated similarly to a   WRITE as discussed above.8.1.5.  Sequencing of Lock Requests   Locking is different than most NFS operations as it requires "at-   most-one" semantics that are not provided by ONCRPC.  ONCRPC over a   reliable transport is not sufficient because a sequence of locking   requests may span multiple TCP connections.  In the face of   retransmission or reordering, lock or unlock requests must have a   well defined and consistent behavior.  To accomplish this, each lock   request contains a sequence number that is a consecutively increasing   integer.  Different lock_owners have different sequences.  The server   maintains the last sequence number (L) received and the response that   was returned.  The first request issued for any given lock_owner is   issued with a sequence number of zero.   Note that for requests that contain a sequence number, for each   lock_owner, there should be no more than one outstanding request.   If a request (r) with a previous sequence number (r < L) is received,   it is rejected with the return of error NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQID.  Given a   properly-functioning client, the response to (r) must have been   received before the last request (L) was sent.  If a duplicate of   last request (r == L) is received, the stored response is returned.   If a request beyond the next sequence (r == L + 2) is received, it is   rejected with the return of error NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQID.  Sequence   history is reinitialized whenever the SETCLIENTID/SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM   sequence changes the client verifier.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 73]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   Since the sequence number is represented with an unsigned 32-bit   integer, the arithmetic involved with the sequence number is mod   2^32.  For an example of modulo arithmetic involving sequence numbers   see [RFC793].   It is critical the server maintain the last response sent to the   client to provide a more reliable cache of duplicate non-idempotent   requests than that of the traditional cache described in [Juszczak].   The traditional duplicate request cache uses a least recently used   algorithm for removing unneeded requests.  However, the last lock   request and response on a given lock_owner must be cached as long as   the lock state exists on the server.   The client MUST monotonically increment the sequence number for the   CLOSE, LOCK, LOCKU, OPEN, OPEN_CONFIRM, and OPEN_DOWNGRADE   operations.  This is true even in the event that the previous   operation that used the sequence number received an error.  The only   exception to this rule is if the previous operation received one of   the following errors: NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID, NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID,   NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID, NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQID, NFS4ERR_BADXDR,   NFS4ERR_RESOURCE, NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE.8.1.6.  Recovery from Replayed Requests   As described above, the sequence number is per lock_owner.  As long   as the server maintains the last sequence number received and follows   the methods described above, there are no risks of a Byzantine router   re-sending old requests.  The server need only maintain the   (lock_owner, sequence number) state as long as there are open files   or closed files with locks outstanding.   LOCK, LOCKU, OPEN, OPEN_DOWNGRADE, and CLOSE each contain a sequence   number and therefore the risk of the replay of these operations   resulting in undesired effects is non-existent while the server   maintains the lock_owner state.8.1.7.  Releasing lock_owner State   When a particular lock_owner no longer holds open or file locking   state at the server, the server may choose to release the sequence   number state associated with the lock_owner.  The server may make   this choice based on lease expiration, for the reclamation of server   memory, or other implementation specific details.  In any event, the   server is able to do this safely only when the lock_owner no longer   is being utilized by the client.  The server may choose to hold the   lock_owner state in the event that retransmitted requests are   received.  However, the period to hold this state is implementation   specific.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 74]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   In the case that a LOCK, LOCKU, OPEN_DOWNGRADE, or CLOSE is   retransmitted after the server has previously released the lock_owner   state, the server will find that the lock_owner has no files open and   an error will be returned to the client.  If the lock_owner does have   a file open, the stateid will not match and again an error is   returned to the client.8.1.8.  Use of Open Confirmation   In the case that an OPEN is retransmitted and the lock_owner is being   used for the first time or the lock_owner state has been previously   released by the server, the use of the OPEN_CONFIRM operation will   prevent incorrect behavior.  When the server observes the use of the   lock_owner for the first time, it will direct the client to perform   the OPEN_CONFIRM for the corresponding OPEN.  This sequence   establishes the use of an lock_owner and associated sequence number.   Since the OPEN_CONFIRM sequence connects a new open_owner on the   server with an existing open_owner on a client, the sequence number   may have any value.  The OPEN_CONFIRM step assures the server that   the value received is the correct one.  See the section "OPEN_CONFIRM   - Confirm Open" for further details.   There are a number of situations in which the requirement to confirm   an OPEN would pose difficulties for the client and server, in that   they would be prevented from acting in a timely fashion on   information received, because that information would be provisional,   subject to deletion upon non-confirmation.  Fortunately, these are   situations in which the server can avoid the need for confirmation   when responding to open requests.  The two constraints are:   o  The server must not bestow a delegation for any open which would      require confirmation.   o  The server MUST NOT require confirmation on a reclaim-type open      (i.e., one specifying claim type CLAIM_PREVIOUS or      CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV).   These constraints are related in that reclaim-type opens are the only   ones in which the server may be required to send a delegation.  For   CLAIM_NULL, sending the delegation is optional while for   CLAIM_DELEGATE_CUR, no delegation is sent.   Delegations being sent with an open requiring confirmation are   troublesome because recovering from non-confirmation adds undue   complexity to the protocol while requiring confirmation on reclaim-   type opens poses difficulties in that the inability to resolveShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 75]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   the status of the reclaim until lease expiration may make it   difficult to have timely determination of the set of locks being   reclaimed (since the grace period may expire).   Requiring open confirmation on reclaim-type opens is avoidable   because of the nature of the environments in which such opens are   done.  For CLAIM_PREVIOUS opens, this is immediately after server   reboot, so there should be no time for lockowners to be created,   found to be unused, and recycled.  For CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV opens, we   are dealing with a client reboot situation.  A server which supports   delegation can be sure that no lockowners for that client have been   recycled since client initialization and thus can ensure that   confirmation will not be required.8.2.  Lock Ranges   The protocol allows a lock owner to request a lock with a byte range   and then either upgrade or unlock a sub-range of the initial lock.   It is expected that this will be an uncommon type of request.  In any   case, servers or server filesystems may not be able to support sub-   range lock semantics.  In the event that a server receives a locking   request that represents a sub-range of current locking state for the   lock owner, the server is allowed to return the error   NFS4ERR_LOCK_RANGE to signify that it does not support sub-range lock   operations.  Therefore, the client should be prepared to receive this   error and, if appropriate, report the error to the requesting   application.   The client is discouraged from combining multiple independent locking   ranges that happen to be adjacent into a single request since the   server may not support sub-range requests and for reasons related to   the recovery of file locking state in the event of server failure.   As discussed in the section "Server Failure and Recovery" below, the   server may employ certain optimizations during recovery that work   effectively only when the client's behavior during lock recovery is   similar to the client's locking behavior prior to server failure.8.3.  Upgrading and Downgrading Locks   If a client has a write lock on a record, it can request an atomic   downgrade of the lock to a read lock via the LOCK request, by setting   the type to READ_LT.  If the server supports atomic downgrade, the   request will succeed.  If not, it will return NFS4ERR_LOCK_NOTSUPP.   The client should be prepared to receive this error, and if   appropriate, report the error to the requesting application.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 76]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   If a client has a read lock on a record, it can request an atomic   upgrade of the lock to a write lock via the LOCK request by setting   the type to WRITE_LT or WRITEW_LT.  If the server does not support   atomic upgrade, it will return NFS4ERR_LOCK_NOTSUPP.  If the upgrade   can be achieved without an existing conflict, the request will   succeed.  Otherwise, the server will return either NFS4ERR_DENIED or   NFS4ERR_DEADLOCK.  The error NFS4ERR_DEADLOCK is returned if the   client issued the LOCK request with the type set to WRITEW_LT and the   server has detected a deadlock.  The client should be prepared to   receive such errors and if appropriate, report the error to the   requesting application.8.4.  Blocking Locks   Some clients require the support of blocking locks.  The NFS version   4 protocol must not rely on a callback mechanism and therefore is   unable to notify a client when a previously denied lock has been   granted.  Clients have no choice but to continually poll for the   lock.  This presents a fairness problem.  Two new lock types are   added, READW and WRITEW, and are used to indicate to the server that   the client is requesting a blocking lock.  The server should maintain   an ordered list of pending blocking locks.  When the conflicting lock   is released, the server may wait the lease period for the first   waiting client to re-request the lock.  After the lease period   expires the next waiting client request is allowed the lock.  Clients   are required to poll at an interval sufficiently small that it is   likely to acquire the lock in a timely manner.  The server is not   required to maintain a list of pending blocked locks as it is used to   increase fairness and not correct operation.  Because of the   unordered nature of crash recovery, storing of lock state to stable   storage would be required to guarantee ordered granting of blocking   locks.   Servers may also note the lock types and delay returning denial of   the request to allow extra time for a conflicting lock to be   released, allowing a successful return.  In this way, clients can   avoid the burden of needlessly frequent polling for blocking locks.   The server should take care in the length of delay in the event the   client retransmits the request.8.5.  Lease Renewal   The purpose of a lease is to allow a server to remove stale locks   that are held by a client that has crashed or is otherwise   unreachable.  It is not a mechanism for cache consistency and lease   renewals may not be denied if the lease interval has not expired.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 77]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   The following events cause implicit renewal of all of the leases for   a given client (i.e., all those sharing a given clientid).  Each of   these is a positive indication that the client is still active and   that the associated state held at the server, for the client, is   still valid.   o  An OPEN with a valid clientid.   o  Any operation made with a valid stateid (CLOSE, DELEGPURGE,      DELEGRETURN, LOCK, LOCKU, OPEN, OPEN_CONFIRM, OPEN_DOWNGRADE,      READ, RENEW, SETATTR, WRITE).  This does not include the special      stateids of all bits 0 or all bits 1.      Note that if the client had restarted or rebooted, the client      would not be making these requests without issuing the      SETCLIENTID/SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM sequence.  The use of the      SETCLIENTID/SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM sequence (one that changes the      client verifier) notifies the server to drop the locking state      associated with the client.  SETCLIENTID/SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM never      renews a lease.      If the server has rebooted, the stateids (NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID      error) or the clientid (NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID error) will not be      valid hence preventing spurious renewals.   This approach allows for low overhead lease renewal which scales   well.  In the typical case no extra RPC calls are required for lease   renewal and in the worst case one RPC is required every lease period   (i.e., a RENEW operation).  The number of locks held by the client is   not a factor since all state for the client is involved with the   lease renewal action.   Since all operations that create a new lease also renew existing   leases, the server must maintain a common lease expiration time for   all valid leases for a given client.  This lease time can then be   easily updated upon implicit lease renewal actions.8.6.  Crash Recovery   The important requirement in crash recovery is that both the client   and the server know when the other has failed.  Additionally, it is   required that a client sees a consistent view of data across server   restarts or reboots.  All READ and WRITE operations that may have   been queued within the client or network buffers must wait until the   client has successfully recovered the locks protecting the READ and   WRITE operations.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 78]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20038.6.1.  Client Failure and Recovery   In the event that a client fails, the server may recover the client's   locks when the associated leases have expired.  Conflicting locks   from another client may only be granted after this lease expiration.   If the client is able to restart or reinitialize within the lease   period the client may be forced to wait the remainder of the lease   period before obtaining new locks.   To minimize client delay upon restart, lock requests are associated   with an instance of the client by a client supplied verifier.  This   verifier is part of the initial SETCLIENTID call made by the client.   The server returns a clientid as a result of the SETCLIENTID   operation.  The client then confirms the use of the clientid with   SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM.  The clientid in combination with an opaque   owner field is then used by the client to identify the lock owner for   OPEN.  This chain of associations is then used to identify all locks   for a particular client.   Since the verifier will be changed by the client upon each   initialization, the server can compare a new verifier to the verifier   associated with currently held locks and determine that they do not   match.  This signifies the client's new instantiation and subsequent   loss of locking state.  As a result, the server is free to release   all locks held which are associated with the old clientid which was   derived from the old verifier.   Note that the verifier must have the same uniqueness properties of   the verifier for the COMMIT operation.8.6.2.  Server Failure and Recovery   If the server loses locking state (usually as a result of a restart   or reboot), it must allow clients time to discover this fact and re-   establish the lost locking state.  The client must be able to re-   establish the locking state without having the server deny valid   requests because the server has granted conflicting access to another   client.  Likewise, if there is the possibility that clients have not   yet re-established their locking state for a file, the server must   disallow READ and WRITE operations for that file.  The duration of   this recovery period is equal to the duration of the lease period.   A client can determine that server failure (and thus loss of locking   state) has occurred, when it receives one of two errors.  The   NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID error indicates a stateid invalidated by a   reboot or restart.  The NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID error indicates aShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 79]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   clientid invalidated by reboot or restart.  When either of these are   received, the client must establish a new clientid (See the section   "Client ID") and re-establish the locking state as discussed below.   The period of special handling of locking and READs and WRITEs, equal   in duration to the lease period, is referred to as the "grace   period".  During the grace period, clients recover locks and the   associated state by reclaim-type locking requests (i.e., LOCK   requests with reclaim set to true and OPEN operations with a claim   type of CLAIM_PREVIOUS).  During the grace period, the server must   reject READ and WRITE operations and non-reclaim locking requests   (i.e., other LOCK and OPEN operations) with an error of   NFS4ERR_GRACE.   If the server can reliably determine that granting a non-reclaim   request will not conflict with reclamation of locks by other clients,   the NFS4ERR_GRACE error does not have to be returned and the non-   reclaim client request can be serviced.  For the server to be able to   service READ and WRITE operations during the grace period, it must   again be able to guarantee that no possible conflict could arise   between an impending reclaim locking request and the READ or WRITE   operation.  If the server is unable to offer that guarantee, the   NFS4ERR_GRACE error must be returned to the client.   For a server to provide simple, valid handling during the grace   period, the easiest method is to simply reject all non-reclaim   locking requests and READ and WRITE operations by returning the   NFS4ERR_GRACE error.  However, a server may keep information about   granted locks in stable storage.  With this information, the server   could determine if a regular lock or READ or WRITE operation can be   safely processed.   For example, if a count of locks on a given file is available in   stable storage, the server can track reclaimed locks for the file and   when all reclaims have been processed, non-reclaim locking requests   may be processed.  This way the server can ensure that non-reclaim   locking requests will not conflict with potential reclaim requests.   With respect to I/O requests, if the server is able to determine that   there are no outstanding reclaim requests for a file by information   from stable storage or another similar mechanism, the processing of   I/O requests could proceed normally for the file.   To reiterate, for a server that allows non-reclaim lock and I/O   requests to be processed during the grace period, it MUST determine   that no lock subsequently reclaimed will be rejected and that no lock   subsequently reclaimed would have prevented any I/O operation   processed during the grace period.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 80]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   Clients should be prepared for the return of NFS4ERR_GRACE errors for   non-reclaim lock and I/O requests.  In this case the client should   employ a retry mechanism for the request.  A delay (on the order of   several seconds) between retries should be used to avoid overwhelming   the server.  Further discussion of the general issue is included in   [Floyd].  The client must account for the server that is able to   perform I/O and non-reclaim locking requests within the grace period   as well as those that can not do so.   A reclaim-type locking request outside the server's grace period can   only succeed if the server can guarantee that no conflicting lock or   I/O request has been granted since reboot or restart.   A server may, upon restart, establish a new value for the lease   period.  Therefore, clients should, once a new clientid is   established, refetch the lease_time attribute and use it as the basis   for lease renewal for the lease associated with that server.   However, the server must establish, for this restart event, a grace   period at least as long as the lease period for the previous server   instantiation.  This allows the client state obtained during the   previous server instance to be reliably re-established.8.6.3.  Network Partitions and Recovery   If the duration of a network partition is greater than the lease   period provided by the server, the server will have not received a   lease renewal from the client.  If this occurs, the server may free   all locks held for the client.  As a result, all stateids held by the   client will become invalid or stale.  Once the client is able to   reach the server after such a network partition, all I/O submitted by   the client with the now invalid stateids will fail with the server   returning the error NFS4ERR_EXPIRED.  Once this error is received,   the client will suitably notify the application that held the lock.   As a courtesy to the client or as an optimization, the server may   continue to hold locks on behalf of a client for which recent   communication has extended beyond the lease period.  If the server   receives a lock or I/O request that conflicts with one of these   courtesy locks, the server must free the courtesy lock and grant the   new request.   When a network partition is combined with a server reboot, there are   edge conditions that place requirements on the server in order to   avoid silent data corruption following the server reboot.  Two of   these edge conditions are known, and are discussed below.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 81]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   The first edge condition has the following scenario:      1. Client A acquires a lock.      2. Client A and server experience mutual network partition, such         that client A is unable to renew its lease.      3. Client A's lease expires, so server releases lock.      4. Client B acquires a lock that would have conflicted with that         of Client A.      5. Client B releases the lock      6. Server reboots      7. Network partition between client A and server heals.      8. Client A issues a RENEW operation, and gets back a         NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID.      9. Client A reclaims its lock within the server's grace period.   Thus, at the final step, the server has erroneously granted client   A's lock reclaim.  If client B modified the object the lock was   protecting, client A will experience object corruption.   The second known edge condition follows:      1. Client A acquires a lock.      2. Server reboots.      3. Client A and server experience mutual network partition, such         that client A is unable to reclaim its lock within the grace         period.      4. Server's reclaim grace period ends.  Client A has no locks         recorded on server.      5. Client B acquires a lock that would have conflicted with that         of Client A.      6. Client B releases the lock.      7. Server reboots a second time.      8. Network partition between client A and server heals.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 82]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003      9. Client A issues a RENEW operation, and gets back a         NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID.     10. Client A reclaims its lock within the server's grace period.   As with the first edge condition, the final step of the scenario of   the second edge condition has the server erroneously granting client   A's lock reclaim.   Solving the first and second edge conditions requires that the server   either assume after it reboots that edge condition occurs, and thus   return NFS4ERR_NO_GRACE for all reclaim attempts, or that the server   record some information stable storage.  The amount of information   the server records in stable storage is in inverse proportion to how   harsh the server wants to be whenever the edge conditions occur.  The   server that is completely tolerant of all edge conditions will record   in stable storage every lock that is acquired, removing the lock   record from stable storage only when the lock is unlocked by the   client and the lock's lockowner advances the sequence number such   that the lock release is not the last stateful event for the   lockowner's sequence.  For the two aforementioned edge conditions,   the harshest a server can be, and still support a grace period for   reclaims, requires that the server record in stable storage   information some minimal information.  For example, a server   implementation could, for each client, save in stable storage a   record containing:   o  the client's id string   o  a boolean that indicates if the client's lease expired or if there      was administrative intervention (see the section, Server      Revocation of Locks) to revoke a record lock, share reservation,      or delegation   o  a timestamp that is updated the first time after a server boot or      reboot the client acquires record locking, share reservation, or      delegation state on the server.  The timestamp need not be updated      on subsequent lock requests until the server reboots.   The server implementation would also record in the stable storage the   timestamps from the two most recent server reboots.   Assuming the above record keeping, for the first edge condition,   after the server reboots, the record that client A's lease expired   means that another client could have acquired a conflicting record   lock, share reservation, or delegation.  Hence the server must reject   a reclaim from client A with the error NFS4ERR_NO_GRACE.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 83]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   For the second edge condition, after the server reboots for a second   time, the record that the client had an unexpired record lock, share   reservation, or delegation established before the server's previous   incarnation means that the server must reject a reclaim from client A   with the error NFS4ERR_NO_GRACE.   Regardless of the level and approach to record keeping, the server   MUST implement one of the following strategies (which apply to   reclaims of share reservations, record locks, and delegations):      1. Reject all reclaims with NFS4ERR_NO_GRACE.  This is superharsh,         but necessary if the server does not want to record lock state         in stable storage.      2. Record sufficient state in stable storage such that all known         edge conditions involving server reboot, including the two         noted in this section, are detected.  False positives are         acceptable.  Note that at this time, it is not known if there         are other edge conditions.         In the event, after a server reboot, the server determines that         there is unrecoverable damage or corruption to the the stable         storage, then for all clients and/or locks affected, the server         MUST return NFS4ERR_NO_GRACE.   A mandate for the client's handling of the NFS4ERR_NO_GRACE error is   outside the scope of this specification, since the strategies for   such handling are very dependent on the client's operating   environment.  However, one potential approach is described below.   When the client receives NFS4ERR_NO_GRACE, it could examine the   change attribute of the objects the client is trying to reclaim state   for, and use that to determine whether to re-establish the state via   normal OPEN or LOCK requests.  This is acceptable provided the   client's operating environment allows it.  In otherwords, the client   implementor is advised to document for his users the behavior.  The   client could also inform the application that its record lock or   share reservations (whether they were delegated or not) have been   lost, such as via a UNIX signal, a GUI pop-up window, etc.  See the   section, "Data Caching and Revocation" for a discussion of what the   client should do for dealing with unreclaimed delegations on client   state.   For further discussion of revocation of locks see the section "Server   Revocation of Locks".Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 84]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20038.7.  Recovery from a Lock Request Timeout or Abort   In the event a lock request times out, a client may decide to not   retry the request.  The client may also abort the request when the   process for which it was issued is terminated (e.g., in UNIX due to a   signal).  It is possible though that the server received the request   and acted upon it.  This would change the state on the server without   the client being aware of the change.  It is paramount that the   client re-synchronize state with server before it attempts any other   operation that takes a seqid and/or a stateid with the same   lock_owner.  This is straightforward to do without a special re-   synchronize operation.   Since the server maintains the last lock request and response   received on the lock_owner, for each lock_owner, the client should   cache the last lock request it sent such that the lock request did   not receive a response.  From this, the next time the client does a   lock operation for the lock_owner, it can send the cached request, if   there is one, and if the request was one that established state   (e.g., a LOCK or OPEN operation), the server will return the cached   result or if never saw the request, perform it.  The client can   follow up with a request to remove the state (e.g., a LOCKU or CLOSE   operation).  With this approach, the sequencing and stateid   information on the client and server for the given lock_owner will   re-synchronize and in turn the lock state will re-synchronize.8.8.  Server Revocation of Locks   At any point, the server can revoke locks held by a client and the   client must be prepared for this event.  When the client detects that   its locks have been or may have been revoked, the client is   responsible for validating the state information between itself and   the server.  Validating locking state for the client means that it   must verify or reclaim state for each lock currently held.   The first instance of lock revocation is upon server reboot or re-   initialization.  In this instance the client will receive an error   (NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID or NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID) and the client will   proceed with normal crash recovery as described in the previous   section.   The second lock revocation event is the inability to renew the lease   before expiration.  While this is considered a rare or unusual event,   the client must be prepared to recover.  Both the server and client   will be able to detect the failure to renew the lease and are capable   of recovering without data corruption.  For the server, it tracks the   last renewal event serviced for the client and knows when the lease   will expire.  Similarly, the client must track operations which willShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 85]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   renew the lease period.  Using the time that each such request was   sent and the time that the corresponding reply was received, the   client should bound the time that the corresponding renewal could   have occurred on the server and thus determine if it is possible that   a lease period expiration could have occurred.   The third lock revocation event can occur as a result of   administrative intervention within the lease period.  While this is   considered a rare event, it is possible that the server's   administrator has decided to release or revoke a particular lock held   by the client.  As a result of revocation, the client will receive an   error of NFS4ERR_ADMIN_REVOKED.  In this instance the client may   assume that only the lock_owner's locks have been lost.  The client   notifies the lock holder appropriately.  The client may not assume   the lease period has been renewed as a result of failed operation.   When the client determines the lease period may have expired, the   client must mark all locks held for the associated lease as   "unvalidated".  This means the client has been unable to re-establish   or confirm the appropriate lock state with the server.  As described   in the previous section on crash recovery, there are scenarios in   which the server may grant conflicting locks after the lease period   has expired for a client.  When it is possible that the lease period   has expired, the client must validate each lock currently held to   ensure that a conflicting lock has not been granted.  The client may   accomplish this task by issuing an I/O request, either a pending I/O   or a zero-length read, specifying the stateid associated with the   lock in question.  If the response to the request is success, the   client has validated all of the locks governed by that stateid and   re-established the appropriate state between itself and the server.   If the I/O request is not successful, then one or more of the locks   associated with the stateid was revoked by the server and the client   must notify the owner.8.9.  Share Reservations   A share reservation is a mechanism to control access to a file.  It   is a separate and independent mechanism from record locking.  When a   client opens a file, it issues an OPEN operation to the server   specifying the type of access required (READ, WRITE, or BOTH) and the   type of access to deny others (deny NONE, READ, WRITE, or BOTH).  If   the OPEN fails the client will fail the application's open request.   Pseudo-code definition of the semantics:   if (request.access == 0)      return (NFS4ERR_INVAL)Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 86]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   else      if ((request.access & file_state.deny)) ||            (request.deny & file_state.access))                    return (NFS4ERR_DENIED)   This checking of share reservations on OPEN is done with no exception   for an existing OPEN for the same open_owner.   The constants used for the OPEN and OPEN_DOWNGRADE operations for the   access and deny fields are as follows:   const OPEN4_SHARE_ACCESS_READ   = 0x00000001;   const OPEN4_SHARE_ACCESS_WRITE  = 0x00000002;   const OPEN4_SHARE_ACCESS_BOTH   = 0x00000003;   const OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_NONE     = 0x00000000;   const OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_READ     = 0x00000001;   const OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_WRITE    = 0x00000002;   const OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_BOTH     = 0x00000003;8.10.  OPEN/CLOSE Operations   To provide correct share semantics, a client MUST use the OPEN   operation to obtain the initial filehandle and indicate the desired   access and what if any access to deny.  Even if the client intends to   use a stateid of all 0's or all 1's, it must still obtain the   filehandle for the regular file with the OPEN operation so the   appropriate share semantics can be applied.  For clients that do not   have a deny mode built into their open programming interfaces, deny   equal to NONE should be used.   The OPEN operation with the CREATE flag, also subsumes the CREATE   operation for regular files as used in previous versions of the NFS   protocol.  This allows a create with a share to be done atomically.   The CLOSE operation removes all share reservations held by the   lock_owner on that file.  If record locks are held, the client SHOULD   release all locks before issuing a CLOSE.  The server MAY free all   outstanding locks on CLOSE but some servers may not support the CLOSE   of a file that still has record locks held.  The server MUST return   failure, NFS4ERR_LOCKS_HELD, if any locks would exist after the   CLOSE.   The LOOKUP operation will return a filehandle without establishing   any lock state on the server.  Without a valid stateid, the server   will assume the client has the least access.  For example, a fileShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 87]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   opened with deny READ/WRITE cannot be accessed using a filehandle   obtained through LOOKUP because it would not have a valid stateid   (i.e., using a stateid of all bits 0 or all bits 1).8.10.1.  Close and Retention of State Information   Since a CLOSE operation requests deallocation of a stateid, dealing   with retransmission of the CLOSE, may pose special difficulties,   since the state information, which normally would be used to   determine the state of the open file being designated, might be   deallocated, resulting in an NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID error.   Servers may deal with this problem in a number of ways.  To provide   the greatest degree assurance that the protocol is being used   properly, a server should, rather than deallocate the stateid, mark   it as close-pending, and retain the stateid with this status, until   later deallocation.  In this way, a retransmitted CLOSE can be   recognized since the stateid points to state information with this   distinctive status, so that it can be handled without error.   When adopting this strategy, a server should retain the state   information until the earliest of:   o  Another validly sequenced request for the same lockowner, that is      not a retransmission.   o  The time that a lockowner is freed by the server due to period      with no activity.   o  All locks for the client are freed as a result of a SETCLIENTID.   Servers may avoid this complexity, at the cost of less complete   protocol error checking, by simply responding NFS4_OK in the event of   a CLOSE for a deallocated stateid, on the assumption that this case   must be caused by a retransmitted close.  When adopting this   approach, it is desirable to at least log an error when returning a   no-error indication in this situation.  If the server maintains a   reply-cache mechanism, it can verify the CLOSE is indeed a   retransmission and avoid error logging in most cases.8.11.  Open Upgrade and Downgrade   When an OPEN is done for a file and the lockowner for which the open   is being done already has the file open, the result is to upgrade the   open file status maintained on the server to include the access and   deny bits specified by the new OPEN as well as those for the existing   OPEN.  The result is that there is one open file, as far as the   protocol is concerned, and it includes the union of the access andShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 88]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   deny bits for all of the OPEN requests completed.  Only a single   CLOSE will be done to reset the effects of both OPENs.  Note that the   client, when issuing the OPEN, may not know that the same file is in   fact being opened.  The above only applies if both OPENs result in   the OPENed object being designated by the same filehandle.   When the server chooses to export multiple filehandles corresponding   to the same file object and returns different filehandles on two   different OPENs of the same file object, the server MUST NOT "OR"   together the access and deny bits and coalesce the two open files.   Instead the server must maintain separate OPENs with separate   stateids and will require separate CLOSEs to free them.   When multiple open files on the client are merged into a single open   file object on the server, the close of one of the open files (on the   client) may necessitate change of the access and deny status of the   open file on the server.  This is because the union of the access and   deny bits for the remaining opens may be smaller (i.e., a proper   subset) than previously.  The OPEN_DOWNGRADE operation is used to   make the necessary change and the client should use it to update the   server so that share reservation requests by other clients are   handled properly.8.12.  Short and Long Leases   When determining the time period for the server lease, the usual   lease tradeoffs apply.  Short leases are good for fast server   recovery at a cost of increased RENEW or READ (with zero length)   requests.  Longer leases are certainly kinder and gentler to servers   trying to handle very large numbers of clients.  The number of RENEW   requests drop in proportion to the lease time.  The disadvantages of   long leases are slower recovery after server failure (the server must   wait for the leases to expire and the grace period to elapse before   granting new lock requests) and increased file contention (if client   fails to transmit an unlock request then server must wait for lease   expiration before granting new locks).   Long leases are usable if the server is able to store lease state in   non-volatile memory.  Upon recovery, the server can reconstruct the   lease state from its non-volatile memory and continue operation with   its clients and therefore long leases would not be an issue.8.13.  Clocks, Propagation Delay, and Calculating Lease Expiration   To avoid the need for synchronized clocks, lease times are granted by   the server as a time delta.  However, there is a requirement that the   client and server clocks do not drift excessively over the duration   of the lock.  There is also the issue of propagation delay across theShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 89]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   network which could easily be several hundred milliseconds as well as   the possibility that requests will be lost and need to be   retransmitted.   To take propagation delay into account, the client should subtract it   from lease times (e.g., if the client estimates the one-way   propagation delay as 200 msec, then it can assume that the lease is   already 200 msec old when it gets it).  In addition, it will take   another 200 msec to get a response back to the server.  So the client   must send a lock renewal or write data back to the server 400 msec   before the lease would expire.   The server's lease period configuration should take into account the   network distance of the clients that will be accessing the server's   resources.  It is expected that the lease period will take into   account the network propagation delays and other network delay   factors for the client population.  Since the protocol does not allow   for an automatic method to determine an appropriate lease period, the   server's administrator may have to tune the lease period.8.14.  Migration, Replication and State   When responsibility for handling a given file system is transferred   to a new server (migration) or the client chooses to use an alternate   server (e.g., in response to server unresponsiveness) in the context   of file system replication, the appropriate handling of state shared   between the client and server (i.e., locks, leases, stateids, and   clientids) is as described below.  The handling differs between   migration and replication.  For related discussion of file server   state and recover of such see the sections under "File Locking and   Share Reservations".   If server replica or a server immigrating a filesystem agrees to, or   is expected to, accept opaque values from the client that originated   from another server, then it is a wise implementation practice for   the servers to encode the "opaque" values in network byte order.   This way, servers acting as replicas or immigrating filesystems will   be able to parse values like stateids, directory cookies,   filehandles, etc. even if their native byte order is different from   other servers cooperating in the replication and migration of the   filesystem.8.14.1.  Migration and State   In the case of migration, the servers involved in the migration of a   filesystem SHOULD transfer all server state from the original to the   new server.  This must be done in a way that is transparent to the   client.  This state transfer will ease the client's transition when aShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 90]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   filesystem migration occurs.  If the servers are successful in   transferring all state, the client will continue to use stateids   assigned by the original server.  Therefore the new server must   recognize these stateids as valid.  This holds true for the clientid   as well.  Since responsibility for an entire filesystem is   transferred with a migration event, there is no possibility that   conflicts will arise on the new server as a result of the transfer of   locks.   As part of the transfer of information between servers, leases would   be transferred as well.  The leases being transferred to the new   server will typically have a different expiration time from those for   the same client, previously on the old server.  To maintain the   property that all leases on a given server for a given client expire   at the same time, the server should advance the expiration time to   the later of the leases being transferred or the leases already   present.  This allows the client to maintain lease renewal of both   classes without special effort.   The servers may choose not to transfer the state information upon   migration.  However, this choice is discouraged.  In this case, when   the client presents state information from the original server, the   client must be prepared to receive either NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID or   NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID from the new server.  The client should then   recover its state information as it normally would in response to a   server failure.  The new server must take care to allow for the   recovery of state information as it would in the event of server   restart.8.14.2.  Replication and State   Since client switch-over in the case of replication is not under   server control, the handling of state is different.  In this case,   leases, stateids and clientids do not have validity across a   transition from one server to another.  The client must re-establish   its locks on the new server.  This can be compared to the re-   establishment of locks by means of reclaim-type requests after a   server reboot.  The difference is that the server has no provision to   distinguish requests reclaiming locks from those obtaining new locks   or to defer the latter.  Thus, a client re-establishing a lock on the   new server (by means of a LOCK or OPEN request), may have the   requests denied due to a conflicting lock.  Since replication is   intended for read-only use of filesystems, such denial of locks   should not pose large difficulties in practice.  When an attempt to   re-establish a lock on a new server is denied, the client should   treat the situation as if his original lock had been revoked.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 91]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20038.14.3.  Notification of Migrated Lease   In the case of lease renewal, the client may not be submitting   requests for a filesystem that has been migrated to another server.   This can occur because of the implicit lease renewal mechanism.  The   client renews leases for all filesystems when submitting a request to   any one filesystem at the server.   In order for the client to schedule renewal of leases that may have   been relocated to the new server, the client must find out about   lease relocation before those leases expire.  To accomplish this, all   operations which implicitly renew leases for a client (i.e., OPEN,   CLOSE, READ, WRITE, RENEW, LOCK, LOCKT, LOCKU), will return the error   NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED if responsibility for any of the leases to be   renewed has been transferred to a new server.  This condition will   continue until the client receives an NFS4ERR_MOVED error and the   server receives the subsequent GETATTR(fs_locations) for an access to   each filesystem for which a lease has been moved to a new server.   When a client receives an NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED error, it should   perform an operation on each filesystem associated with the server in   question.  When the client receives an NFS4ERR_MOVED error, the   client can follow the normal process to obtain the new server   information (through the fs_locations attribute) and perform renewal   of those leases on the new server.  If the server has not had state   transferred to it transparently, the client will receive either   NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID or NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID from the new server,   as described above, and the client can then recover state information   as it does in the event of server failure.8.14.4.  Migration and the Lease_time Attribute   In order that the client may appropriately manage its leases in the   case of migration, the destination server must establish proper   values for the lease_time attribute.   When state is transferred transparently, that state should include   the correct value of the lease_time attribute.  The lease_time   attribute on the destination server must never be less than that on   the source since this would result in premature expiration of leases   granted by the source server.  Upon migration in which state is   transferred transparently, the client is under no obligation to re-   fetch the lease_time attribute and may continue to use the value   previously fetched (on the source server).   If state has not been transferred transparently (i.e., the client   sees a real or simulated server reboot), the client should fetch the   value of lease_time on the new (i.e., destination) server, and use itShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 92]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   for subsequent locking requests.  However the server must respect a   grace period at least as long as the lease_time on the source server,   in order to ensure that clients have ample time to reclaim their   locks before potentially conflicting non-reclaimed locks are granted.   The means by which the new server obtains the value of lease_time on   the old server is left to the server implementations.  It is not   specified by the NFS version 4 protocol.9.  Client-Side Caching   Client-side caching of data, of file attributes, and of file names is   essential to providing good performance with the NFS protocol.   Providing distributed cache coherence is a difficult problem and   previous versions of the NFS protocol have not attempted it.   Instead, several NFS client implementation techniques have been used   to reduce the problems that a lack of coherence poses for users.   These techniques have not been clearly defined by earlier protocol   specifications and it is often unclear what is valid or invalid   client behavior.   The NFS version 4 protocol uses many techniques similar to those that   have been used in previous protocol versions.  The NFS version 4   protocol does not provide distributed cache coherence.  However, it   defines a more limited set of caching guarantees to allow locks and   share reservations to be used without destructive interference from   client side caching.   In addition, the NFS version 4 protocol introduces a delegation   mechanism which allows many decisions normally made by the server to   be made locally by clients.  This mechanism provides efficient   support of the common cases where sharing is infrequent or where   sharing is read-only.9.1.  Performance Challenges for Client-Side Caching   Caching techniques used in previous versions of the NFS protocol have   been successful in providing good performance.  However, several   scalability challenges can arise when those techniques are used with   very large numbers of clients.  This is particularly true when   clients are geographically distributed which classically increases   the latency for cache revalidation requests.   The previous versions of the NFS protocol repeat their file data   cache validation requests at the time the file is opened.  This   behavior can have serious performance drawbacks.  A common case is   one in which a file is only accessed by a single client.  Therefore,   sharing is infrequent.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 93]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   In this case, repeated reference to the server to find that no   conflicts exist is expensive.  A better option with regards to   performance is to allow a client that repeatedly opens a file to do   so without reference to the server.  This is done until potentially   conflicting operations from another client actually occur.   A similar situation arises in connection with file locking.  Sending   file lock and unlock requests to the server as well as the read and   write requests necessary to make data caching consistent with the   locking semantics (see the section "Data Caching and File Locking")   can severely limit performance.  When locking is used to provide   protection against infrequent conflicts, a large penalty is incurred.   This penalty may discourage the use of file locking by applications.   The NFS version 4 protocol provides more aggressive caching   strategies with the following design goals:   o  Compatibility with a large range of server semantics.   o  Provide the same caching benefits as previous versions of the NFS      protocol when unable to provide the more aggressive model.   o  Requirements for aggressive caching are organized so that a large      portion of the benefit can be obtained even when not all of the      requirements can be met.   The appropriate requirements for the server are discussed in later   sections in which specific forms of caching are covered.  (see the   section "Open Delegation").9.2.  Delegation and Callbacks   Recallable delegation of server responsibilities for a file to a   client improves performance by avoiding repeated requests to the   server in the absence of inter-client conflict.  With the use of a   "callback" RPC from server to client, a server recalls delegated   responsibilities when another client engages in sharing of a   delegated file.   A delegation is passed from the server to the client, specifying the   object of the delegation and the type of delegation.  There are   different types of delegations but each type contains a stateid to be   used to represent the delegation when performing operations that   depend on the delegation.  This stateid is similar to those   associated with locks and share reservations but differs in that the   stateid for a delegation is associated with a clientid and may beShepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 94]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   used on behalf of all the open_owners for the given client.  A   delegation is made to the client as a whole and not to any specific   process or thread of control within it.   Because callback RPCs may not work in all environments (due to   firewalls, for example), correct protocol operation does not depend   on them.  Preliminary testing of callback functionality by means of a   CB_NULL procedure determines whether callbacks can be supported.  The   CB_NULL procedure checks the continuity of the callback path.  A   server makes a preliminary assessment of callback availability to a   given client and avoids delegating responsibilities until it has   determined that callbacks are supported.  Because the granting of a   delegation is always conditional upon the absence of conflicting   access, clients must not assume that a delegation will be granted and   they must always be prepared for OPENs to be processed without any   delegations being granted.   Once granted, a delegation behaves in most ways like a lock.  There   is an associated lease that is subject to renewal together with all   of the other leases held by that client.   Unlike locks, an operation by a second client to a delegated file   will cause the server to recall a delegation through a callback.   On recall, the client holding the delegation must flush modified   state (such as modified data) to the server and return the   delegation.  The conflicting request will not receive a response   until the recall is complete.  The recall is considered complete when   the client returns the delegation or the server times out on the   recall and revokes the delegation as a result of the timeout.   Following the resolution of the recall, the server has the   information necessary to grant or deny the second client's request.   At the time the client receives a delegation recall, it may have   substantial state that needs to be flushed to the server.  Therefore,   the server should allow sufficient time for the delegation to be   returned since it may involve numerous RPCs to the server.  If the   server is able to determine that the client is diligently flushing   state to the server as a result of the recall, the server may extend   the usual time allowed for a recall.  However, the time allowed for   recall completion should not be unbounded.   An example of this is when responsibility to mediate opens on a given   file is delegated to a client (see the section "Open Delegation").   The server will not know what opens are in effect on the client.   Without this knowledge the server will be unable to determine if the   access and deny state for the file allows any particular open until   the delegation for the file has been returned.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 95]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   A client failure or a network partition can result in failure to   respond to a recall callback.  In this case, the server will revoke   the delegation which in turn will render useless any modified state   still on the client.9.2.1.  Delegation Recovery   There are three situations that delegation recovery must deal with:   o   Client reboot or restart   o   Server reboot or restart   o   Network partition (full or callback-only)   In the event the client reboots or restarts, the failure to renew   leases will result in the revocation of record locks and share   reservations.  Delegations, however, may be treated a bit   differently.   There will be situations in which delegations will need to be   reestablished after a client reboots or restarts.  The reason for   this is the client may have file data stored locally and this data   was associated with the previously held delegations.  The client will   need to reestablish the appropriate file state on the server.   To allow for this type of client recovery, the server MAY extend the   period for delegation recovery beyond the typical lease expiration   period.  This implies that requests from other clients that conflict   with these delegations will need to wait.  Because the normal recall   process may require significant time for the client to flush changed   state to the server, other clients need be prepared for delays that   occur because of a conflicting delegation.  This longer interval   would increase the window for clients to reboot and consult stable   storage so that the delegations can be reclaimed.  For open   delegations, such delegations are reclaimed using OPEN with a claim   type of CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV.  (See the sections on "Data Caching and   Revocation" and "Operation 18: OPEN" for discussion of open   delegation and the details of OPEN respectively).   A server MAY support a claim type of CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV, but if it   does, it MUST NOT remove delegations upon SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM, and   instead MUST, for a period of time no less than that of the value of   the lease_time attribute, maintain the client's delegations to allow   time for the client to issue CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV requests.  The   server that supports CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV MUST support the DELEGPURGE   operation.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 96]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   When the server reboots or restarts, delegations are reclaimed (using   the OPEN operation with CLAIM_PREVIOUS) in a similar fashion to   record locks and share reservations.  However, there is a slight   semantic difference.  In the normal case if the server decides that a   delegation should not be granted, it performs the requested action   (e.g., OPEN) without granting any delegation.  For reclaim, the   server grants the delegation but a special designation is applied so   that the client treats the delegation as having been granted but   recalled by the server.  Because of this, the client has the duty to   write all modified state to the server and then return the   delegation.  This process of handling delegation reclaim reconciles   three principles of the NFS version 4 protocol:   o  Upon reclaim, a client reporting resources assigned to it by an      earlier server instance must be granted those resources.   o  The server has unquestionable authority to determine whether      delegations are to be granted and, once granted, whether they are      to be continued.   o  The use of callbacks is not to be depended upon until the client      has proven its ability to receive them.   When a network partition occurs, delegations are subject to freeing   by the server when the lease renewal period expires.  This is similar   to the behavior for locks and share reservations.  For delegations,   however, the server may extend the period in which conflicting   requests are held off.  Eventually the occurrence of a conflicting   request from another client will cause revocation of the delegation.   A loss of the callback path (e.g., by later network configuration   change) will have the same effect.  A recall request will fail and   revocation of the delegation will result.   A client normally finds out about revocation of a delegation when it   uses a stateid associated with a delegation and receives the error   NFS4ERR_EXPIRED.  It also may find out about delegation revocation   after a client reboot when it attempts to reclaim a delegation and   receives that same error.  Note that in the case of a revoked write   open delegation, there are issues because data may have been modified   by the client whose delegation is revoked and separately by other   clients.  See the section "Revocation Recovery for Write Open   Delegation" for a discussion of such issues.  Note also that when   delegations are revoked, information about the revoked delegation   will be written by the server to stable storage (as described in the   section "Crash Recovery").  This is done to deal with the case in   which a server reboots after revoking a delegation but before the   client holding the revoked delegation is notified about the   revocation.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 97]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20039.3.  Data Caching   When applications share access to a set of files, they need to be   implemented so as to take account of the possibility of conflicting   access by another application.  This is true whether the applications   in question execute on different clients or reside on the same   client.   Share reservations and record locks are the facilities the NFS   version 4 protocol provides to allow applications to coordinate   access by providing mutual exclusion facilities.  The NFS version 4   protocol's data caching must be implemented such that it does not   invalidate the assumptions that those using these facilities depend   upon.9.3.1.  Data Caching and OPENs   In order to avoid invalidating the sharing assumptions that   applications rely on, NFS version 4 clients should not provide cached   data to applications or modify it on behalf of an application when it   would not be valid to obtain or modify that same data via a READ or   WRITE operation.   Furthermore, in the absence of open delegation (see the section "Open   Delegation") two additional rules apply.  Note that these rules are   obeyed in practice by many NFS version 2 and version 3 clients.   o  First, cached data present on a client must be revalidated after      doing an OPEN.  Revalidating means that the client fetches the      change attribute from the server, compares it with the cached      change attribute, and if different, declares the cached data (as      well as the cached attributes) as invalid.  This is to ensure that      the data for the OPENed file is still correctly reflected in the      client's cache.  This validation must be done at least when the      client's OPEN operation includes DENY=WRITE or BOTH thus      terminating a period in which other clients may have had the      opportunity to open the file with WRITE access.  Clients may      choose to do the revalidation more often (i.e., at OPENs      specifying DENY=NONE) to parallel the NFS version 3 protocol's      practice for the benefit of users assuming this degree of cache      revalidation.      Since the change attribute is updated for data and metadata      modifications, some client implementors may be tempted to use the      time_modify attribute and not change to validate cached data, so      that metadata changes do not spuriously invalidate clean data.      The implementor is cautioned in this approach.  The change      attribute is guaranteed to change for each update to the file,Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 98]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003      whereas time_modify is guaranteed to change only at the      granularity of the time_delta attribute.  Use by the client's data      cache validation logic of time_modify and not change runs the risk      of the client incorrectly marking stale data as valid.   o  Second, modified data must be flushed to the server before closing      a file OPENed for write.  This is complementary to the first rule.      If the data is not flushed at CLOSE, the revalidation done after      client OPENs as file is unable to achieve its purpose.  The other      aspect to flushing the data before close is that the data must be      committed to stable storage, at the server, before the CLOSE      operation is requested by the client.  In the case of a server      reboot or restart and a CLOSEd file, it may not be possible to      retransmit the data to be written to the file.  Hence, this      requirement.9.3.2.  Data Caching and File Locking   For those applications that choose to use file locking instead of   share reservations to exclude inconsistent file access, there is an   analogous set of constraints that apply to client side data caching.   These rules are effective only if the file locking is used in a way   that matches in an equivalent way the actual READ and WRITE   operations executed.  This is as opposed to file locking that is   based on pure convention.  For example, it is possible to manipulate   a two-megabyte file by dividing the file into two one-megabyte   regions and protecting access to the two regions by file locks on   bytes zero and one.  A lock for write on byte zero of the file would   represent the right to do READ and WRITE operations on the first   region.  A lock for write on byte one of the file would represent the   right to do READ and WRITE operations on the second region.  As long   as all applications manipulating the file obey this convention, they   will work on a local filesystem.  However, they may not work with the   NFS version 4 protocol unless clients refrain from data caching.   The rules for data caching in the file locking environment are:   o  First, when a client obtains a file lock for a particular region,      the data cache corresponding to that region (if any cached data      exists) must be revalidated.  If the change attribute indicates      that the file may have been updated since the cached data was      obtained, the client must flush or invalidate the cached data for      the newly locked region.  A client might choose to invalidate all      of non-modified cached data that it has for the file but the only      requirement for correct operation is to invalidate all of the data      in the newly locked region.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                    [Page 99]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   o  Second, before releasing a write lock for a region, all modified      data for that region must be flushed to the server.  The modified      data must also be written to stable storage.   Note that flushing data to the server and the invalidation of cached   data must reflect the actual byte ranges locked or unlocked.   Rounding these up or down to reflect client cache block boundaries   will cause problems if not carefully done.  For example, writing a   modified block when only half of that block is within an area being   unlocked may cause invalid modification to the region outside the   unlocked area.  This, in turn, may be part of a region locked by   another client.  Clients can avoid this situation by synchronously   performing portions of write operations that overlap that portion   (initial or final) that is not a full block.  Similarly, invalidating   a locked area which is not an integral number of full buffer blocks   would require the client to read one or two partial blocks from the   server if the revalidation procedure shows that the data which the   client possesses may not be valid.   The data that is written to the server as a prerequisite to the   unlocking of a region must be written, at the server, to stable   storage.  The client may accomplish this either with synchronous   writes or by following asynchronous writes with a COMMIT operation.   This is required because retransmission of the modified data after a   server reboot might conflict with a lock held by another client.   A client implementation may choose to accommodate applications which   use record locking in non-standard ways (e.g., using a record lock as   a global semaphore) by flushing to the server more data upon an LOCKU   than is covered by the locked range.  This may include modified data   within files other than the one for which the unlocks are being done.   In such cases, the client must not interfere with applications whose   READs and WRITEs are being done only within the bounds of record   locks which the application holds.  For example, an application locks   a single byte of a file and proceeds to write that single byte.  A   client that chose to handle a LOCKU by flushing all modified data to   the server could validly write that single byte in response to an   unrelated unlock.  However, it would not be valid to write the entire   block in which that single written byte was located since it includes   an area that is not locked and might be locked by another client.   Client implementations can avoid this problem by dividing files with   modified data into those for which all modifications are done to   areas covered by an appropriate record lock and those for which there   are modifications not covered by a record lock.  Any writes done for   the former class of files must not include areas not locked and thus   not modified on the client.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 100]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 20039.3.3.  Data Caching and Mandatory File Locking   Client side data caching needs to respect mandatory file locking when   it is in effect.  The presence of mandatory file locking for a given   file is indicated when the client gets back NFS4ERR_LOCKED from a   READ or WRITE on a file it has an appropriate share reservation for.   When mandatory locking is in effect for a file, the client must check   for an appropriate file lock for data being read or written.  If a   lock exists for the range being read or written, the client may   satisfy the request using the client's validated cache.  If an   appropriate file lock is not held for the range of the read or write,   the read or write request must not be satisfied by the client's cache   and the request must be sent to the server for processing.  When a   read or write request partially overlaps a locked region, the request   should be subdivided into multiple pieces with each region (locked or   not) treated appropriately.9.3.4.  Data Caching and File Identity   When clients cache data, the file data needs to be organized   according to the filesystem object to which the data belongs.  For   NFS version 3 clients, the typical practice has been to assume for   the purpose of caching that distinct filehandles represent distinct   filesystem objects.  The client then has the choice to organize and   maintain the data cache on this basis.   In the NFS version 4 protocol, there is now the possibility to have   significant deviations from a "one filehandle per object" model   because a filehandle may be constructed on the basis of the object's   pathname.  Therefore, clients need a reliable method to determine if   two filehandles designate the same filesystem object.  If clients   were simply to assume that all distinct filehandles denote distinct   objects and proceed to do data caching on this basis, caching   inconsistencies would arise between the distinct client side objects   which mapped to the same server side object.   By providing a method to differentiate filehandles, the NFS version 4   protocol alleviates a potential functional regression in comparison   with the NFS version 3 protocol.  Without this method, caching   inconsistencies within the same client could occur and this has not   been present in previous versions of the NFS protocol.  Note that it   is possible to have such inconsistencies with applications executing   on multiple clients but that is not the issue being addressed here.   For the purposes of data caching, the following steps allow an NFS   version 4 client to determine whether two distinct filehandles denote   the same server side object:Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 101]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   o  If GETATTR directed to two filehandles returns different values of      the fsid attribute, then the filehandles represent distinct      objects.   o  If GETATTR for any file with an fsid that matches the fsid of the      two filehandles in question returns a unique_handles attribute      with a value of TRUE, then the two objects are distinct.   o  If GETATTR directed to the two filehandles does not return the      fileid attribute for both of the handles, then it cannot be      determined whether the two objects are the same.  Therefore,      operations which depend on that knowledge (e.g., client side data      caching) cannot be done reliably.   o  If GETATTR directed to the two filehandles returns different      values for the fileid attribute, then they are distinct objects.   o  Otherwise they are the same object.9.4.  Open Delegation   When a file is being OPENed, the server may delegate further handling   of opens and closes for that file to the opening client.  Any such   delegation is recallable, since the circumstances that allowed for   the delegation are subject to change.  In particular, the server may   receive a conflicting OPEN from another client, the server must   recall the delegation before deciding whether the OPEN from the other   client may be granted.  Making a delegation is up to the server and   clients should not assume that any particular OPEN either will or   will not result in an open delegation.  The following is a typical   set of conditions that servers might use in deciding whether OPEN   should be delegated:   o  The client must be able to respond to the server's callback      requests.  The server will use the CB_NULL procedure for a test of      callback ability.   o  The client must have responded properly to previous recalls.   o  There must be no current open conflicting with the requested      delegation.   o  There should be no current delegation that conflicts with the      delegation being requested.   o  The probability of future conflicting open requests should be low      based on the recent history of the file.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 102]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   o  The existence of any server-specific semantics of OPEN/CLOSE that      would make the required handling incompatible with the prescribed      handling that the delegated client would apply (see below).   There are two types of open delegations, read and write.  A read open   delegation allows a client to handle, on its own, requests to open a   file for reading that do not deny read access to others.  Multiple   read open delegations may be outstanding simultaneously and do not   conflict.  A write open delegation allows the client to handle, on   its own, all opens.  Only one write open delegation may exist for a   given file at a given time and it is inconsistent with any read open   delegations.   When a client has a read open delegation, it may not make any changes   to the contents or attributes of the file but it is assured that no   other client may do so.  When a client has a write open delegation,   it may modify the file data since no other client will be accessing   the file's data.  The client holding a write delegation may only   affect file attributes which are intimately connected with the file   data:  size, time_modify, change.   When a client has an open delegation, it does not send OPENs or   CLOSEs to the server but updates the appropriate status internally.   For a read open delegation, opens that cannot be handled locally   (opens for write or that deny read access) must be sent to the   server.   When an open delegation is made, the response to the OPEN contains an   open delegation structure which specifies the following:   o  the type of delegation (read or write)   o  space limitation information to control flushing of data on close      (write open delegation only, see the section "Open Delegation and      Data Caching")   o  an nfsace4 specifying read and write permissions   o  a stateid to represent the delegation for READ and WRITE   The delegation stateid is separate and distinct from the stateid for   the OPEN proper.  The standard stateid, unlike the delegation   stateid, is associated with a particular lock_owner and will continue   to be valid after the delegation is recalled and the file remains   open.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 103]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   When a request internal to the client is made to open a file and open   delegation is in effect, it will be accepted or rejected solely on   the basis of the following conditions.  Any requirement for other   checks to be made by the delegate should result in open delegation   being denied so that the checks can be made by the server itself.   o  The access and deny bits for the request and the file as described      in the section "Share Reservations".   o  The read and write permissions as determined below.   The nfsace4 passed with delegation can be used to avoid frequent   ACCESS calls.  The permission check should be as follows:   o  If the nfsace4 indicates that the open may be done, then it should      be granted without reference to the server.   o  If the nfsace4 indicates that the open may not be done, then an      ACCESS request must be sent to the server to obtain the definitive      answer.   The server may return an nfsace4 that is more restrictive than the   actual ACL of the file.  This includes an nfsace4 that specifies   denial of all access.  Note that some common practices such as   mapping the traditional user "root" to the user "nobody" may make it   incorrect to return the actual ACL of the file in the delegation   response.   The use of delegation together with various other forms of caching   creates the possibility that no server authentication will ever be   performed for a given user since all of the user's requests might be   satisfied locally.  Where the client is depending on the server for   authentication, the client should be sure authentication occurs for   each user by use of the ACCESS operation.  This should be the case   even if an ACCESS operation would not be required otherwise.  As   mentioned before, the server may enforce frequent authentication by   returning an nfsace4 denying all access with every open delegation.9.4.1.  Open Delegation and Data Caching   OPEN delegation allows much of the message overhead associated with   the opening and closing files to be eliminated.  An open when an open   delegation is in effect does not require that a validation message be   sent to the server.  The continued endurance of the "read open   delegation" provides a guarantee that no OPEN for write and thus no   write has occurred.  Similarly, when closing a file opened for write   and if write open delegation is in effect, the data written does not   have to be flushed to the server until the open delegation isShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 104]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   recalled.  The continued endurance of the open delegation provides a   guarantee that no open and thus no read or write has been done by   another client.   For the purposes of open delegation, READs and WRITEs done without an   OPEN are treated as the functional equivalents of a corresponding   type of OPEN.  This refers to the READs and WRITEs that use the   special stateids consisting of all zero bits or all one bits.   Therefore, READs or WRITEs with a special stateid done by another   client will force the server to recall a write open delegation.  A   WRITE with a special stateid done by another client will force a   recall of read open delegations.   With delegations, a client is able to avoid writing data to the   server when the CLOSE of a file is serviced.  The file close system   call is the usual point at which the client is notified of a lack of   stable storage for the modified file data generated by the   application.  At the close, file data is written to the server and   through normal accounting the server is able to determine if the   available filesystem space for the data has been exceeded (i.e.,   server returns NFS4ERR_NOSPC or NFS4ERR_DQUOT).  This accounting   includes quotas.  The introduction of delegations requires that a   alternative method be in place for the same type of communication to   occur between client and server.   In the delegation response, the server provides either the limit of   the size of the file or the number of modified blocks and associated   block size.  The server must ensure that the client will be able to   flush data to the server of a size equal to that provided in the   original delegation.  The server must make this assurance for all   outstanding delegations.  Therefore, the server must be careful in   its management of available space for new or modified data taking   into account available filesystem space and any applicable quotas.   The server can recall delegations as a result of managing the   available filesystem space.  The client should abide by the server's   state space limits for delegations.  If the client exceeds the stated   limits for the delegation, the server's behavior is undefined.   Based on server conditions, quotas or available filesystem space, the   server may grant write open delegations with very restrictive space   limitations.  The limitations may be defined in a way that will   always force modified data to be flushed to the server on close.   With respect to authentication, flushing modified data to the server   after a CLOSE has occurred may be problematic.  For example, the user   of the application may have logged off the client and unexpired   authentication credentials may not be present.  In this case, the   client may need to take special care to ensure that local unexpiredShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 105]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   credentials will in fact be available.  This may be accomplished by   tracking the expiration time of credentials and flushing data well in   advance of their expiration or by making private copies of   credentials to assure their availability when needed.9.4.2.  Open Delegation and File Locks   When a client holds a write open delegation, lock operations may be   performed locally.  This includes those required for mandatory file   locking.  This can be done since the delegation implies that there   can be no conflicting locks.  Similarly, all of the revalidations   that would normally be associated with obtaining locks and the   flushing of data associated with the releasing of locks need not be   done.   When a client holds a read open delegation, lock operations are not   performed locally.  All lock operations, including those requesting   non-exclusive locks, are sent to the server for resolution.9.4.3.  Handling of CB_GETATTR   The server needs to employ special handling for a GETATTR where the   target is a file that has a write open delegation in effect.  The   reason for this is that the client holding the write delegation may   have modified the data and the server needs to reflect this change to   the second client that submitted the GETATTR.  Therefore, the client   holding the write delegation needs to be interrogated.  The server   will use the CB_GETATTR operation.  The only attributes that the   server can reliably query via CB_GETATTR are size and change.   Since CB_GETATTR is being used to satisfy another client's GETATTR   request, the server only needs to know if the client holding the   delegation has a modified version of the file.  If the client's copy   of the delegated file is not modified (data or size), the server can   satisfy the second client's GETATTR request from the attributes   stored locally at the server.  If the file is modified, the server   only needs to know about this modified state.  If the server   determines that the file is currently modified, it will respond to   the second client's GETATTR as if the file had been modified locally   at the server.   Since the form of the change attribute is determined by the server   and is opaque to the client, the client and server need to agree on a   method of communicating the modified state of the file.  For the size   attribute, the client will report its current view of the file size.   For the change attribute, the handling is more involved.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 106]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   For the client, the following steps will be taken when receiving a   write delegation:   o  The value of the change attribute will be obtained from the server      and cached.  Let this value be represented by c.   o  The client will create a value greater than c that will be used      for communicating modified data is held at the client.  Let this      value be represented by d.   o  When the client is queried via CB_GETATTR for the change      attribute, it checks to see if it holds modified data.  If the      file is modified, the value d is returned for the change attribute      value.  If this file is not currently modified, the client returns      the value c for the change attribute.   For simplicity of implementation, the client MAY for each CB_GETATTR   return the same value d.  This is true even if, between successive   CB_GETATTR operations, the client again modifies in the file's data   or metadata in its cache.  The client can return the same value   because the only requirement is that the client be able to indicate   to the server that the client holds modified data.  Therefore, the   value of d may always be c + 1.   While the change attribute is opaque to the client in the sense that   it has no idea what units of time, if any, the server is counting   change with, it is not opaque in that the client has to treat it as   an unsigned integer, and the server has to be able to see the results   of the client's changes to that integer.  Therefore, the server MUST   encode the change attribute in network order when sending it to the   client.  The client MUST decode it from network order to its native   order when receiving it and the client MUST encode it network order   when sending it to the server.  For this reason, change is defined as   an unsigned integer rather than an opaque array of octets.   For the server, the following steps will be taken when providing a   write delegation:   o  Upon providing a write delegation, the server will cache a copy of      the change attribute in the data structure it uses to record the      delegation.  Let this value be represented by sc.   o  When a second client sends a GETATTR operation on the same file to      the server, the server obtains the change attribute from the first      client.  Let this value be cc.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 107]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   o  If the value cc is equal to sc, the file is not modified and the      server returns the current values for change, time_metadata, and      time_modify (for example) to the second client.   o  If the value cc is NOT equal to sc, the file is currently modified      at the first client and most likely will be modified at the server      at a future time.  The server then uses its current time to      construct attribute values for time_metadata and time_modify.  A      new value of sc, which we will call nsc, is computed by the      server, such that nsc >= sc + 1.  The server then returns the      constructed time_metadata, time_modify, and nsc values to the      requester.  The server replaces sc in the delegation record with      nsc.  To prevent the possibility of time_modify, time_metadata,      and change from appearing to go backward (which would happen if      the client holding the delegation fails to write its modified data      to the server before the delegation is revoked or returned), the      server SHOULD update the file's metadata record with the      constructed attribute values.  For reasons of reasonable      performance, committing the constructed attribute values to stable      storage is OPTIONAL.      As discussed earlier in this section, the client MAY return the      same cc value on subsequent CB_GETATTR calls, even if the file was      modified in the client's cache yet again between successive      CB_GETATTR calls.  Therefore, the server must assume that the file      has been modified yet again, and MUST take care to ensure that the      new nsc it constructs and returns is greater than the previous nsc      it returned.  An example implementation's delegation record would      satisfy this mandate by including a boolean field (let us call it      "modified") that is set to false when the delegation is granted,      and an sc value set at the time of grant to the change attribute      value.  The modified field would be set to true the first time cc      != sc, and would stay true until the delegation is returned or      revoked.  The processing for constructing nsc, time_modify, and      time_metadata would use this pseudo code:      if (!modified) {          do CB_GETATTR for change and size;             if (cc != sc)                 modified = TRUE;         } else {                 do CB_GETATTR for size;         }         if (modified) {             sc = sc + 1;          time_modify = time_metadata = current_time;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 108]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003          update sc, time_modify, time_metadata into file's metadata;      }      return to client (that sent GETATTR) the attributes         it requested, but make sure size comes from what         CB_GETATTR returned.  Do not update the file's metadata         with the client's modified size.   o  In the case that the file attribute size is different than the      server's current value, the server treats this as a modification      regardless of the value of the change attribute retrieved via      CB_GETATTR and responds to the second client as in the last step.   This methodology resolves issues of clock differences between client   and server and other scenarios where the use of CB_GETATTR break   down.   It should be noted that the server is under no obligation to use   CB_GETATTR and therefore the server MAY simply recall the delegation   to avoid its use.9.4.4.  Recall of Open Delegation   The following events necessitate recall of an open delegation:   o  Potentially conflicting OPEN request (or READ/WRITE done with      "special" stateid)   o  SETATTR issued by another client   o  REMOVE request for the file   o  RENAME request for the file as either source or target of the      RENAME   Whether a RENAME of a directory in the path leading to the file   results in recall of an open delegation depends on the semantics of   the server filesystem.  If that filesystem denies such RENAMEs when a   file is open, the recall must be performed to determine whether the   file in question is, in fact, open.   In addition to the situations above, the server may choose to recall   open delegations at any time if resource constraints make it   advisable to do so.  Clients should always be prepared for the   possibility of recall.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 109]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   When a client receives a recall for an open delegation, it needs to   update state on the server before returning the delegation.  These   same updates must be done whenever a client chooses to return a   delegation voluntarily.  The following items of state need to be   dealt with:   o  If the file associated with the delegation is no longer open and      no previous CLOSE operation has been sent to the server, a CLOSE      operation must be sent to the server.   o  If a file has other open references at the client, then OPEN      operations must be sent to the server.  The appropriate stateids      will be provided by the server for subsequent use by the client      since the delegation stateid will not longer be valid.  These OPEN      requests are done with the claim type of CLAIM_DELEGATE_CUR.  This      will allow the presentation of the delegation stateid so that the      client can establish the appropriate rights to perform the OPEN.      (see the section "Operation 18: OPEN" for details.)   o  If there are granted file locks, the corresponding LOCK operations      need to be performed.  This applies to the write open delegation      case only.   o  For a write open delegation, if at the time of recall the file is      not open for write, all modified data for the file must be flushed      to the server.  If the delegation had not existed, the client      would have done this data flush before the CLOSE operation.   o  For a write open delegation when a file is still open at the time      of recall, any modified data for the file needs to be flushed to      the server.   o  With the write open delegation in place, it is possible that the      file was truncated during the duration of the delegation.  For      example, the truncation could have occurred as a result of an OPEN      UNCHECKED with a size attribute value of zero.  Therefore, if a      truncation of the file has occurred and this operation has not      been propagated to the server, the truncation must occur before      any modified data is written to the server.   In the case of write open delegation, file locking imposes some   additional requirements.  To precisely maintain the associated   invariant, it is required to flush any modified data in any region   for which a write lock was released while the write delegation was in   effect.  However, because the write open delegation implies no other   locking by other clients, a simpler implementation is to flush all   modified data for the file (as described just above) if any write   lock has been released while the write open delegation was in effect.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 110]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   An implementation need not wait until delegation recall (or deciding   to voluntarily return a delegation) to perform any of the above   actions, if implementation considerations (e.g., resource   availability constraints) make that desirable.  Generally, however,   the fact that the actual open state of the file may continue to   change makes it not worthwhile to send information about opens and   closes to the server, except as part of delegation return.  Only in   the case of closing the open that resulted in obtaining the   delegation would clients be likely to do this early, since, in that   case, the close once done will not be undone.  Regardless of the   client's choices on scheduling these actions, all must be performed   before the delegation is returned, including (when applicable) the   close that corresponds to the open that resulted in the delegation.   These actions can be performed either in previous requests or in   previous operations in the same COMPOUND request.9.4.5.  Clients that Fail to Honor Delegation Recalls   A client may fail to respond to a recall for various reasons, such as   a failure of the callback path from server to the client.  The client   may be unaware of a failure in the callback path.  This lack of   awareness could result in the client finding out long after the   failure that its delegation has been revoked, and another client has   modified the data for which the client had a delegation.  This is   especially a problem for the client that held a write delegation.   The server also has a dilemma in that the client that fails to   respond to the recall might also be sending other NFS requests,   including those that renew the lease before the lease expires.   Without returning an error for those lease renewing operations, the   server leads the client to believe that the delegation it has is in   force.   This difficulty is solved by the following rules:   o  When the callback path is down, the server MUST NOT revoke the      delegation if one of the following occurs:      -  The client has issued a RENEW operation and the server has         returned an NFS4ERR_CB_PATH_DOWN error.  The server MUST renew         the lease for any record locks and share reservations the         client has that the server has known about (as opposed to those         locks and share reservations the client has established but not         yet sent to the server, due to the delegation).  The server         SHOULD give the client a reasonable time to return its         delegations to the server before revoking the client's         delegations.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 111]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003      -  The client has not issued a RENEW operation for some period of         time after the server attempted to recall the delegation.  This         period of time MUST NOT be less than the value of the         lease_time attribute.   o  When the client holds a delegation, it can not rely on operations,      except for RENEW, that take a stateid, to renew delegation leases      across callback path failures.  The client that wants to keep      delegations in force across callback path failures must use RENEW      to do so.9.4.6.  Delegation Revocation   At the point a delegation is revoked, if there are associated opens   on the client, the applications holding these opens need to be   notified.  This notification usually occurs by returning errors for   READ/WRITE operations or when a close is attempted for the open file.   If no opens exist for the file at the point the delegation is   revoked, then notification of the revocation is unnecessary.   However, if there is modified data present at the client for the   file, the user of the application should be notified.  Unfortunately,   it may not be possible to notify the user since active applications   may not be present at the client.  See the section "Revocation   Recovery for Write Open Delegation" for additional details.9.5.  Data Caching and Revocation   When locks and delegations are revoked, the assumptions upon which   successful caching depend are no longer guaranteed.  For any locks or   share reservations that have been revoked, the corresponding owner   needs to be notified.  This notification includes applications with a   file open that has a corresponding delegation which has been revoked.   Cached data associated with the revocation must be removed from the   client.  In the case of modified data existing in the client's cache,   that data must be removed from the client without it being written to   the server.  As mentioned, the assumptions made by the client are no   longer valid at the point when a lock or delegation has been revoked.   For example, another client may have been granted a conflicting lock   after the revocation of the lock at the first client.  Therefore, the   data within the lock range may have been modified by the other   client.  Obviously, the first client is unable to guarantee to the   application what has occurred to the file in the case of revocation.   Notification to a lock owner will in many cases consist of simply   returning an error on the next and all subsequent READs/WRITEs to the   open file or on the close.  Where the methods available to a client   make such notification impossible because errors for certainShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 112]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   operations may not be returned, more drastic action such as signals   or process termination may be appropriate.  The justification for   this is that an invariant for which an application depends on may be   violated.  Depending on how errors are typically treated for the   client operating environment, further levels of notification   including logging, console messages, and GUI pop-ups may be   appropriate.9.5.1.  Revocation Recovery for Write Open Delegation   Revocation recovery for a write open delegation poses the special   issue of modified data in the client cache while the file is not   open.  In this situation, any client which does not flush modified   data to the server on each close must ensure that the user receives   appropriate notification of the failure as a result of the   revocation.  Since such situations may require human action to   correct problems, notification schemes in which the appropriate user   or administrator is notified may be necessary.  Logging and console   messages are typical examples.   If there is modified data on the client, it must not be flushed   normally to the server.  A client may attempt to provide a copy of   the file data as modified during the delegation under a different   name in the filesystem name space to ease recovery.  Note that when   the client can determine that the file has not been modified by any   other client, or when the client has a complete cached copy of file   in question, such a saved copy of the client's view of the file may   be of particular value for recovery.  In other case, recovery using a   copy of the file based partially on the client's cached data and   partially on the server copy as modified by other clients, will be   anything but straightforward, so clients may avoid saving file   contents in these situations or mark the results specially to warn   users of possible problems.   Saving of such modified data in delegation revocation situations may   be limited to files of a certain size or might be used only when   sufficient disk space is available within the target filesystem.   Such saving may also be restricted to situations when the client has   sufficient buffering resources to keep the cached copy available   until it is properly stored to the target filesystem.9.6.  Attribute Caching   The attributes discussed in this section do not include named   attributes.  Individual named attributes are analogous to files and   caching of the data for these needs to be handled just as dataShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 113]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   caching is for ordinary files.  Similarly, LOOKUP results from an   OPENATTR directory are to be cached on the same basis as any other   pathnames and similarly for directory contents.   Clients may cache file attributes obtained from the server and use   them to avoid subsequent GETATTR requests.  Such caching is write   through in that modification to file attributes is always done by   means of requests to the server and should not be done locally and   cached.  The exception to this are modifications to attributes that   are intimately connected with data caching.  Therefore, extending a   file by writing data to the local data cache is reflected immediately   in the size as seen on the client without this change being   immediately reflected on the server.  Normally such changes are not   propagated directly to the server but when the modified data is   flushed to the server, analogous attribute changes are made on the   server.  When open delegation is in effect, the modified attributes   may be returned to the server in the response to a CB_RECALL call.   The result of local caching of attributes is that the attribute   caches maintained on individual clients will not be coherent.   Changes made in one order on the server may be seen in a different   order on one client and in a third order on a different client.   The typical filesystem application programming interfaces do not   provide means to atomically modify or interrogate attributes for   multiple files at the same time.  The following rules provide an   environment where the potential incoherences mentioned above can be   reasonably managed.  These rules are derived from the practice of   previous NFS protocols.   o  All attributes for a given file (per-fsid attributes excepted) are      cached as a unit at the client so that no non-serializability can      arise within the context of a single file.   o  An upper time boundary is maintained on how long a client cache      entry can be kept without being refreshed from the server.   o  When operations are performed that change attributes at the      server, the updated attribute set is requested as part of the      containing RPC.  This includes directory operations that update      attributes indirectly.  This is accomplished by following the      modifying operation with a GETATTR operation and then using the      results of the GETATTR to update the client's cached attributes.   Note that if the full set of attributes to be cached is requested by   READDIR, the results can be cached by the client on the same basis as   attributes obtained via GETATTR.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 114]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   A client may validate its cached version of attributes for a file by   fetching just both the change and time_access attributes and assuming   that if the change attribute has the same value as it did when the   attributes were cached, then no attributes other than time_access   have changed.  The reason why time_access is also fetched is because   many servers operate in environments where the operation that updates   change does not update time_access.  For example, POSIX file   semantics do not update access time when a file is modified by the   write system call.  Therefore, the client that wants a current   time_access value should fetch it with change during the attribute   cache validation processing and update its cached time_access.   The client may maintain a cache of modified attributes for those   attributes intimately connected with data of modified regular files   (size, time_modify, and change).  Other than those three attributes,   the client MUST NOT maintain a cache of modified attributes.   Instead, attribute changes are immediately sent to the server.   In some operating environments, the equivalent to time_access is   expected to be implicitly updated by each read of the content of the   file object.  If an NFS client is caching the content of a file   object, whether it is a regular file, directory, or symbolic link,   the client SHOULD NOT update the time_access attribute (via SETATTR   or a small READ or READDIR request) on the server with each read that   is satisfied from cache.  The reason is that this can defeat the   performance benefits of caching content, especially since an explicit   SETATTR of time_access may alter the change attribute on the server.   If the change attribute changes, clients that are caching the content   will think the content has changed, and will re-read unmodified data   from the server.  Nor is the client encouraged to maintain a modified   version of time_access in its cache, since this would mean that the   client will either eventually have to write the access time to the   server with bad performance effects, or it would never update the   server's time_access, thereby resulting in a situation where an   application that caches access time between a close and open of the   same file observes the access time oscillating between the past and   present.  The time_access attribute always means the time of last   access to a file by a read that was satisfied by the server.  This   way clients will tend to see only time_access changes that go forward   in time.9.7.  Data and Metadata Caching and Memory Mapped Files   Some operating environments include the capability for an application   to map a file's content into the application's address space.  Each   time the application accesses a memory location that corresponds to a   block that has not been loaded into the address space, a page fault   occurs and the file is read (or if the block does not exist in theShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 115]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   file, the block is allocated and then instantiated in the   application's address space).   As long as each memory mapped access to the file requires a page   fault, the relevant attributes of the file that are used to detect   access and modification (time_access, time_metadata, time_modify, and   change) will be updated.  However, in many operating environments,   when page faults are not required these attributes will not be   updated on reads or updates to the file via memory access (regardless   whether the file is local file or is being access remotely).  A   client or server MAY fail to update attributes of a file that is   being accessed via memory mapped I/O.  This has several implications:   o  If there is an application on the server that has memory mapped a      file that a client is also accessing, the client may not be able      to get a consistent value of the change attribute to determine      whether its cache is stale or not.  A server that knows that the      file is memory mapped could always pessimistically return updated      values for change so as to force the application to always get the      most up to date data and metadata for the file.  However, due to      the negative performance implications of this, such behavior is      OPTIONAL.   o  If the memory mapped file is not being modified on the server, and      instead is just being read by an application via the memory mapped      interface, the client will not see an updated time_access      attribute.  However, in many operating environments, neither will      any process running on the server.  Thus NFS clients are at no      disadvantage with respect to local processes.   o  If there is another client that is memory mapping the file, and if      that client is holding a write delegation, the same set of issues      as discussed in the previous two bullet items apply.  So, when a      server does a CB_GETATTR to a file that the client has modified in      its cache, the response from CB_GETATTR will not necessarily be      accurate.  As discussed earlier, the client's obligation is to      report that the file has been modified since the delegation was      granted, not whether it has been modified again between successive      CB_GETATTR calls, and the server MUST assume that any file the      client has modified in cache has been modified again between      successive CB_GETATTR calls.  Depending on the nature of the      client's memory management system, this weak obligation may not be      possible.  A client MAY return stale information in CB_GETATTR      whenever the file is memory mapped.   o  The mixture of memory mapping and file locking on the same file is      problematic.  Consider the following scenario, where the page size      on each client is 8192 bytes.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 116]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003      -  Client A memory maps first page (8192 bytes) of file X      -  Client B memory maps first page (8192 bytes) of file X      -  Client A write locks first 4096 bytes      -  Client B write locks second 4096 bytes      -  Client A, via a STORE instruction modifies part of its locked         region.      -  Simultaneous to client A, client B issues a STORE on part of         its locked region.   Here the challenge is for each client to resynchronize to get a   correct view of the first page.  In many operating environments, the   virtual memory management systems on each client only know a page is   modified, not that a subset of the page corresponding to the   respective lock regions has been modified.  So it is not possible for   each client to do the right thing, which is to only write to the   server that portion of the page that is locked. For example, if   client A simply writes out the page, and then client B writes out the   page, client A's data is lost.   Moreover, if mandatory locking is enabled on the file, then we have a   different problem.  When clients A and B issue the STORE   instructions, the resulting page faults require a record lock on the   entire page.  Each client then tries to extend their locked range to   the entire page, which results in a deadlock.   Communicating the NFS4ERR_DEADLOCK error to a STORE instruction is   difficult at best.   If a client is locking the entire memory mapped file, there is no   problem with advisory or mandatory record locking, at least until the   client unlocks a region in the middle of the file.   Given the above issues the following are permitted:   -  Clients and servers MAY deny memory mapping a file they know there      are record locks for.   -  Clients and servers MAY deny a record lock on a file they know is      memory mapped.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 117]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   -  A client MAY deny memory mapping a file that it knows requires      mandatory locking for I/O.  If mandatory locking is enabled after      the file is opened and mapped, the client MAY deny the application      further access to its mapped file.9.8.  Name Caching   The results of LOOKUP and READDIR operations may be cached to avoid   the cost of subsequent LOOKUP operations.  Just as in the case of   attribute caching, inconsistencies may arise among the various client   caches.  To mitigate the effects of these inconsistencies and given   the context of typical filesystem APIs, an upper time boundary is   maintained on how long a client name cache entry can be kept without   verifying that the entry has not been made invalid by a directory   change operation performed by another client.   When a client is not making changes to a directory for which there   exist name cache entries, the client needs to periodically fetch   attributes for that directory to ensure that it is not being   modified.  After determining that no modification has occurred, the   expiration time for the associated name cache entries may be updated   to be the current time plus the name cache staleness bound.   When a client is making changes to a given directory, it needs to   determine whether there have been changes made to the directory by   other clients.  It does this by using the change attribute as   reported before and after the directory operation in the associated   change_info4 value returned for the operation.  The server is able to   communicate to the client whether the change_info4 data is provided   atomically with respect to the directory operation.  If the change   values are provided atomically, the client is then able to compare   the pre-operation change value with the change value in the client's   name cache.  If the comparison indicates that the directory was   updated by another client, the name cache associated with the   modified directory is purged from the client.  If the comparison   indicates no modification, the name cache can be updated on the   client to reflect the directory operation and the associated timeout   extended.  The post-operation change value needs to be saved as the   basis for future change_info4 comparisons.   As demonstrated by the scenario above, name caching requires that the   client revalidate name cache data by inspecting the change attribute   of a directory at the point when the name cache item was cached.   This requires that the server update the change attribute for   directories when the contents of the corresponding directory is   modified.  For a client to use the change_info4 information   appropriately and correctly, the server must report the pre and post   operation change attribute values atomically.  When the server isShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 118]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   unable to report the before and after values atomically with respect   to the directory operation, the server must indicate that fact in the   change_info4 return value.  When the information is not atomically   reported, the client should not assume that other clients have not   changed the directory.9.9.  Directory Caching   The results of READDIR operations may be used to avoid subsequent   READDIR operations.  Just as in the cases of attribute and name   caching, inconsistencies may arise among the various client caches.   To mitigate the effects of these inconsistencies, and given the   context of typical filesystem APIs, the following rules should be   followed:   o  Cached READDIR information for a directory which is not obtained      in a single READDIR operation must always be a consistent snapshot      of directory contents.  This is determined by using a GETATTR      before the first READDIR and after the last of READDIR that      contributes to the cache.   o  An upper time boundary is maintained to indicate the length of      time a directory cache entry is considered valid before the client      must revalidate the cached information.   The revalidation technique parallels that discussed in the case of   name caching.  When the client is not changing the directory in   question, checking the change attribute of the directory with GETATTR   is adequate.  The lifetime of the cache entry can be extended at   these checkpoints.  When a client is modifying the directory, the   client needs to use the change_info4 data to determine whether there   are other clients modifying the directory.  If it is determined that   no other client modifications are occurring, the client may update   its directory cache to reflect its own changes.   As demonstrated previously, directory caching requires that the   client revalidate directory cache data by inspecting the change   attribute of a directory at the point when the directory was cached.   This requires that the server update the change attribute for   directories when the contents of the corresponding directory is   modified.  For a client to use the change_info4 information   appropriately and correctly, the server must report the pre and post   operation change attribute values atomically.  When the server is   unable to report the before and after values atomically with respect   to the directory operation, the server must indicate that fact in the   change_info4 return value.  When the information is not atomically   reported, the client should not assume that other clients have not   changed the directory.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 119]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 200310.  Minor Versioning   To address the requirement of an NFS protocol that can evolve as the   need arises, the NFS version 4 protocol contains the rules and   framework to allow for future minor changes or versioning.   The base assumption with respect to minor versioning is that any   future accepted minor version must follow the IETF process and be   documented in a standards track RFC.  Therefore, each minor version   number will correspond to an RFC.  Minor version zero of the NFS   version 4 protocol is represented by this RFC.  The COMPOUND   procedure will support the encoding of the minor version being   requested by the client.   The following items represent the basic rules for the development of   minor versions.  Note that a future minor version may decide to   modify or add to the following rules as part of the minor version   definition.    1.  Procedures are not added or deleted        To maintain the general RPC model, NFS version 4 minor versions        will not add to or delete procedures from the NFS program.    2.  Minor versions may add operations to the COMPOUND and        CB_COMPOUND procedures.        The addition of operations to the COMPOUND and CB_COMPOUND        procedures does not affect the RPC model.    2.1 Minor versions may append attributes to GETATTR4args, bitmap4,        and GETATTR4res.        This allows for the expansion of the attribute model to allow        for future growth or adaptation.    2.2 Minor version X must append any new attributes after the last        documented attribute.        Since attribute results are specified as an opaque array of        per-attribute XDR encoded results, the complexity of adding new        attributes in the midst of the current definitions will be too        burdensome.    3.  Minor versions must not modify the structure of an existing        operation's arguments or results.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 120]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003        Again the complexity of handling multiple structure definitions        for a single operation is too burdensome.  New operations should        be added instead of modifying existing structures for a minor        version.        This rule does not preclude the following adaptations in a minor        version.      o  adding bits to flag fields such as new attributes to GETATTR's         bitmap4 data type      o  adding bits to existing attributes like ACLs that have flag         words      o  extending enumerated types (including NFS4ERR_*) with new         values    4.  Minor versions may not modify the structure of existing        attributes.    5.  Minor versions may not delete operations.        This prevents the potential reuse of a particular operation        "slot" in a future minor version.    6.  Minor versions may not delete attributes.    7.  Minor versions may not delete flag bits or enumeration values.    8.  Minor versions may declare an operation as mandatory to NOT        implement.        Specifying an operation as "mandatory to not implement" is        equivalent to obsoleting an operation.  For the client, it means        that the operation should not be sent to the server.  For the        server, an NFS error can be returned as opposed to "dropping"        the request as an XDR decode error.  This approach allows for        the obsolescence of an operation while maintaining its structure        so that a future minor version can reintroduce the operation.    8.1 Minor versions may declare attributes mandatory to NOT        implement.    8.2 Minor versions may declare flag bits or enumeration values as        mandatory to NOT implement.    9.  Minor versions may downgrade features from mandatory to        recommended, or recommended to optional.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 121]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003    10. Minor versions may upgrade features from optional to recommended        or recommended to mandatory.    11. A client and server that support minor version X must support        minor versions 0 (zero) through X-1 as well.    12. No new features may be introduced as mandatory in a minor        version.        This rule allows for the introduction of new functionality and        forces the use of implementation experience before designating a        feature as mandatory.    13. A client MUST NOT attempt to use a stateid, filehandle, or        similar returned object from the COMPOUND procedure with minor        version X for another COMPOUND procedure with minor version Y,        where X != Y.11.  Internationalization   The primary issue in which NFS version 4 needs to deal with   internationalization, or I18N, is with respect to file names and   other strings as used within the protocol.  The choice of string   representation must allow reasonable name/string access to clients   which use various languages.  The UTF-8 encoding of the UCS as   defined by [ISO10646] allows for this type of access and follows the   policy described in "IETF Policy on Character Sets and Languages",   [RFC2277].   [RFC3454], otherwise know as "stringprep", documents a framework for   using Unicode/UTF-8 in networking protocols, so as "to increase the   likelihood that string input and string comparison work in ways that   make sense for typical users throughout the world."  A protocol must   define a profile of stringprep "in order to fully specify the   processing options."  The remainder of this Internationalization   section defines the NFS version 4 stringprep profiles.  Much of   terminology used for the remainder of this section comes from   stringprep.   There are three UTF-8 string types defined for NFS version 4:   utf8str_cs, utf8str_cis, and utf8str_mixed.  Separate profiles are   defined for each. Each profile defines the following, as required by   stringprep:   o  The intended applicability of the profileShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 122]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   o  The character repertoire that is the input and output to      stringprep (which is Unicode 3.2 for referenced version of      stringprep)   o  The mapping tables from stringprep used (as described insection 3      of stringprep)   o  Any additional mapping tables specific to the profile   o  The Unicode normalization used, if any (as described insection 4      of stringprep)   o  The tables from stringprep listing of characters that are      prohibited as output (as described insection 5 of stringprep)   o  The bidirectional string testing used, if any (as described insection 6 of stringprep)   o  Any additional characters that are prohibited as output specific      to the profile   Stringprep discusses Unicode characters, whereas NFS version 4   renders UTF-8 characters.  Since there is a one to one mapping from   UTF-8 to Unicode, where ever the remainder of this document refers to   to Unicode, the reader should assume UTF-8.   Much of the text for the profiles comes from [RFC3454].11.1.  Stringprep profile for the utf8str_cs type   Every use of the utf8str_cs type definition in the NFS version 4   protocol specification follows the profile named nfs4_cs_prep.11.1.1.  Intended applicability of the nfs4_cs_prep profile   The utf8str_cs type is a case sensitive string of UTF-8 characters.   Its primary use in NFS Version 4 is for naming components and   pathnames.  Components and pathnames are stored on the server's   filesystem.  Two valid distinct UTF-8 strings might be the same after   processing via the utf8str_cs profile.  If the strings are two names   inside a directory, the NFS version 4 server will need to either:   o  disallow the creation of a second name if it's post processed form      collides with that of an existing name, or   o  allow the creation of the second name, but arrange so that after      post processing, the second name is different than the post      processed form of the first name.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 123]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 200311.1.2.  Character repertoire of nfs4_cs_prep   The nfs4_cs_prep profile uses Unicode 3.2, as defined in stringprep'sAppendix A.111.1.3.  Mapping used by nfs4_cs_prep   The nfs4_cs_prep profile specifies mapping using the following tables   from stringprep:      Table B.1   Table B.2 is normally not part of the nfs4_cs_prep profile as it is   primarily for dealing with case-insensitive comparisons.  However, if   the NFS version 4 file server supports the case_insensitive   filesystem attribute, and if case_insensitive is true, the NFS   version 4 server MUST use Table B.2 (in addition to Table B1) when   processing utf8str_cs strings, and the NFS version 4 client MUST   assume Table B.2 (in addition to Table B.1) are being used.   If the case_preserving attribute is present and set to false, then   the NFS version 4 server MUST use table B.2 to map case when   processing utf8str_cs strings.  Whether the server maps from lower to   upper case or the upper to lower case is an implementation   dependency.11.1.4.  Normalization used by nfs4_cs_prep   The nfs4_cs_prep profile does not specify a normalization form.  A   later revision of this specification may specify a particular   normalization form.  Therefore, the server and client can expect that   they may receive unnormalized characters within protocol requests and   responses.  If the operating environment requires normalization, then   the implementation must normalize utf8str_cs strings within the   protocol before presenting the information to an application (at the   client) or local filesystem (at the server).Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 124]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 200311.1.5.  Prohibited output for nfs4_cs_prep   The nfs4_cs_prep profile specifies prohibiting using the following   tables from stringprep:      Table C.3      Table C.4      Table C.5      Table C.6      Table C.7      Table C.8      Table C.911.1.6.  Bidirectional output for nfs4_cs_prep   The nfs4_cs_prep profile does not specify any checking of   bidirectional strings.11.2.  Stringprep profile for the utf8str_cis type   Every use of the utf8str_cis type definition in the NFS version 4   protocol specification follows the profile named nfs4_cis_prep.11.2.1.  Intended applicability of the nfs4_cis_prep profile   The utf8str_cis type is a case insensitive string of UTF-8   characters.  Its primary use in NFS Version 4 is for naming NFS   servers.11.2.2.  Character repertoire of nfs4_cis_prep   The nfs4_cis_prep profile uses Unicode 3.2, as defined in   stringprep'sAppendix A.111.2.3.  Mapping used by nfs4_cis_prep   The nfs4_cis_prep profile specifies mapping using the following   tables from stringprep:      Table B.1      Table B.211.2.4.  Normalization used by nfs4_cis_prep   The nfs4_cis_prep profile specifies using Unicode normalization form   KC, as described in stringprep.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 125]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 200311.2.5.  Prohibited output for nfs4_cis_prep   The nfs4_cis_prep profile specifies prohibiting using the following   tables from stringprep:      Table C.1.2      Table C.2.2      Table C.3      Table C.4      Table C.5      Table C.6      Table C.7      Table C.8      Table C.911.2.6.  Bidirectional output for nfs4_cis_prep   The nfs4_cis_prep profile specifies checking bidirectional strings as   described in stringprep'ssection 6.11.3.  Stringprep profile for the utf8str_mixed type   Every use of the utf8str_mixed type definition in the NFS version 4   protocol specification follows the profile named nfs4_mixed_prep.11.3.1.  Intended applicability of the nfs4_mixed_prep profile   The utf8str_mixed type is a string of UTF-8 characters, with a prefix   that is case sensitive, a separator equal to '@', and a suffix that   is fully qualified domain name.  Its primary use in NFS Version 4 is   for naming principals identified in an Access Control Entry.11.3.2.  Character repertoire of nfs4_mixed_prep   The nfs4_mixed_prep profile uses Unicode 3.2, as defined in   stringprep'sAppendix A.111.3.3.  Mapping used by nfs4_cis_prep   For the prefix and the separator of a utf8str_mixed string, the   nfs4_mixed_prep profile specifies mapping using the following table   from stringprep:      Table B.1   For the suffix of a utf8str_mixed string, the nfs4_mixed_prep profile   specifies mapping using the following tables from stringprep:Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 126]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003      Table B.1      Table B.211.3.4.  Normalization used by nfs4_mixed_prep   The nfs4_mixed_prep profile specifies using Unicode normalization   form KC, as described in stringprep.11.3.5.  Prohibited output for nfs4_mixed_prep   The nfs4_mixed_prep profile specifies prohibiting using the following   tables from stringprep:      Table C.1.2      Table C.2.2      Table C.3      Table C.4      Table C.5      Table C.6      Table C.7      Table C.8      Table C.911.3.6.  Bidirectional output for nfs4_mixed_prep   The nfs4_mixed_prep profile specifies checking bidirectional strings   as described in stringprep'ssection 6.11.4.  UTF-8 Related Errors   Where the client sends an invalid UTF-8 string, the server should   return an NFS4ERR_INVAL error.  This includes cases in which   inappropriate prefixes are detected and where the count includes   trailing bytes that do not constitute a full UCS character.   Where the client supplied string is valid UTF-8 but contains   characters that are not supported by the server as a value for that   string (e.g., names containing characters that have more than two   octets on a filesystem that supports Unicode characters only), the   server should return an NFS4ERR_BADCHAR error.   Where a UTF-8 string is used as a file name, and the filesystem,   while supporting all of the characters within the name, does not   allow that particular name to be used, the server should return the   error NFS4ERR_BADNAME.  This includes situations in which the server   filesystem imposes a normalization constraint on name strings, butShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 127]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   will also include such situations as filesystem prohibitions of "."   and ".." as file names for certain operations, and other such   constraints.12.  Error Definitions   NFS error numbers are assigned to failed operations within a compound   request.  A compound request contains a number of NFS operations that   have their results encoded in sequence in a compound reply.  The   results of successful operations will consist of an NFS4_OK status   followed by the encoded results of the operation.  If an NFS   operation fails, an error status will be entered in the reply and the   compound request will be terminated.   A description of each defined error follows:   NFS4_OK               Indicates the operation completed successfully.   NFS4ERR_ACCESS        Permission denied. The caller does not have the                         correct permission to perform the requested                         operation. Contrast this with NFS4ERR_PERM,                         which restricts itself to owner or privileged                         user permission failures.   NFS4ERR_ATTRNOTSUPP   An attribute specified is not supported by the                         server.  Does not apply to the GETATTR                         operation.   NFS4ERR_ADMIN_REVOKED Due to administrator intervention, the                         lockowner's record locks, share reservations,                         and delegations have been revoked by the                         server.   NFS4ERR_BADCHAR       A UTF-8 string contains a character which is                         not supported by the server in the context in                         which it being used.   NFS4ERR_BAD_COOKIE    READDIR cookie is stale.   NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE     Illegal NFS filehandle. The filehandle failed                         internal consistency checks.   NFS4ERR_BADNAME       A name string in a request consists of valid                         UTF-8 characters supported by the server but                         the name is not supported by the server as a                         valid name for current operation.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 128]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   NFS4ERR_BADOWNER      An owner, owner_group, or ACL attribute value                         can not be translated to local representation.   NFS4ERR_BADTYPE       An attempt was made to create an object of a                         type not supported by the server.   NFS4ERR_BAD_RANGE     The range for a LOCK, LOCKT, or LOCKU operation                         is not appropriate to the allowable range of                         offsets for the server.   NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQID     The sequence number in a locking request is                         neither the next expected number or the last                         number processed.   NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID   A stateid generated by the current server                         instance, but which does not designate any                         locking state (either current or superseded)                         for a current lockowner-file pair, was used.   NFS4ERR_BADXDR        The server encountered an XDR decoding error                         while processing an operation.   NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE    The SETCLIENTID operation has found that a                         client id is already in use by another client.   NFS4ERR_DEADLOCK      The server has been able to determine a file                         locking deadlock condition for a blocking lock                         request.   NFS4ERR_DELAY         The server initiated the request, but was not                         able to complete it in a timely fashion. The                         client should wait and then try the request                         with a new RPC transaction ID.  For example,                         this error should be returned from a server                         that supports hierarchical storage and receives                         a request to process a file that has been                         migrated. In this case, the server should start                         the immigration process and respond to client                         with this error.  This error may also occur                         when a necessary delegation recall makes                         processing a request in a timely fashion                         impossible.   NFS4ERR_DENIED        An attempt to lock a file is denied.  Since                         this may be a temporary condition, the client                         is encouraged to retry the lock request until                         the lock is accepted.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 129]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   NFS4ERR_DQUOT         Resource (quota) hard limit exceeded. The                         user's resource limit on the server has been                         exceeded.   NFS4ERR_EXIST         File exists. The file specified already exists.   NFS4ERR_EXPIRED       A lease has expired that is being used in the                         current operation.   NFS4ERR_FBIG          File too large. The operation would have caused                         a file to grow beyond the server's limit.   NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED     The filehandle provided is volatile and has                         expired at the server.   NFS4ERR_FILE_OPEN     The operation can not be successfully processed                         because a file involved in the operation is                         currently open.   NFS4ERR_GRACE         The server is in its recovery or grace period                         which should match the lease period of the                         server.   NFS4ERR_INVAL         Invalid argument or unsupported argument for an                         operation. Two examples are attempting a                         READLINK on an object other than a symbolic                         link or specifying a value for an enum field                         that is not defined in the protocol (e.g.,                         nfs_ftype4).   NFS4ERR_IO            I/O error. A hard error (for example, a disk                         error) occurred while processing the requested                         operation.   NFS4ERR_ISDIR         Is a directory. The caller specified a                         directory in a non-directory operation.   NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED   A lease being renewed is associated with a                         filesystem that has been migrated to a new                         server.   NFS4ERR_LOCKED        A read or write operation was attempted on a                         locked file.   NFS4ERR_LOCK_NOTSUPP  Server does not support atomic upgrade or                         downgrade of locks.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 130]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   NFS4ERR_LOCK_RANGE    A lock request is operating on a sub-range of a                         current lock for the lock owner and the server                         does not support this type of request.   NFS4ERR_LOCKS_HELD    A CLOSE was attempted and file locks would                         exist after the CLOSE.   NFS4ERR_MINOR_VERS_MISMATCH                         The server has received a request that                         specifies an unsupported minor version.  The                         server must return a COMPOUND4res with a zero                         length operations result array.   NFS4ERR_MLINK         Too many hard links.   NFS4ERR_MOVED         The filesystem which contains the current                         filehandle object has been relocated or                         migrated to another server.  The client may                         obtain the new filesystem location by obtaining                         the "fs_locations" attribute for the current                         filehandle.  For further discussion, refer to                         the section "Filesystem Migration or                         Relocation".   NFS4ERR_NAMETOOLONG   The filename in an operation was too long.   NFS4ERR_NOENT         No such file or directory. The file or                         directory name specified does not exist.   NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE  The logical current filehandle value (or, in                         the case of RESTOREFH, the saved filehandle                         value) has not been set properly.  This may be                         a result of a malformed COMPOUND operation                         (i.e., no PUTFH or PUTROOTFH before an                         operation that requires the current filehandle                         be set).   NFS4ERR_NO_GRACE      A reclaim of client state has fallen outside of                         the grace period of the server.  As a result,                         the server can not guarantee that conflicting                         state has not been provided to another client.   NFS4ERR_NOSPC         No space left on device. The operation would                         have caused the server's filesystem to exceed                         its limit.   NFS4ERR_NOTDIR        Not a directory. The caller specified a non-                         directory in a directory operation.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 131]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   NFS4ERR_NOTEMPTY      An attempt was made to remove a directory that                         was not empty.   NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP       Operation is not supported.   NFS4ERR_NOT_SAME      This error is returned by the VERIFY operation                         to signify that the attributes compared were                         not the same as provided in the client's                         request.   NFS4ERR_NXIO          I/O error. No such device or address.   NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID   A stateid which designates the locking state                         for a lockowner-file at an earlier time was                         used.   NFS4ERR_OPENMODE      The client attempted a READ, WRITE, LOCK or                         SETATTR operation not sanctioned by the stateid                         passed (e.g., writing to a file opened only for                         read).   NFS4ERR_OP_ILLEGAL    An illegal operation value has been specified                         in the argop field of a COMPOUND or CB_COMPOUND                         procedure.   NFS4ERR_PERM          Not owner. The operation was not allowed                         because the caller is either not a privileged                         user (root) or not the owner of the target of                         the operation.   NFS4ERR_RECLAIM_BAD   The reclaim provided by the client does not                         match any of the server's state consistency                         checks and is bad.   NFS4ERR_RECLAIM_CONFLICT                         The reclaim provided by the client has                         encountered a conflict and can not be provided.                         Potentially indicates a misbehaving client.   NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      For the processing of the COMPOUND procedure,                         the server may exhaust available resources and                         can not continue processing operations within                         the COMPOUND procedure.  This error will be                         returned from the server in those instances of                         resource exhaustion related to the processing                         of the COMPOUND procedure.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 132]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   NFS4ERR_RESTOREFH     The RESTOREFH operation does not have a saved                         filehandle (identified by SAVEFH) to operate                         upon.   NFS4ERR_ROFS          Read-only filesystem. A modifying operation was                         attempted on a read-only filesystem.   NFS4ERR_SAME          This error is returned by the NVERIFY operation                         to signify that the attributes compared were                         the same as provided in the client's request.   NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT   An error occurred on the server which does not                         map to any of the legal NFS version 4 protocol                         error values.  The client should translate this                         into an appropriate error.  UNIX clients may                         choose to translate this to EIO.   NFS4ERR_SHARE_DENIED  An attempt to OPEN a file with a share                         reservation has failed because of a share                         conflict.   NFS4ERR_STALE         Invalid filehandle. The filehandle given in the                         arguments was invalid. The file referred to by                         that filehandle no longer exists or access to                         it has been revoked.   NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID A clientid not recognized by the server was                          used in a locking or SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM                          request.   NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID A stateid generated by an earlier server                         instance was used.   NFS4ERR_SYMLINK       The current filehandle provided for a LOOKUP is                         not a directory but a symbolic link.  Also used                         if the final component of the OPEN path is a                         symbolic link.   NFS4ERR_TOOSMALL      The encoded response to a READDIR request                         exceeds the size limit set by the initial                         request.   NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC      The security mechanism being used by the client                         for the operation does not match the server's                         security policy.  The client should change the                         security mechanism being used and retry the                         operation.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 133]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   NFS4ERR_XDEV          Attempt to do an operation between different                         fsids.13.  NFS version 4 Requests   For the NFS version 4 RPC program, there are two traditional RPC   procedures: NULL and COMPOUND.  All other functionality is defined as   a set of operations and these operations are defined in normal   XDR/RPC syntax and semantics.  However, these operations are   encapsulated within the COMPOUND procedure.  This requires that the   client combine one or more of the NFS version 4 operations into a   single request.   The NFS4_CALLBACK program is used to provide server to client   signaling and is constructed in a similar fashion as the NFS version   4 program.  The procedures CB_NULL and CB_COMPOUND are defined in the   same way as NULL and COMPOUND are within the NFS program.  The   CB_COMPOUND request also encapsulates the remaining operations of the   NFS4_CALLBACK program.  There is no predefined RPC program number for   the NFS4_CALLBACK program.  It is up to the client to specify a   program number in the "transient" program range.  The program and   port number of the NFS4_CALLBACK program are provided by the client   as part of the SETCLIENTID/SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM sequence. The program   and port can be changed by another SETCLIENTID/SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM   sequence, and it is possible to use the sequence to change them   within a client incarnation without removing relevant leased client   state.13.1.  Compound Procedure   The COMPOUND procedure provides the opportunity for better   performance within high latency networks.  The client can avoid   cumulative latency of multiple RPCs by combining multiple dependent   operations into a single COMPOUND procedure.  A compound operation   may provide for protocol simplification by allowing the client to   combine basic procedures into a single request that is customized for   the client's environment.   The CB_COMPOUND procedure precisely parallels the features of   COMPOUND as described above.   The basic structure of the COMPOUND procedure is:   +-----+--------------+--------+-----------+-----------+-----------+--   | tag | minorversion | numops | op + args | op + args | op + args |   +-----+--------------+--------+-----------+-----------+-----------+--Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 134]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   and the reply's structure is:      +------------+-----+--------+-----------------------+--      |last status | tag | numres | status + op + results |      +------------+-----+--------+-----------------------+--   The numops and numres fields, used in the depiction above, represent   the count for the counted array encoding use to signify the number of   arguments or results encoded in the request and response.  As per the   XDR encoding, these counts must match exactly the number of operation   arguments or results encoded.13.2.  Evaluation of a Compound Request   The server will process the COMPOUND procedure by evaluating each of   the operations within the COMPOUND procedure in order.  Each   component operation consists of a 32 bit operation code, followed by   the argument of length determined by the type of operation. The   results of each operation are encoded in sequence into a reply   buffer.  The results of each operation are preceded by the opcode and   a status code (normally zero).  If an operation results in a non-zero   status code, the status will be encoded and evaluation of the   compound sequence will halt and the reply will be returned.  Note   that evaluation stops even in the event of "non error" conditions   such as NFS4ERR_SAME.   There are no atomicity requirements for the operations contained   within the COMPOUND procedure.  The operations being evaluated as   part of a COMPOUND request may be evaluated simultaneously with other   COMPOUND requests that the server receives.   It is the client's responsibility for recovering from any partially   completed COMPOUND procedure.  Partially completed COMPOUND   procedures may occur at any point due to errors such as   NFS4ERR_RESOURCE and NFS4ERR_DELAY.  This may occur even given an   otherwise valid operation string.  Further, a server reboot which   occurs in the middle of processing a COMPOUND procedure may leave the   client with the difficult task of determining how far COMPOUND   processing has proceeded.  Therefore, the client should avoid overly   complex COMPOUND procedures in the event of the failure of an   operation within the procedure.   Each operation assumes a "current" and "saved" filehandle that is   available as part of the execution context of the compound request.   Operations may set, change, or return the current filehandle.  The   "saved" filehandle is used for temporary storage of a filehandle   value and as operands for the RENAME and LINK operations.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 135]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 200313.3.  Synchronous Modifying Operations   NFS version 4 operations that modify the filesystem are synchronous.   When an operation is successfully completed at the server, the client   can depend that any data associated with the request is now on stable   storage (the one exception is in the case of the file data in a WRITE   operation with the UNSTABLE option specified).   This implies that any previous operations within the same compound   request are also reflected in stable storage.  This behavior enables   the client's ability to recover from a partially executed compound   request which may resulted from the failure of the server.  For   example, if a compound request contains operations A and B and the   server is unable to send a response to the client, depending on the   progress the server made in servicing the request the result of both   operations may be reflected in stable storage or just operation A may   be reflected.  The server must not have just the results of operation   B in stable storage.13.4.  Operation Values   The operations encoded in the COMPOUND procedure are identified by   operation values.  To avoid overlap with the RPC procedure numbers,   operations 0 (zero) and 1 are not defined.  Operation 2 is not   defined but reserved for future use with minor versioning.14.  NFS version 4 Procedures14.1.  Procedure 0: NULL - No Operation   SYNOPSIS      <null>   ARGUMENT      void;   RESULT      void;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 136]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   DESCRIPTION      Standard NULL procedure.  Void argument, void response.  This      procedure has no functionality associated with it.  Because of      this it is sometimes used to measure the overhead of processing a      service request.  Therefore, the server should ensure that no      unnecessary work is done in servicing this procedure.   ERRORS      None.14.2.  Procedure 1: COMPOUND - Compound Operations   SYNOPSIS     compoundargs -> compoundres   ARGUMENT     union nfs_argop4 switch (nfs_opnum4 argop) {             case <OPCODE>: <argument>;             ...     };     struct COMPOUND4args {             utf8str_cs      tag;             uint32_t        minorversion;             nfs_argop4      argarray<>;     };   RESULT     union nfs_resop4 switch (nfs_opnum4 resop){             case <OPCODE>: <result>;             ...     };     struct COMPOUND4res {             nfsstat4        status;             utf8str_cs      tag;             nfs_resop4      resarray<>;     };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 137]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   DESCRIPTION   The COMPOUND procedure is used to combine one or more of the NFS   operations into a single RPC request.  The main NFS RPC program has   two main procedures: NULL and COMPOUND.  All other operations use the   COMPOUND procedure as a wrapper.   The COMPOUND procedure is used to combine individual operations into   a single RPC request.  The server interprets each of the operations   in turn.  If an operation is executed by the server and the status of   that operation is NFS4_OK, then the next operation in the COMPOUND   procedure is executed.  The server continues this process until there   are no more operations to be executed or one of the operations has a   status value other than NFS4_OK.   In the processing of the COMPOUND procedure, the server may find that   it does not have the available resources to execute any or all of the   operations within the COMPOUND sequence.  In this case, the error   NFS4ERR_RESOURCE will be returned for the particular operation within   the COMPOUND procedure where the resource exhaustion occurred.  This   assumes that all previous operations within the COMPOUND sequence   have been evaluated successfully.  The results for all of the   evaluated operations must be returned to the client.   The server will generally choose between two methods of decoding the   client's request.  The first would be the traditional one-pass XDR   decode, in which decoding of the entire COMPOUND precedes execution   of any operation within it.  If there is an XDR decoding error in   this case, an RPC XDR decode error would be returned.  The second   method would be to make an initial pass to decode the basic COMPOUND   request and then to XDR decode each of the individual operations, as   the server is ready to execute it.  In this case, the server may   encounter an XDR decode error during such an operation decode, after   previous operations within the COMPOUND have been executed.  In this   case, the server would return the error NFS4ERR_BADXDR to signify the   decode error.   The COMPOUND arguments contain a "minorversion" field.  The initial   and default value for this field is 0 (zero).  This field will be   used by future minor versions such that the client can communicate to   the server what minor version is being requested.  If the server   receives a COMPOUND procedure with a minorversion field value that it   does not support, the server MUST return an error of   NFS4ERR_MINOR_VERS_MISMATCH and a zero length resultdata array.   Contained within the COMPOUND results is a "status" field.  If the   results array length is non-zero, this status must be equivalent to   the status of the last operation that was executed within theShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 138]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   COMPOUND procedure.  Therefore, if an operation incurred an error   then the "status" value will be the same error value as is being   returned for the operation that failed.   Note that operations, 0 (zero) and 1 (one) are not defined for the   COMPOUND procedure.  Operation 2 is not defined but reserved for   future definition and use with minor versioning.  If the server   receives a operation array that contains operation 2 and the   minorversion field has a value of 0 (zero), an error of   NFS4ERR_OP_ILLEGAL, as described in the next paragraph, is returned   to the client.  If an operation array contains an operation 2 and the   minorversion field is non-zero and the server does not support the   minor version, the server returns an error of   NFS4ERR_MINOR_VERS_MISMATCH.  Therefore, the   NFS4ERR_MINOR_VERS_MISMATCH error takes precedence over all other   errors.   It is possible that the server receives a request that contains an   operation that is less than the first legal operation (OP_ACCESS) or   greater than the last legal operation (OP_RELEASE_LOCKOWNER).   In this case, the server's response will encode the opcode OP_ILLEGAL   rather than the illegal opcode of the request. The status field in   the ILLEGAL return results will set to NFS4ERR_OP_ILLEGAL.  The   COMPOUND procedure's return results will also be NFS4ERR_OP_ILLEGAL.   The definition of the "tag" in the request is left to the   implementor.  It may be used to summarize the content of the compound   request for the benefit of packet sniffers and engineers debugging   implementations.  However, the value of "tag" in the response SHOULD   be the same value as provided in the request.  This applies to the   tag field of the CB_COMPOUND procedure as well.   IMPLEMENTATION   Since an error of any type may occur after only a portion of the   operations have been evaluated, the client must be prepared to   recover from any failure.  If the source of an NFS4ERR_RESOURCE error   was a complex or lengthy set of operations, it is likely that if the   number of operations were reduced the server would be able to   evaluate them successfully.  Therefore, the client is responsible for   dealing with this type of complexity in recovery.   ERRORS   All errors defined in the protocolShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 139]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 200314.2.1.  Operation 3: ACCESS - Check Access Rights   SYNOPSIS     (cfh), accessreq -> supported, accessrights   ARGUMENT     const ACCESS4_READ      = 0x00000001;     const ACCESS4_LOOKUP    = 0x00000002;     const ACCESS4_MODIFY    = 0x00000004;     const ACCESS4_EXTEND    = 0x00000008;     const ACCESS4_DELETE    = 0x00000010;     const ACCESS4_EXECUTE   = 0x00000020;     struct ACCESS4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: object */             uint32_t        access;     };   RESULT     struct ACCESS4resok {             uint32_t        supported;             uint32_t        access;     };     union ACCESS4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4_OK:              ACCESS4resok   resok4;      default:              void;     };   DESCRIPTION   ACCESS determines the access rights that a user, as identified by the   credentials in the RPC request, has with respect to the file system   object specified by the current filehandle.  The client encodes the   set of access rights that are to be checked in the bit mask "access".   The server checks the permissions encoded in the bit mask.  If a   status of NFS4_OK is returned, two bit masks are included in the   response.  The first, "supported", represents the access rights for   which the server can verify reliably.  The second, "access",   represents the access rights available to the user for the filehandle   provided.  On success, the current filehandle retains its value.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 140]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   Note that the supported field will contain only as many values as   were originally sent in the arguments.  For example, if the client   sends an ACCESS operation with only the ACCESS4_READ value set and   the server supports this value, the server will return only   ACCESS4_READ even if it could have reliably checked other values.   The results of this operation are necessarily advisory in nature.  A   return status of NFS4_OK and the appropriate bit set in the bit mask   does not imply that such access will be allowed to the file system   object in the future. This is because access rights can be revoked by   the server at any time.   The following access permissions may be requested:   ACCESS4_READ    Read data from file or read a directory.   ACCESS4_LOOKUP  Look up a name in a directory (no meaning for non-                   directory objects).   ACCESS4_MODIFY  Rewrite existing file data or modify existing                   directory entries.   ACCESS4_EXTEND  Write new data or add directory entries.   ACCESS4_DELETE  Delete an existing directory entry.   ACCESS4_EXECUTE Execute file (no meaning for a directory).   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION   In general, it is not sufficient for the client to attempt to deduce   access permissions by inspecting the uid, gid, and mode fields in the   file attributes or by attempting to interpret the contents of the ACL   attribute.  This is because the server may perform uid or gid mapping   or enforce additional access control restrictions.  It is also   possible that the server may not be in the same ID space as the   client.  In these cases (and perhaps others), the client can not   reliably perform an access check with only current file attributes.   In the NFS version 2 protocol, the only reliable way to determine   whether an operation was allowed was to try it and see if it   succeeded or failed.  Using the ACCESS operation in the NFS version 4   protocol, the client can ask the server to indicate whether or not   one or more classes of operations are permitted.  The ACCESS   operation is provided to allow clients to check before doing a series   of operations which will result in an access failure.  The OPENShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 141]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   operation provides a point where the server can verify access to the   file object and method to return that information to the client.  The   ACCESS operation is still useful for directory operations or for use   in the case the UNIX API "access" is used on the client.   The information returned by the server in response to an ACCESS call   is not permanent.  It was correct at the exact time that the server   performed the checks, but not necessarily afterwards.  The server can   revoke access permission at any time.   The client should use the effective credentials of the user to build   the authentication information in the ACCESS request used to   determine access rights.  It is the effective user and group   credentials that are used in subsequent read and write operations.   Many implementations do not directly support the ACCESS4_DELETE   permission.  Operating systems like UNIX will ignore the   ACCESS4_DELETE bit if set on an access request on a non-directory   object.  In these systems, delete permission on a file is determined   by the access permissions on the directory in which the file resides,   instead of being determined by the permissions of the file itself.   Therefore, the mask returned enumerating which access rights can be   determined will have the ACCESS4_DELETE value set to 0.  This   indicates to the client that the server was unable to check that   particular access right.  The ACCESS4_DELETE bit in the access mask   returned will then be ignored by the client.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE14.2.2.  Operation 4: CLOSE - Close File   SYNOPSIS     (cfh), seqid, open_stateid -> open_stateidShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 142]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   ARGUMENT     struct CLOSE4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: object */             seqid4          seqid             stateid4        open_stateid;     };   RESULT     union CLOSE4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4_OK:              stateid4       open_stateid;      default:              void;     };   DESCRIPTION   The CLOSE operation releases share reservations for the regular or   named attribute file as specified by the current filehandle.  The   share reservations and other state information released at the server   as a result of this CLOSE is only associated with the supplied   stateid.  The sequence id provides for the correct ordering. State   associated with other OPENs is not affected.   If record locks are held, the client SHOULD release all locks before   issuing a CLOSE.  The server MAY free all outstanding locks on CLOSE   but some servers may not support the CLOSE of a file that still has   record locks held.  The server MUST return failure if any locks would   exist after the CLOSE.   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION   Even though CLOSE returns a stateid, this stateid is not useful to   the client and should be treated as deprecated.  CLOSE "shuts down"   the state associated with all OPENs for the file by a single   open_owner.  As noted above, CLOSE will either release all file   locking state or return an error.  Therefore, the stateid returned by   CLOSE is not useful for operations that follow.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ADMIN_REVOKED      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQIDShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 143]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_EXPIRED      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_ISDIR      NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED      NFS4ERR_LOCKS_HELD      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID14.2.3.  Operation 5: COMMIT - Commit Cached Data   SYNOPSIS     (cfh), offset, count -> verifier   ARGUMENT     struct COMMIT4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: file */             offset4         offset;             count4          count;     };   RESULT     struct COMMIT4resok {             verifier4       writeverf;     };     union COMMIT4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4_OK:              COMMIT4resok   resok4;      default:              void;     };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 144]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   DESCRIPTION   The COMMIT operation forces or flushes data to stable storage for the   file specified by the current filehandle.  The flushed data is that   which was previously written with a WRITE operation which had the   stable field set to UNSTABLE4.   The offset specifies the position within the file where the flush is   to begin.  An offset value of 0 (zero) means to flush data starting   at the beginning of the file.  The count specifies the number of   bytes of data to flush.  If count is 0 (zero), a flush from offset to   the end of the file is done.   The server returns a write verifier upon successful completion of the   COMMIT.  The write verifier is used by the client to determine if the   server has restarted or rebooted between the initial WRITE(s) and the   COMMIT.  The client does this by comparing the write verifier   returned from the initial writes and the verifier returned by the   COMMIT operation.  The server must vary the value of the write   verifier at each server event or instantiation that may lead to a   loss of uncommitted data.  Most commonly this occurs when the server   is rebooted; however, other events at the server may result in   uncommitted data loss as well.   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION   The COMMIT operation is similar in operation and semantics to the   POSIX fsync(2) system call that synchronizes a file's state with the   disk (file data and metadata is flushed to disk or stable storage).   COMMIT performs the same operation for a client, flushing any   unsynchronized data and metadata on the server to the server's disk   or stable storage for the specified file.  Like fsync(2), it may be   that there is some modified data or no modified data to synchronize.   The data may have been synchronized by the server's normal periodic   buffer synchronization activity.  COMMIT should return NFS4_OK,   unless there has been an unexpected error.   COMMIT differs from fsync(2) in that it is possible for the client to   flush a range of the file (most likely triggered by a buffer-   reclamation scheme on the client before file has been completely   written).   The server implementation of COMMIT is reasonably simple.  If the   server receives a full file COMMIT request, that is starting at   offset 0 and count 0, it should do the equivalent of fsync()'ing the   file.  Otherwise, it should arrange to have the cached data in theShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 145]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   range specified by offset and count to be flushed to stable storage.   In both cases, any metadata associated with the file must be flushed   to stable storage before returning.  It is not an error for there to   be nothing to flush on the server.  This means that the data and   metadata that needed to be flushed have already been flushed or lost   during the last server failure.   The client implementation of COMMIT is a little more complex.  There   are two reasons for wanting to commit a client buffer to stable   storage.  The first is that the client wants to reuse a buffer.  In   this case, the offset and count of the buffer are sent to the server   in the COMMIT request.  The server then flushes any cached data based   on the offset and count, and flushes any metadata associated with the   file.  It then returns the status of the flush and the write   verifier.  The other reason for the client to generate a COMMIT is   for a full file flush, such as may be done at close.  In this case,   the client would gather all of the buffers for this file that contain   uncommitted data, do the COMMIT operation with an offset of 0 and   count of 0, and then free all of those buffers.  Any other dirty   buffers would be sent to the server in the normal fashion.   After a buffer is written by the client with the stable parameter set   to UNSTABLE4, the buffer must be considered as modified by the client   until the buffer has either been flushed via a COMMIT operation or   written via a WRITE operation with stable parameter set to FILE_SYNC4   or DATA_SYNC4. This is done to prevent the buffer from being freed   and reused before the data can be flushed to stable storage on the   server.   When a response is returned from either a WRITE or a COMMIT operation   and it contains a write verifier that is different than previously   returned by the server, the client will need to retransmit all of the   buffers containing uncommitted cached data to the server.  How this   is to be done is up to the implementor.  If there is only one buffer   of interest, then it should probably be sent back over in a WRITE   request with the appropriate stable parameter.  If there is more than   one buffer, it might be worthwhile retransmitting all of the buffers   in WRITE requests with the stable parameter set to UNSTABLE4 and then   retransmitting the COMMIT operation to flush all of the data on the   server to stable storage.  The timing of these retransmissions is   left to the implementor.   The above description applies to page-cache-based systems as well as   buffer-cache-based systems.  In those systems, the virtual memory   system will need to be modified instead of the buffer cache.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 146]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_ISDIR      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_ROFS      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE14.2.4.  Operation 6: CREATE - Create a Non-Regular File Object   SYNOPSIS     (cfh), name, type, attrs -> (cfh), change_info, attrs_set   ARGUMENT     union createtype4 switch (nfs_ftype4 type) {      case NF4LNK:              linktext4      linkdata;      case NF4BLK:      case NF4CHR:              specdata4      devdata;      case NF4SOCK:      case NF4FIFO:      case NF4DIR:              void;     };     struct CREATE4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: directory for creation */             createtype4     objtype;             component4      objname;             fattr4          createattrs;     };   RESULT     struct CREATE4resok {             change_info4    cinfo;             bitmap4         attrset;        /* attributes set */Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 147]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003     };     union CREATE4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4_OK:              CREATE4resok resok4;      default:              void;     };   DESCRIPTION   The CREATE operation creates a non-regular file object in a directory   with a given name.  The OPEN operation MUST be used to create a   regular file.   The objname specifies the name for the new object.  The objtype   determines the type of object to be created: directory, symlink, etc.   If an object of the same name already exists in the directory, the   server will return the error NFS4ERR_EXIST.   For the directory where the new file object was created, the server   returns change_info4 information in cinfo.  With the atomic field of   the change_info4 struct, the server will indicate if the before and   after change attributes were obtained atomically with respect to the   file object creation.   If the objname has a length of 0 (zero), or if objname does not obey   the UTF-8 definition, the error NFS4ERR_INVAL will be returned.   The current filehandle is replaced by that of the new object.   The createattrs specifies the initial set of attributes for the   object.  The set of attributes may include any writable attribute   valid for the object type. When the operation is successful, the   server will return to the client an attribute mask signifying which   attributes were successfully set for the object.   If createattrs includes neither the owner attribute nor an ACL with   an ACE for the owner, and if the server's filesystem both supports   and requires an owner attribute (or an owner ACE) then the server   MUST derive the owner (or the owner ACE). This would typically be   from the principal indicated in the RPC credentials of the call, but   the server's operating environment or filesystem semantics may   dictate other methods of derivation. Similarly, if createattrs   includes neither the group attribute nor a group ACE, and if the   server's filesystem both supports and requires the notion of a group   attribute (or group ACE), the server MUST derive the group attributeShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 148]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   (or the corresponding owner ACE) for the file. This could be from the   RPC call's credentials, such as the group principal if the   credentials include it (such as with AUTH_SYS), from the group   identifier associated with the principal in the credentials (for   e.g., POSIX systems have a passwd database that has the group   identifier for every user identifier), inherited from directory the   object is created in, or whatever else the server's operating   environment or filesystem semantics dictate. This applies to the OPEN   operation too.   Conversely, it is possible the client will specify in createattrs an   owner attribute or group attribute or ACL that the principal   indicated the RPC call's credentials does not have permissions to   create files for. The error to be returned in this instance is   NFS4ERR_PERM. This applies to the OPEN operation too.   IMPLEMENTATION   If the client desires to set attribute values after the create, a   SETATTR operation can be added to the COMPOUND request so that the   appropriate attributes will be set.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_ATTRNOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_BADCHAR      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BADNAME      NFS4ERR_BADOWNER      NFS4ERR_BADTYPE      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_DQUOT      NFS4ERR_EXIST      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NAMETOOLONG      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOSPC      NFS4ERR_NOTDIR      NFS4ERR_PERM      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_ROFS      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALEShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 149]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 200314.2.5.  Operation 7: DELEGPURGE - Purge Delegations Awaiting Recovery   SYNOPSIS     clientid ->   ARGUMENT     struct DELEGPURGE4args {             clientid4       clientid;     };   RESULT     struct DELEGPURGE4res {             nfsstat4        status;     };   DESCRIPTION   Purges all of the delegations awaiting recovery for a given client.   This is useful for clients which do not commit delegation information   to stable storage to indicate that conflicting requests need not be   delayed by the server awaiting recovery of delegation information.   This operation should be used by clients that record delegation   information on stable storage on the client.  In this case,   DELEGPURGE should be issued immediately after doing delegation   recovery on all delegations known to the client.  Doing so will   notify the server that no additional delegations for the client will   be recovered allowing it to free resources, and avoid delaying other   clients who make requests that conflict with the unrecovered   delegations.  The set of delegations known to the server and the   client may be different.  The reason for this is that a client may   fail after making a request which resulted in delegation but before   it received the results and committed them to the client's stable   storage.   The server MAY support DELEGPURGE, but if it does not, it MUST NOT   support CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_RESOURCEShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 150]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID14.2.6.  Operation 8: DELEGRETURN - Return Delegation   SYNOPSIS     (cfh), stateid ->   ARGUMENT     struct DELEGRETURN4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: delegated file */             stateid4        stateid;     };   RESULT     struct DELEGRETURN4res {             nfsstat4        status;     };   DESCRIPTION   Returns the delegation represented by the current filehandle and   stateid.   Delegations may be returned when recalled or voluntarily (i.e.,   before the server has recalled them).  In either case the client must   properly propagate state changed under the context of the delegation   to the server before returning the delegation.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ADMIN_REVOKED      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_EXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEIDShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 151]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 200314.2.7.  Operation 9: GETATTR - Get Attributes   SYNOPSIS     (cfh), attrbits -> attrbits, attrvals   ARGUMENT     struct GETATTR4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: directory or file */             bitmap4         attr_request;     };   RESULT     struct GETATTR4resok {             fattr4          obj_attributes;     };     union GETATTR4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4_OK:              GETATTR4resok  resok4;      default:              void;     };   DESCRIPTION   The GETATTR operation will obtain attributes for the filesystem   object specified by the current filehandle.  The client sets a bit in   the bitmap argument for each attribute value that it would like the   server to return.  The server returns an attribute bitmap that   indicates the attribute values for which it was able to return,   followed by the attribute values ordered lowest attribute number   first.   The server must return a value for each attribute that the client   requests if the attribute is supported by the server.  If the server   does not support an attribute or cannot approximate a useful value   then it must not return the attribute value and must not set the   attribute bit in the result bitmap.  The server must return an error   if it supports an attribute but cannot obtain its value.  In that   case no attribute values will be returned.   All servers must support the mandatory attributes as specified in the   section "File Attributes".   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 152]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   IMPLEMENTATION   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE14.2.8.  Operation 10: GETFH - Get Current Filehandle   SYNOPSIS     (cfh) -> filehandle   ARGUMENT     /* CURRENT_FH: */     void;   RESULT     struct GETFH4resok {             nfs_fh4         object;     };     union GETFH4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4_OK:             GETFH4resok     resok4;      default:             void;     };   DESCRIPTION   This operation returns the current filehandle value.   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 153]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   IMPLEMENTATION   Operations that change the current filehandle like LOOKUP or CREATE   do not automatically return the new filehandle as a result.  For   instance, if a client needs to lookup a directory entry and obtain   its filehandle then the following request is needed.      PUTFH  (directory filehandle)      LOOKUP (entry name)      GETFH   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE14.2.9.  Operation 11: LINK - Create Link to a File   SYNOPSIS     (sfh), (cfh), newname -> (cfh), change_info   ARGUMENT     struct LINK4args {             /* SAVED_FH: source object */             /* CURRENT_FH: target directory */             component4      newname;     };   RESULT     struct LINK4resok {             change_info4    cinfo;     };     union LINK4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4_OK:              LINK4resok resok4;      default:              void;     };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 154]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   DESCRIPTION   The LINK operation creates an additional newname for the file   represented by the saved filehandle, as set by the SAVEFH operation,   in the directory represented by the current filehandle.  The existing   file and the target directory must reside within the same filesystem   on the server.  On success, the current filehandle will continue to   be the target directory.  If an object exists in the target directory   with the same name as newname, the server must return NFS4ERR_EXIST.   For the target directory, the server returns change_info4 information   in cinfo.  With the atomic field of the change_info4 struct, the   server will indicate if the before and after change attributes were   obtained atomically with respect to the link creation.   If the newname has a length of 0 (zero), or if newname does not obey   the UTF-8 definition, the error NFS4ERR_INVAL will be returned.   IMPLEMENTATION   Changes to any property of the "hard" linked files are reflected in   all of the linked files.  When a link is made to a file, the   attributes for the file should have a value for numlinks that is one   greater than the value before the LINK operation.   The statement "file and the target directory must reside within the   same filesystem on the server" means that the fsid fields in the   attributes for the objects are the same. If they reside on different   filesystems, the error, NFS4ERR_XDEV, is returned.  On some servers,   the filenames, "." and "..", are illegal as newname.   In the case that newname is already linked to the file represented by   the saved filehandle, the server will return NFS4ERR_EXIST.   Note that symbolic links are created with the CREATE operation.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_BADCHAR      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BADNAME      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_DQUOT      NFS4ERR_EXIST      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_FILE_OPENShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 155]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_ISDIR      NFS4ERR_MLINK      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NAMETOOLONG      NFS4ERR_NOENT      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOSPC      NFS4ERR_NOTDIR      NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_ROFS      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC      NFS4ERR_XDEV14.2.10.  Operation 12: LOCK - Create Lock   SYNOPSIS     (cfh) locktype, reclaim, offset, length, locker -> stateid   ARGUMENT     struct open_to_lock_owner4 {             seqid4          open_seqid;             stateid4        open_stateid;             seqid4          lock_seqid;             lock_owner4     lock_owner;     };     struct exist_lock_owner4 {             stateid4        lock_stateid;             seqid4          lock_seqid;     };     union locker4 switch (bool new_lock_owner) {      case TRUE:             open_to_lock_owner4     open_owner;      case FALSE:             exist_lock_owner4       lock_owner;     };     enum nfs_lock_type4 {             READ_LT         = 1,             WRITE_LT        = 2,Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 156]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003             READW_LT        = 3,    /* blocking read */             WRITEW_LT       = 4     /* blocking write */     };     struct LOCK4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: file */             nfs_lock_type4  locktype;             bool            reclaim;             offset4         offset;             length4         length;             locker4         locker;     };   RESULT     struct LOCK4denied {             offset4         offset;             length4         length;             nfs_lock_type4  locktype;             lock_owner4     owner;     };     struct LOCK4resok {             stateid4        lock_stateid;     };     union LOCK4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4_OK:              LOCK4resok     resok4;      case NFS4ERR_DENIED:              LOCK4denied    denied;      default:              void;     };   DESCRIPTION   The LOCK operation requests a record lock for the byte range   specified by the offset and length parameters.  The lock type is also   specified to be one of the nfs_lock_type4s.  If this is a reclaim   request, the reclaim parameter will be TRUE;   Bytes in a file may be locked even if those bytes are not currently   allocated to the file.  To lock the file from a specific offset   through the end-of-file (no matter how long the file actually is) use   a length field with all bits set to 1 (one).  If the length is zero,Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 157]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   or if a length which is not all bits set to one is specified, and   length when added to the offset exceeds the maximum 64-bit unsigned   integer value, the error NFS4ERR_INVAL will result.   Some servers may only support locking for byte offsets that fit   within 32 bits.  If the client specifies a range that includes a byte   beyond the last byte offset of the 32-bit range, but does not include   the last byte offset of the 32-bit and all of the byte offsets beyond   it, up to the end of the valid 64-bit range, such a 32-bit server   MUST return the error NFS4ERR_BAD_RANGE.   In the case that the lock is denied, the owner, offset, and length of   a conflicting lock are returned.   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION   If the server is unable to determine the exact offset and length of   the conflicting lock, the same offset and length that were provided   in the arguments should be returned in the denied results.  The File   Locking section contains a full description of this and the other   file locking operations.   LOCK operations are subject to permission checks and to checks   against the access type of the associated file.  However, the   specific right and modes required for various type of locks, reflect   the semantics of the server-exported filesystem, and are not   specified by the protocol.  For example, Windows 2000 allows a write   lock of a file open for READ, while a POSIX-compliant system does   not.   When the client makes a lock request that corresponds to a range that   the lockowner has locked already (with the same or different lock   type), or to a sub-region of such a range, or to a region which   includes multiple locks already granted to that lockowner, in whole   or in part, and the server does not support such locking operations   (i.e., does not support POSIX locking semantics), the server will   return the error NFS4ERR_LOCK_RANGE.  In that case, the client may   return an error, or it may emulate the required operations, using   only LOCK for ranges that do not include any bytes already locked by   that lock_owner and LOCKU of locks held by that lock_owner   (specifying an exactly-matching range and type).  Similarly, when the   client makes a lock request that amounts to upgrading (changing from   a read lock to a write lock) or downgrading (changing from write lock   to a read lock) an existing record lock, and the server does notShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 158]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   support such a lock, the server will return NFS4ERR_LOCK_NOTSUPP.   Such operations may not perfectly reflect the required semantics in   the face of conflicting lock requests from other clients.   The locker argument specifies the lock_owner that is associated with   the LOCK request.  The locker4 structure is a switched union that   indicates whether the lock_owner is known to the server or if the   lock_owner is new to the server.  In the case that the lock_owner is   known to the server and has an established lock_seqid, the argument   is just the lock_owner and lock_seqid.  In the case that the   lock_owner is not known to the server, the argument contains not only   the lock_owner and lock_seqid but also the open_stateid and   open_seqid.  The new lock_owner case covers the very first lock done   by the lock_owner and offers a method to use the established state of   the open_stateid to transition to the use of the lock_owner.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_ADMIN_REVOKED      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BAD_RANGE      NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQID      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_DEADLOCK      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_DENIED      NFS4ERR_EXPIRED      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_GRACE      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_ISDIR      NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED      NFS4ERR_LOCK_NOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_LOCK_RANGE      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NO_GRACE      NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_OPENMODE      NFS4ERR_RECLAIM_BAD      NFS4ERR_RECLAIM_CONFLICT      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID      NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEIDShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 159]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 200314.2.11.  Operation 13: LOCKT - Test For Lock   SYNOPSIS     (cfh) locktype, offset, length owner -> {void, NFS4ERR_DENIED ->     owner}   ARGUMENT     struct LOCKT4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: file */             nfs_lock_type4  locktype;             offset4         offset;             length4         length;             lock_owner4     owner;     };   RESULT     struct LOCK4denied {             offset4         offset;             length4         length;             nfs_lock_type4  locktype;             lock_owner4     owner;     };     union LOCKT4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4ERR_DENIED:              LOCK4denied    denied;      case NFS4_OK:              void;      default:              void;     };   DESCRIPTION   The LOCKT operation tests the lock as specified in the arguments.  If   a conflicting lock exists, the owner, offset, length, and type of the   conflicting lock are returned; if no lock is held, nothing other than   NFS4_OK is returned.  Lock types READ_LT and READW_LT are processed   in the same way in that a conflicting lock test is done without   regard to blocking or non-blocking.  The same is true for WRITE_LT   and WRITEW_LT.   The ranges are specified as for LOCK.  The NFS4ERR_INVAL and   NFS4ERR_BAD_RANGE errors are returned under the same circumstances as   for LOCK.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 160]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION   If the server is unable to determine the exact offset and length of   the conflicting lock, the same offset and length that were provided   in the arguments should be returned in the denied results.  The File   Locking section contains further discussion of the file locking   mechanisms.   LOCKT uses a lock_owner4 rather a stateid4, as is used in LOCK to   identify the owner.  This is because the client does not have to open   the file to test for the existence of a lock, so a stateid may not be   available.   The test for conflicting locks should exclude locks for the current   lockowner.  Note that since such locks are not examined the possible   existence of overlapping ranges may not affect the results of LOCKT.   If the server does examine locks that match the lockowner for the   purpose of range checking, NFS4ERR_LOCK_RANGE may be returned..  In   the event that it returns NFS4_OK, clients may do a LOCK and receive   NFS4ERR_LOCK_RANGE on the LOCK request because of the flexibility   provided to the server.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BAD_RANGE      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_DENIED      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_GRACE      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_ISDIR      NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED      NFS4ERR_LOCK_RANGE      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTIDShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 161]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 200314.2.12.  Operation 14: LOCKU - Unlock File   SYNOPSIS     (cfh) type, seqid, stateid, offset, length -> stateid   ARGUMENT     struct LOCKU4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: file */             nfs_lock_type4  locktype;             seqid4          seqid;             stateid4        stateid;             offset4         offset;             length4         length;     };   RESULT     union LOCKU4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case   NFS4_OK:              stateid4       stateid;      default:              void;     };   DESCRIPTION   The LOCKU operation unlocks the record lock specified by the   parameters. The client may set the locktype field to any value that   is legal for the nfs_lock_type4 enumerated type, and the server MUST   accept any legal value for locktype. Any legal value for locktype has   no effect on the success or failure of the LOCKU operation.   The ranges are specified as for LOCK.  The NFS4ERR_INVAL and   NFS4ERR_BAD_RANGE errors are returned under the same circumstances as   for LOCK.   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION   If the area to be unlocked does not correspond exactly to a lock   actually held by the lockowner the server may return the error   NFS4ERR_LOCK_RANGE.  This includes the case in which the area is not   locked, where the area is a sub-range of the area locked, where it   overlaps the area locked without matching exactly or the area   specified includes multiple locks held by the lockowner.  In all ofShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 162]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   these cases, allowed by POSIX locking semantics, a client receiving   this error, should if it desires support for such operations,   simulate the operation using LOCKU on ranges corresponding to locks   it actually holds, possibly followed by LOCK requests for the sub-   ranges not being unlocked.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_ADMIN_REVOKED      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BAD_RANGE      NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQID      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_EXPIRED      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_GRACE      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_ISDIR      NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED      NFS4ERR_LOCK_RANGE      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID14.2.13.  Operation 15: LOOKUP - Lookup Filename   SYNOPSIS     (cfh), component -> (cfh)   ARGUMENT     struct LOOKUP4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: directory */             component4      objname;     };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 163]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   RESULT     struct LOOKUP4res {             /* CURRENT_FH: object */             nfsstat4        status;     };   DESCRIPTION   This operation LOOKUPs or finds a filesystem object using the   directory specified by the current filehandle.  LOOKUP evaluates the   component and if the object exists the current filehandle is replaced   with the component's filehandle.   If the component cannot be evaluated either because it does not exist   or because the client does not have permission to evaluate the   component, then an error will be returned and the current filehandle   will be unchanged.   If the component is a zero length string or if any component does not   obey the UTF-8 definition, the error NFS4ERR_INVAL will be returned.   IMPLEMENTATION   If the client wants to achieve the effect of a multi-component   lookup, it may construct a COMPOUND request such as (and obtain each   filehandle):      PUTFH  (directory filehandle)      LOOKUP "pub"      GETFH      LOOKUP "foo"      GETFH      LOOKUP "bar"      GETFH   NFS version 4 servers depart from the semantics of previous NFS   versions in allowing LOOKUP requests to cross mountpoints on the   server.  The client can detect a mountpoint crossing by comparing the   fsid attribute of the directory with the fsid attribute of the   directory looked up.  If the fsids are different then the new   directory is a server mountpoint.  UNIX clients that detect a   mountpoint crossing will need to mount the server's filesystem.  This   needs to be done to maintain the file object identity checking   mechanisms common to UNIX clients.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 164]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   Servers that limit NFS access to "shares" or "exported" filesystems   should provide a pseudo-filesystem into which the exported   filesystems can be integrated, so that clients can browse the   server's name space.  The clients' view of a pseudo filesystem will   be limited to paths that lead to exported filesystems.   Note: previous versions of the protocol assigned special semantics to   the names "." and "..".  NFS version 4 assigns no special semantics   to these names.  The LOOKUPP operator must be used to lookup a parent   directory.   Note that this operation does not follow symbolic links.  The client   is responsible for all parsing of filenames including filenames that   are modified by symbolic links encountered during the lookup process.   If the current filehandle supplied is not a directory but a symbolic   link, the error NFS4ERR_SYMLINK is returned as the error.  For all   other non-directory file types, the error NFS4ERR_NOTDIR is returned.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_BADCHAR      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BADNAME      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NAMETOOLONG      NFS4ERR_NOENT      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOTDIR      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_SYMLINK      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.14.  Operation 16: LOOKUPP - Lookup Parent Directory   SYNOPSIS     (cfh) -> (cfh)Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 165]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   ARGUMENT     /* CURRENT_FH: object */     void;   RESULT     struct LOOKUPP4res {             /* CURRENT_FH: directory */             nfsstat4        status;     };   DESCRIPTION   The current filehandle is assumed to refer to a regular directory   or a named attribute directory.  LOOKUPP assigns the filehandle for   its parent directory to be the current filehandle.  If there is no   parent directory an NFS4ERR_NOENT error must be returned.   Therefore, NFS4ERR_NOENT will be returned by the server when the   current filehandle is at the root or top of the server's file tree.   IMPLEMENTATION   As for LOOKUP, LOOKUPP will also cross mountpoints.   If the current filehandle is not a directory or named attribute   directory, the error NFS4ERR_NOTDIR is returned.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOENT      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOTDIR      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE14.2.15.  Operation 17: NVERIFY - Verify Difference in Attributes   SYNOPSIS     (cfh), fattr -> -Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 166]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   ARGUMENT     struct NVERIFY4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: object */             fattr4          obj_attributes;     };   RESULT     struct NVERIFY4res {             nfsstat4        status;     };   DESCRIPTION   This operation is used to prefix a sequence of operations to be   performed if one or more attributes have changed on some filesystem   object.  If all the attributes match then the error NFS4ERR_SAME must   be returned.   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION   This operation is useful as a cache validation operator.  If the   object to which the attributes belong has changed then the following   operations may obtain new data associated with that object.  For   instance, to check if a file has been changed and obtain new data if   it has:      PUTFH  (public)      LOOKUP "foobar"      NVERIFY attrbits attrs      READ 0 32767   In the case that a recommended attribute is specified in the NVERIFY   operation and the server does not support that attribute for the   filesystem object, the error NFS4ERR_ATTRNOTSUPP is returned to the   client.   When the attribute rdattr_error or any write-only attribute (e.g.,   time_modify_set) is specified, the error NFS4ERR_INVAL is returned to   the client.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 167]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_ATTRNOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_BADCHAR      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SAME      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE14.2.16.  Operation 18: OPEN - Open a Regular File   SYNOPSIS     (cfh), seqid, share_access, share_deny, owner, openhow, claim ->     (cfh), stateid, cinfo, rflags, open_confirm, attrset delegation   ARGUMENT     struct OPEN4args {             seqid4          seqid;             uint32_t        share_access;             uint32_t        share_deny;             open_owner4     owner;             openflag4       openhow;             open_claim4     claim;     };     enum createmode4 {             UNCHECKED4      = 0,             GUARDED4        = 1,             EXCLUSIVE4      = 2     };     union createhow4 switch (createmode4 mode) {      case UNCHECKED4:      case GUARDED4:              fattr4         createattrs;      case EXCLUSIVE4:              verifier4      createverf;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 168]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003     };     enum opentype4 {             OPEN4_NOCREATE  = 0,             OPEN4_CREATE    = 1     };     union openflag4 switch (opentype4 opentype) {      case OPEN4_CREATE:              createhow4     how;      default:              void;     };     /* Next definitions used for OPEN delegation */     enum limit_by4 {             NFS_LIMIT_SIZE          = 1,             NFS_LIMIT_BLOCKS        = 2             /* others as needed */     };     struct nfs_modified_limit4 {             uint32_t        num_blocks;             uint32_t        bytes_per_block;     };     union nfs_space_limit4 switch (limit_by4 limitby) {      /* limit specified as file size */      case NFS_LIMIT_SIZE:              uint64_t               filesize;      /* limit specified by number of blocks */      case NFS_LIMIT_BLOCKS:              nfs_modified_limit4    mod_blocks;     } ;     enum open_delegation_type4 {             OPEN_DELEGATE_NONE      = 0,             OPEN_DELEGATE_READ      = 1,             OPEN_DELEGATE_WRITE     = 2     };     enum open_claim_type4 {             CLAIM_NULL              = 0,             CLAIM_PREVIOUS          = 1,             CLAIM_DELEGATE_CUR      = 2,             CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV     = 3     };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 169]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003     struct open_claim_delegate_cur4 {             stateid4        delegate_stateid;             component4      file;     };     union open_claim4 switch (open_claim_type4 claim) {      /*       * No special rights to file. Ordinary OPEN of the specified file.       */      case CLAIM_NULL:              /* CURRENT_FH: directory */              component4     file;      /*       * Right to the file established by an open previous to server       * reboot.  File identified by filehandle obtained at that time       * rather than by name.       */      case CLAIM_PREVIOUS:              /* CURRENT_FH: file being reclaimed */              open_delegation_type4   delegate_type;      /*       * Right to file based on a delegation granted by the server.       * File is specified by name.       */      case CLAIM_DELEGATE_CUR:              /* CURRENT_FH: directory */              open_claim_delegate_cur4       delegate_cur_info;      /* Right to file based on a delegation granted to a previous boot       * instance of the client.  File is specified by name.       */      case CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV:              /* CURRENT_FH: directory */              component4     file_delegate_prev;     };   RESULT   struct open_read_delegation4 {           stateid4        stateid;        /* Stateid for delegation*/           bool            recall;         /* Pre-recalled flag for                                              delegations obtained                                              by reclaim                                              (CLAIM_PREVIOUS) */           nfsace4         permissions;    /* Defines users who don't                                              need an ACCESS call toShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 170]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003                                              open for read */   };   struct open_write_delegation4 {           stateid4        stateid;        /* Stateid for delegation*/           bool            recall;         /* Pre-recalled flag for                                              delegations obtained                                              by reclaim                                              (CLAIM_PREVIOUS) */           nfs_space_limit4 space_limit;   /* Defines condition that                                              the client must check to                                              determine whether the                                              file needs to be flushed                                              to the server on close.                                              */           nfsace4         permissions;    /* Defines users who don't                                              need an ACCESS call as                                              part of a delegated                                              open. */   };   union open_delegation4   switch (open_delegation_type4 delegation_type) {           case OPEN_DELEGATE_NONE:                   void;           case OPEN_DELEGATE_READ:                   open_read_delegation4 read;           case OPEN_DELEGATE_WRITE:                   open_write_delegation4 write;   };   const OPEN4_RESULT_CONFIRM      = 0x00000002;   const OPEN4_RESULT_LOCKTYPE_POSIX = 0x00000004;   struct OPEN4resok {           stateid4        stateid;        /* Stateid for open */           change_info4    cinfo;          /* Directory Change Info */           uint32_t        rflags;         /* Result flags */           bitmap4         attrset;        /* attributes on create */           open_delegation4 delegation;    /* Info on any open                                              delegation */   };   union OPEN4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:           /* CURRENT_FH: opened file */           OPEN4resok      resok4;    default:Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 171]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003           void;   };   WARNING TO CLIENT IMPLEMENTORS   OPEN resembles LOOKUP in that it generates a filehandle for the   client to use.  Unlike LOOKUP though, OPEN creates server state on   the filehandle.  In normal circumstances, the client can only release   this state with a CLOSE operation.  CLOSE uses the current filehandle   to determine which file to close.  Therefore the client MUST follow   every OPEN operation with a GETFH operation in the same COMPOUND   procedure.  This will supply the client with the filehandle such that   CLOSE can be used appropriately.   Simply waiting for the lease on the file to expire is insufficient   because the server may maintain the state indefinitely as long as   another client does not attempt to make a conflicting access to the   same file.   DESCRIPTION   The OPEN operation creates and/or opens a regular file in a directory   with the provided name.  If the file does not exist at the server and   creation is desired, specification of the method of creation is   provided by the openhow parameter.  The client has the choice of   three creation methods: UNCHECKED, GUARDED, or EXCLUSIVE.   If the current filehandle is a named attribute directory, OPEN will   then create or open a named attribute file.  Note that exclusive   create of a named attribute is not supported.  If the createmode is   EXCLUSIVE4 and the current filehandle is a named attribute directory,   the server will return EINVAL.   UNCHECKED means that the file should be created if a file of that   name does not exist and encountering an existing regular file of that   name is not an error.  For this type of create, createattrs specifies   the initial set of attributes for the file.  The set of attributes   may include any writable attribute valid for regular files.  When an   UNCHECKED create encounters an existing file, the attributes   specified by createattrs are not used, except that when an size of   zero is specified, the existing file is truncated.  If GUARDED is   specified, the server checks for the presence of a duplicate object   by name before performing the create.  If a duplicate exists, an   error of NFS4ERR_EXIST is returned as the status.  If the object does   not exist, the request is performed as described for UNCHECKED.  ForShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 172]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   each of these cases (UNCHECKED and GUARDED) where the operation is   successful, the server will return to the client an attribute mask   signifying which attributes were successfully set for the object.   EXCLUSIVE specifies that the server is to follow exclusive creation   semantics, using the verifier to ensure exclusive creation of the   target.  The server should check for the presence of a duplicate   object by name.  If the object does not exist, the server creates the   object and stores the verifier with the object.  If the object does   exist and the stored verifier matches the client provided verifier,   the server uses the existing object as the newly created object.  If   the stored verifier does not match, then an error of NFS4ERR_EXIST is   returned.  No attributes may be provided in this case, since the   server may use an attribute of the target object to store the   verifier.  If the server uses an attribute to store the exclusive   create verifier, it will signify which attribute by setting the   appropriate bit in the attribute mask that is returned in the   results.   For the target directory, the server returns change_info4 information   in cinfo.  With the atomic field of the change_info4 struct, the   server will indicate if the before and after change attributes were   obtained atomically with respect to the link creation.   Upon successful creation, the current filehandle is replaced by that   of the new object.   The OPEN operation provides for Windows share reservation capability   with the use of the share_access and share_deny fields of the OPEN   arguments.  The client specifies at OPEN the required share_access   and share_deny modes.  For clients that do not directly support   SHAREs (i.e., UNIX), the expected deny value is DENY_NONE.  In the   case that there is a existing SHARE reservation that conflicts with   the OPEN request, the server returns the error NFS4ERR_SHARE_DENIED.   For a complete SHARE request, the client must provide values for the   owner and seqid fields for the OPEN argument.  For additional   discussion of SHARE semantics see the section on 'Share   Reservations'.   In the case that the client is recovering state from a server   failure, the claim field of the OPEN argument is used to signify that   the request is meant to reclaim state previously held.   The "claim" field of the OPEN argument is used to specify the file to   be opened and the state information which the client claims to   possess.  There are four basic claim types which cover the various   situations for an OPEN.  They are as follows:Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 173]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   CLAIM_NULL                         For the client, this is a new OPEN                         request and there is no previous state                         associate with the file for the client.   CLAIM_PREVIOUS                         The client is claiming basic OPEN state                         for a file that was held previous to a                         server reboot.  Generally used when a                         server is returning persistent                         filehandles; the client may not have the                         file name to reclaim the OPEN.   CLAIM_DELEGATE_CUR                         The client is claiming a delegation for                         OPEN as granted by the server.                         Generally this is done as part of                         recalling a delegation.   CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV                         The client is claiming a delegation                         granted to a previous client instance;                         used after the client reboots. The                         server MAY support CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV.                         If it does support CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV,                         SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM MUST NOT remove the                         client's delegation state, and the                         server MUST support the DELEGPURGE                         operation.   For OPEN requests whose claim type is other than CLAIM_PREVIOUS   (i.e., requests other than those devoted to reclaiming opens after a   server reboot) that reach the server during its grace or lease   expiration period, the server returns an error of NFS4ERR_GRACE.   For any OPEN request, the server may return an open delegation, which   allows further opens and closes to be handled locally on the client   as described in the section Open Delegation.  Note that delegation is   up to the server to decide.  The client should never assume that   delegation will or will not be granted in a particular instance.  It   should always be prepared for either case.  A partial exception is   the reclaim (CLAIM_PREVIOUS) case, in which a delegation type is   claimed.  In this case, delegation will always be granted, although   the server may specify an immediate recall in the delegation   structure.   The rflags returned by a successful OPEN allow the server to return   information governing how the open file is to be handled.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 174]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   OPEN4_RESULT_CONFIRM indicates that the client MUST execute an   OPEN_CONFIRM operation before using the open file.   OPEN4_RESULT_LOCKTYPE_POSIX indicates the server's file locking   behavior supports the complete set of Posix locking techniques.  From   this the client can choose to manage file locking state in a way to   handle a mis-match of file locking management.   If the component is of zero length, NFS4ERR_INVAL will be returned.   The component is also subject to the normal UTF-8, character support,   and name checks.  See the section "UTF-8 Related Errors" for further   discussion.   When an OPEN is done and the specified lockowner already has the   resulting filehandle open, the result is to "OR" together the new   share and deny status together with the existing status.  In this   case, only a single CLOSE need be done, even though multiple OPENs   were completed.  When such an OPEN is done, checking of share   reservations for the new OPEN proceeds normally, with no exception   for the existing OPEN held by the same lockowner.   If the underlying filesystem at the server is only accessible in a   read-only mode and the OPEN request has specified ACCESS_WRITE or   ACCESS_BOTH, the server will return NFS4ERR_ROFS to indicate a read-   only filesystem.   As with the CREATE operation, the server MUST derive the owner, owner   ACE, group, or group ACE if any of the four attributes are required   and supported by the server's filesystem.  For an OPEN with the   EXCLUSIVE4 createmode, the server has no choice, since such OPEN   calls do not include the createattrs field.  Conversely, if   createattrs is specified, and includes owner or group (or   corresponding ACEs) that the principal in the RPC call's credentials   does not have authorization to create files for, then the server may   return NFS4ERR_PERM.   In the case of a OPEN which specifies a size of zero (e.g.,   truncation) and the file has named attributes, the named attributes   are left as is.  They are not removed.   IMPLEMENTATION   The OPEN operation contains support for EXCLUSIVE create.  The   mechanism is similar to the support in NFS version 3 [RFC1813].  As   in NFS version 3, this mechanism provides reliable exclusive   creation.  Exclusive create is invoked when the how parameter is   EXCLUSIVE.  In this case, the client provides a verifier that can   reasonably be expected to be unique.  A combination of a clientShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 175]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   identifier, perhaps the client network address, and a unique number   generated by the client, perhaps the RPC transaction identifier, may   be appropriate.   If the object does not exist, the server creates the object and   stores the verifier in stable storage. For filesystems that do not   provide a mechanism for the storage of arbitrary file attributes, the   server may use one or more elements of the object meta-data to store   the verifier. The verifier must be stored in stable storage to   prevent erroneous failure on retransmission of the request. It is   assumed that an exclusive create is being performed because exclusive   semantics are critical to the application. Because of the expected   usage, exclusive CREATE does not rely solely on the normally volatile   duplicate request cache for storage of the verifier. The duplicate   request cache in volatile storage does not survive a crash and may   actually flush on a long network partition, opening failure windows.   In the UNIX local filesystem environment, the expected storage   location for the verifier on creation is the meta-data (time stamps)   of the object. For this reason, an exclusive object create may not   include initial attributes because the server would have nowhere to   store the verifier.   If the server can not support these exclusive create semantics,   possibly because of the requirement to commit the verifier to stable   storage, it should fail the OPEN request with the error,   NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP.   During an exclusive CREATE request, if the object already exists, the   server reconstructs the object's verifier and compares it with the   verifier in the request. If they match, the server treats the request   as a success. The request is presumed to be a duplicate of an   earlier, successful request for which the reply was lost and that the   server duplicate request cache mechanism did not detect.  If the   verifiers do not match, the request is rejected with the status,   NFS4ERR_EXIST.   Once the client has performed a successful exclusive create, it must   issue a SETATTR to set the correct object attributes.  Until it does   so, it should not rely upon any of the object attributes, since the   server implementation may need to overload object meta-data to store   the verifier.  The subsequent SETATTR must not occur in the same   COMPOUND request as the OPEN.  This separation will guarantee that   the exclusive create mechanism will continue to function properly in   the face of retransmission of the request.   Use of the GUARDED attribute does not provide exactly-once semantics.   In particular, if a reply is lost and the server does not detect the   retransmission of the request, the operation can fail withShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 176]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   NFS4ERR_EXIST, even though the create was performed successfully.   The client would use this behavior in the case that the application   has not requested an exclusive create but has asked to have the file   truncated when the file is opened.  In the case of the client timing   out and retransmitting the create request, the client can use GUARDED   to prevent against a sequence like: create, write, create   (retransmitted) from occurring.   For SHARE reservations, the client must specify a value for   share_access that is one of READ, WRITE, or BOTH.  For share_deny,   the client must specify one of NONE, READ, WRITE, or BOTH.  If the   client fails to do this, the server must return NFS4ERR_INVAL.   Based on the share_access value (READ, WRITE, or BOTH) the client   should check that the requester has the proper access rights to   perform the specified operation.  This would generally be the results   of applying the ACL access rules to the file for the current   requester.  However, just as with the ACCESS operation, the client   should not attempt to second-guess the server's decisions, as access   rights may change and may be subject to server administrative   controls outside the ACL framework.  If the requester is not   authorized to READ or WRITE (depending on the share_access value),   the server must return NFS4ERR_ACCESS.  Note that since the NFS   version 4 protocol does not impose any requirement that READs and   WRITEs issued for an open file have the same credentials as the OPEN   itself, the server still must do appropriate access checking on the   READs and WRITEs themselves.   If the component provided to OPEN is a symbolic link, the error   NFS4ERR_SYMLINK will be returned to the client.  If the current   filehandle is not a directory, the error NFS4ERR_NOTDIR will be   returned.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_ADMIN_REVOKED      NFS4ERR_ATTRNOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_BADCHAR      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BADNAME      NFS4ERR_BADOWNER      NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQID      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_DQUOT      NFS4ERR_EXIST      NFS4ERR_EXPIREDShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 177]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_GRACE      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_ISDIR      NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NAMETOOLONG      NFS4ERR_NOENT      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOSPC      NFS4ERR_NOTDIR      NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_NO_GRACE      NFS4ERR_PERM      NFS4ERR_RECLAIM_BAD      NFS4ERR_RECLAIM_CONFLICT      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_ROFS      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_SHARE_DENIED      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID      NFS4ERR_SYMLINK      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.17.  Operation 19: OPENATTR - Open Named Attribute Directory   SYNOPSIS     (cfh) createdir -> (cfh)   ARGUMENT     struct OPENATTR4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: object */             bool    createdir;     };   RESULT     struct OPENATTR4res {             /* CURRENT_FH: named attr directory*/             nfsstat4        status;     };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 178]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   DESCRIPTION   The OPENATTR operation is used to obtain the filehandle of the named   attribute directory associated with the current filehandle.  The   result of the OPENATTR will be a filehandle to an object of type   NF4ATTRDIR.  From this filehandle, READDIR and LOOKUP operations can   be used to obtain filehandles for the various named attributes   associated with the original filesystem object.  Filehandles returned   within the named attribute directory will have a type of   NF4NAMEDATTR.   The createdir argument allows the client to signify if a named   attribute directory should be created as a result of the OPENATTR   operation.  Some clients may use the OPENATTR operation with a value   of FALSE for createdir to determine if any named attributes exist for   the object.  If none exist, then NFS4ERR_NOENT will be returned.  If   createdir has a value of TRUE and no named attribute directory   exists, one is created.  The creation of a named attribute directory   assumes that the server has implemented named attribute support in   this fashion and is not required to do so by this definition.   IMPLEMENTATION   If the server does not support named attributes for the current   filehandle, an error of NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP will be returned to the   client.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_DQUOT      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOENT      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOSPC      NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_ROFS      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALEShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 179]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 200314.2.18.  Operation 20: OPEN_CONFIRM - Confirm Open   SYNOPSIS     (cfh), seqid, stateid-> stateid   ARGUMENT     struct OPEN_CONFIRM4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: opened file */             stateid4        open_stateid;             seqid4          seqid;     };   RESULT     struct OPEN_CONFIRM4resok {             stateid4        open_stateid;     };     union OPEN_CONFIRM4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4_OK:              OPEN_CONFIRM4resok     resok4;      default:              void;     };   DESCRIPTION   This operation is used to confirm the sequence id usage for the first   time that a open_owner is used by a client.  The stateid returned   from the OPEN operation is used as the argument for this operation   along with the next sequence id for the open_owner.  The sequence id   passed to the OPEN_CONFIRM must be 1 (one) greater than the seqid   passed to the OPEN operation from which the open_confirm value was   obtained.  If the server receives an unexpected sequence id with   respect to the original open, then the server assumes that the client   will not confirm the original OPEN and all state associated with the   original OPEN is released by the server.   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION   A given client might generate many open_owner4 data structures for a   given clientid.  The client will periodically either dispose of its   open_owner4s or stop using them for indefinite periods of time.  The   latter situation is why the NFS version 4 protocol does not have anShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 180]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   explicit operation to exit an open_owner4: such an operation is of no   use in that situation.  Instead, to avoid unbounded memory use, the   server needs to implement a strategy for disposing of open_owner4s   that have no current lock, open, or delegation state for any files   and have not been used recently.  The time period used to determine   when to dispose of open_owner4s is an implementation choice.  The   time period should certainly be no less than the lease time plus any   grace period the server wishes to implement beyond a lease time.  The   OPEN_CONFIRM operation allows the server to safely dispose of unused   open_owner4 data structures.   In the case that a client issues an OPEN operation and the server no   longer has a record of the open_owner4, the server needs to ensure   that this is a new OPEN and not a replay or retransmission.   Servers must not require confirmation on OPENs that grant delegations   or are doing reclaim operations.  See section "Use of Open   Confirmation" for details.  The server can easily avoid this by   noting whether it has disposed of one open_owner4 for the given   clientid.  If the server does not support delegation, it might simply   maintain a single bit that notes whether any open_owner4 (for any   client) has been disposed of.   The server must hold unconfirmed OPEN state until one of three events   occur.  First, the client sends an OPEN_CONFIRM request with the   appropriate sequence id and stateid within the lease period.  In this   case, the OPEN state on the server goes to confirmed, and the   open_owner4 on the server is fully established.   Second, the client sends another OPEN request with a sequence id that   is incorrect for the open_owner4 (out of sequence).  In this case,   the server assumes the second OPEN request is valid and the first one   is a replay.  The server cancels the OPEN state of the first OPEN   request, establishes an unconfirmed OPEN state for the second OPEN   request, and responds to the second OPEN request with an indication   that an OPEN_CONFIRM is needed.  The process then repeats itself.   While there is a potential for a denial of service attack on the   client, it is mitigated if the client and server require the use of a   security flavor based on Kerberos V5, LIPKEY, or some other flavor   that uses cryptography.   What if the server is in the unconfirmed OPEN state for a given   open_owner4, and it receives an operation on the open_owner4 that has   a stateid but the operation is not OPEN, or it is OPEN_CONFIRM but   with the wrong stateid?  Then, even if the seqid is correct, theShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 181]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   server returns NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID, because the server assumes the   operation is a replay: if the server has no established OPEN state,   then there is no way, for example, a LOCK operation could be valid.   Third, neither of the two aforementioned events occur for the   open_owner4 within the lease period.  In this case, the OPEN state is   canceled and disposal of the open_owner4 can occur.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ADMIN_REVOKED      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQID      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_EXPIRED      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_ISDIR      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID14.2.19.  Operation 21: OPEN_DOWNGRADE - Reduce Open File Access   SYNOPSIS     (cfh), stateid, seqid, access, deny -> stateid   ARGUMENT     struct OPEN_DOWNGRADE4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: opened file */             stateid4        open_stateid;             seqid4          seqid;             uint32_t        share_access;             uint32_t        share_deny;     };   RESULT     struct OPEN_DOWNGRADE4resok {             stateid4        open_stateid;     };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 182]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003     union OPEN_DOWNGRADE4res switch(nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4_OK:             OPEN_DOWNGRADE4resok    resok4;      default:             void;     };   DESCRIPTION   This operation is used to adjust the share_access and share_deny bits   for a given open.  This is necessary when a given openowner opens the   same file multiple times with different share_access and share_deny   flags.  In this situation, a close of one of the opens may change the   appropriate share_access and share_deny flags to remove bits   associated with opens no longer in effect.   The share_access and share_deny bits specified in this operation   replace the current ones for the specified open file.  The   share_access and share_deny bits specified must be exactly equal to   the union of the share_access and share_deny bits specified for some   subset of the OPENs in effect for current openowner on the current   file.  If that constraint is not respected, the error NFS4ERR_INVAL   should be returned.  Since share_access and share_deny bits are   subsets of those already granted, it is not possible for this request   to be denied because of conflicting share reservations.   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ADMIN_REVOKED      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQID      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_EXPIRED      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEIDShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 183]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 200314.2.20.  Operation 22: PUTFH - Set Current Filehandle   SYNOPSIS     filehandle -> (cfh)   ARGUMENT     struct PUTFH4args {             nfs_fh4         object;     };   RESULT     struct PUTFH4res {             /* CURRENT_FH: */             nfsstat4        status;     };   DESCRIPTION   Replaces the current filehandle with the filehandle provided as an   argument.   If the security mechanism used by the requester does not meet the   requirements of the filehandle provided to this operation, the server   MUST return NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC.   IMPLEMENTATION   Commonly used as the first operator in an NFS request to set the   context for following operations.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_WRONGSECShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 184]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 200314.2.21.  Operation 23: PUTPUBFH - Set Public Filehandle   SYNOPSIS     - -> (cfh)   ARGUMENT     void;   RESULT     struct PUTPUBFH4res {             /* CURRENT_FH: public fh */             nfsstat4        status;     };   DESCRIPTION   Replaces the current filehandle with the filehandle that represents   the public filehandle of the server's name space.  This filehandle   may be different from the "root" filehandle which may be associated   with some other directory on the server.   The public filehandle represents the concepts embodied in [RFC2054],   [RFC2055], [RFC2224].  The intent for NFS version 4 is that the   public filehandle (represented by the PUTPUBFH operation) be used as   a method of providing WebNFS server compatibility with NFS versions 2   and 3.   The public filehandle and the root filehandle (represented by the   PUTROOTFH operation) should be equivalent.  If the public and root   filehandles are not equivalent, then the public filehandle MUST be a   descendant of the root filehandle.   IMPLEMENTATION   Used as the first operator in an NFS request to set the context for   following operations.   With the NFS version 2 and 3 public filehandle, the client is able to   specify whether the path name provided in the LOOKUP should be   evaluated as either an absolute path relative to the server's root or   relative to the public filehandle.  [RFC2224] contains further   discussion of the functionality.  With NFS version 4, that type of   specification is not directly available in the LOOKUP operation.  The   reason for this is because the component separators needed to specify   absolute vs. relative are not allowed in NFS version 4.  Therefore,Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 185]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   the client is responsible for constructing its request such that the   use of either PUTROOTFH or PUTPUBFH are used to signify absolute or   relative evaluation of an NFS URL respectively.   Note that there are warnings mentioned in [RFC2224] with respect to   the use of absolute evaluation and the restrictions the server may   place on that evaluation with respect to how much of its namespace   has been made available.  These same warnings apply to NFS version 4.   It is likely, therefore that because of server implementation   details, an NFS version 3 absolute public filehandle lookup may   behave differently than an NFS version 4 absolute resolution.   There is a form of security negotiation as described in [RFC2755]   that uses the public filehandle a method of employing SNEGO.  This   method is not available with NFS version 4 as filehandles are not   overloaded with special meaning and therefore do not provide the same   framework as NFS versions 2 and 3.  Clients should therefore use the   security negotiation mechanisms described in this RFC.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.22.  Operation 24: PUTROOTFH - Set Root Filehandle   SYNOPSIS     - -> (cfh)   ARGUMENT     void;   RESULT     struct PUTROOTFH4res {             /* CURRENT_FH: root fh */             nfsstat4        status;     };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 186]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   DESCRIPTION   Replaces the current filehandle with the filehandle that represents   the root of the server's name space.  From this filehandle a LOOKUP   operation can locate any other filehandle on the server. This   filehandle may be different from the "public" filehandle which may be   associated with some other directory on the server.   IMPLEMENTATION   Commonly used as the first operator in an NFS request to set the   context for following operations.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.23.  Operation 25: READ - Read from File   SYNOPSIS     (cfh), stateid, offset, count -> eof, data   ARGUMENT     struct READ4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: file */             stateid4        stateid;             offset4         offset;             count4          count;     };   RESULT     struct READ4resok {             bool            eof;             opaque          data<>;     };     union READ4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4_OK:              READ4resok     resok4;      default:              void;     };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 187]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   DESCRIPTION   The READ operation reads data from the regular file identified by the   current filehandle.   The client provides an offset of where the READ is to start and a   count of how many bytes are to be read.  An offset of 0 (zero) means   to read data starting at the beginning of the file.  If offset is   greater than or equal to the size of the file, the status, NFS4_OK,   is returned with a data length set to 0 (zero) and eof is set to   TRUE.  The READ is subject to access permissions checking.   If the client specifies a count value of 0 (zero), the READ succeeds   and returns 0 (zero) bytes of data again subject to access   permissions checking.  The server may choose to return fewer bytes   than specified by the client.  The client needs to check for this   condition and handle the condition appropriately.   The stateid value for a READ request represents a value returned from   a previous record lock or share reservation request.  The stateid is   used by the server to verify that the associated share reservation   and any record locks are still valid and to update lease timeouts for   the client.   If the read ended at the end-of-file (formally, in a correctly formed   READ request, if offset + count is equal to the size of the file), or   the read request extends beyond the size of the file (if offset +   count is greater than the size of the file), eof is returned as TRUE;   otherwise it is FALSE.  A successful READ of an empty file will   always return eof as TRUE.   If the current filehandle is not a regular file, an error will be   returned to the client.  In the case the current filehandle   represents a directory, NFS4ERR_ISDIR is return; otherwise,   NFS4ERR_INVAL is returned.   For a READ with a stateid value of all bits 0, the server MAY allow   the READ to be serviced subject to mandatory file locks or the   current share deny modes for the file.  For a READ with a stateid   value of all bits 1, the server MAY allow READ operations to bypass   locking checks at the server.   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 188]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   IMPLEMENTATION   It is possible for the server to return fewer than count bytes of   data.  If the server returns less than the count requested and eof is   set to FALSE, the client should issue another READ to get the   remaining data.  A server may return less data than requested under   several circumstances.  The file may have been truncated by another   client or perhaps on the server itself, changing the file size from   what the requesting client believes to be the case.  This would   reduce the actual amount of data available to the client.  It is   possible that the server may back off the transfer size and reduce   the read request return.  Server resource exhaustion may also occur   necessitating a smaller read return.   If mandatory file locking is on for the file, and if the region   corresponding to the data to be read from file is write locked by an   owner not associated the stateid, the server will return the   NFS4ERR_LOCKED error.  The client should try to get the appropriate   read record lock via the LOCK operation before re-attempting the   READ.  When the READ completes, the client should release the record   lock via LOCKU.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_ADMIN_REVOKED      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_EXPIRED      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_GRACE      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_ISDIR      NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED      NFS4ERR_LOCKED      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NXIO      NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_OPENMODE      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEIDShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 189]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 200314.2.24.  Operation 26: READDIR - Read Directory   SYNOPSIS      (cfh), cookie, cookieverf, dircount, maxcount, attr_request ->      cookieverf { cookie, name, attrs }   ARGUMENT     struct READDIR4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: directory */             nfs_cookie4     cookie;             verifier4       cookieverf;             count4          dircount;             count4          maxcount;             bitmap4         attr_request;     };   RESULT     struct entry4 {             nfs_cookie4     cookie;             component4      name;             fattr4          attrs;             entry4          *nextentry;     };     struct dirlist4 {             entry4          *entries;             bool            eof;     };     struct READDIR4resok {             verifier4       cookieverf;             dirlist4        reply;     };     union READDIR4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4_OK:              READDIR4resok  resok4;      default:              void;     };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 190]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   DESCRIPTION   The READDIR operation retrieves a variable number of entries from a   filesystem directory and returns client requested attributes for each   entry along with information to allow the client to request   additional directory entries in a subsequent READDIR.   The arguments contain a cookie value that represents where the   READDIR should start within the directory.  A value of 0 (zero) for   the cookie is used to start reading at the beginning of the   directory.  For subsequent READDIR requests, the client specifies a   cookie value that is provided by the server on a previous READDIR   request.   The cookieverf value should be set to 0 (zero) when the cookie value   is 0 (zero) (first directory read).  On subsequent requests, it   should be a cookieverf as returned by the server.  The cookieverf   must match that returned by the READDIR in which the cookie was   acquired.  If the server determines that the cookieverf is no longer   valid for the directory, the error NFS4ERR_NOT_SAME must be returned.   The dircount portion of the argument is a hint of the maximum number   of bytes of directory information that should be returned.  This   value represents the length of the names of the directory entries and   the cookie value for these entries.  This length represents the XDR   encoding of the data (names and cookies) and not the length in the   native format of the server.   The maxcount value of the argument is the maximum number of bytes for   the result.  This maximum size represents all of the data being   returned within the READDIR4resok structure and includes the XDR   overhead.  The server may return less data.  If the server is unable   to return a single directory entry within the maxcount limit, the   error NFS4ERR_TOOSMALL will be returned to the client.   Finally, attr_request represents the list of attributes to be   returned for each directory entry supplied by the server.   On successful return, the server's response will provide a list of   directory entries.  Each of these entries contains the name of the   directory entry, a cookie value for that entry, and the associated   attributes as requested.  The "eof" flag has a value of TRUE if there   are no more entries in the directory.   The cookie value is only meaningful to the server and is used as a   "bookmark" for the directory entry.  As mentioned, this cookie is   used by the client for subsequent READDIR operations so that it may   continue reading a directory.  The cookie is similar in concept to aShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 191]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   READ offset but should not be interpreted as such by the client.   Ideally, the cookie value should not change if the directory is   modified since the client may be caching these values.   In some cases, the server may encounter an error while obtaining the   attributes for a directory entry.  Instead of returning an error for   the entire READDIR operation, the server can instead return the   attribute 'fattr4_rdattr_error'.  With this, the server is able to   communicate the failure to the client and not fail the entire   operation in the instance of what might be a transient failure.   Obviously, the client must request the fattr4_rdattr_error attribute   for this method to work properly.  If the client does not request the   attribute, the server has no choice but to return failure for the   entire READDIR operation.   For some filesystem environments, the directory entries "." and ".."   have special meaning and in other environments, they may not.  If the   server supports these special entries within a directory, they should   not be returned to the client as part of the READDIR response.  To   enable some client environments, the cookie values of 0, 1, and 2 are   to be considered reserved.  Note that the UNIX client will use these   values when combining the server's response and local representations   to enable a fully formed UNIX directory presentation to the   application.   For READDIR arguments, cookie values of 1 and 2 should not be used   and for READDIR results cookie values of 0, 1, and 2 should not be   returned.   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION   The server's filesystem directory representations can differ greatly.   A client's programming interfaces may also be bound to the local   operating environment in a way that does not translate well into the   NFS protocol.  Therefore the use of the dircount and maxcount fields   are provided to allow the client the ability to provide guidelines to   the server.  If the client is aggressive about attribute collection   during a READDIR, the server has an idea of how to limit the encoded   response.  The dircount field provides a hint on the number of   entries based solely on the names of the directory entries.  Since it   is a hint, it may be possible that a dircount value is zero.  In this   case, the server is free to ignore the dircount value and return   directory information based on the specified maxcount value.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 192]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   The cookieverf may be used by the server to help manage cookie values   that may become stale.  It should be a rare occurrence that a server   is unable to continue properly reading a directory with the provided   cookie/cookieverf pair.  The server should make every effort to avoid   this condition since the application at the client may not be able to   properly handle this type of failure.   The use of the cookieverf will also protect the client from using   READDIR cookie values that may be stale.  For example, if the file   system has been migrated, the server may or may not be able to use   the same cookie values to service READDIR as the previous server   used.  With the client providing the cookieverf, the server is able   to provide the appropriate response to the client.  This prevents the   case where the server may accept a cookie value but the underlying   directory has changed and the response is invalid from the client's   context of its previous READDIR.   Since some servers will not be returning "." and ".." entries as has   been done with previous versions of the NFS protocol, the client that   requires these entries be present in READDIR responses must fabricate   them.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BAD_COOKIE      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOTDIR      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_TOOSMALL14.2.25.  Operation 27: READLINK - Read Symbolic Link   SYNOPSIS     (cfh) -> linktextShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 193]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   ARGUMENT     /* CURRENT_FH: symlink */     void;   RESULT     struct READLINK4resok {             linktext4       link;     };     union READLINK4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4_OK:              READLINK4resok resok4;      default:              void;     };   DESCRIPTION   READLINK reads the data associated with a symbolic link.  The data is   a UTF-8 string that is opaque to the server.  That is, whether   created by an NFS client or created locally on the server, the data   in a symbolic link is not interpreted when created, but is simply   stored.   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION   A symbolic link is nominally a pointer to another file.  The data is   not necessarily interpreted by the server, just stored in the file.   It is possible for a client implementation to store a path name that   is not meaningful to the server operating system in a symbolic link.   A READLINK operation returns the data to the client for   interpretation. If different implementations want to share access to   symbolic links, then they must agree on the interpretation of the   data in the symbolic link.   The READLINK operation is only allowed on objects of type NF4LNK.   The server should return the error, NFS4ERR_INVAL, if the object is   not of type, NF4LNK.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_DELAYShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 194]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_ISDIR      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE14.2.26.  Operation 28: REMOVE - Remove Filesystem Object   SYNOPSIS     (cfh), filename -> change_info   ARGUMENT     struct REMOVE4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: directory */             component4       target;     };   RESULT     struct REMOVE4resok {             change_info4    cinfo;     }     union REMOVE4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4_OK:              REMOVE4resok   resok4;      default:              void;     }   DESCRIPTION   The REMOVE operation removes (deletes) a directory entry named by   filename from the directory corresponding to the current filehandle.   If the entry in the directory was the last reference to the   corresponding filesystem object, the object may be destroyed.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 195]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   For the directory where the filename was removed, the server returns   change_info4 information in cinfo.  With the atomic field of the   change_info4 struct, the server will indicate if the before and after   change attributes were obtained atomically with respect to the   removal.   If the target has a length of 0 (zero), or if target does not obey   the UTF-8 definition, the error NFS4ERR_INVAL will be returned.   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION   NFS versions 2 and 3 required a different operator RMDIR for   directory removal and REMOVE for non-directory removal. This allowed   clients to skip checking the file type when being passed a non-   directory delete system call (e.g., unlink() in POSIX) to remove a   directory, as well as the converse (e.g., a rmdir() on a non-   directory) because they knew the server would check the file type.   NFS version 4 REMOVE can be used to delete any directory entry   independent of its file type. The implementor of an NFS version 4   client's entry points from the unlink() and rmdir() system calls   should first check the file type against the types the system call is   allowed to remove before issuing a REMOVE. Alternatively, the   implementor can produce a COMPOUND call that includes a LOOKUP/VERIFY   sequence to verify the file type before a REMOVE operation in the   same COMPOUND call.   The concept of last reference is server specific.  However, if the   numlinks field in the previous attributes of the object had the value   1, the client should not rely on referring to the object via a   filehandle.  Likewise, the client should not rely on the resources   (disk space, directory entry, and so on) formerly associated with the   object becoming immediately available.  Thus, if a client needs to be   able to continue to access a file after using REMOVE to remove it,   the client should take steps to make sure that the file will still be   accessible.  The usual mechanism used is to RENAME the file from its   old name to a new hidden name.   If the server finds that the file is still open when the REMOVE   arrives:   o  The server SHOULD NOT delete the file's directory entry if the      file was opened with OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_WRITE or      OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_BOTH.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 196]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   o  If the file was not opened with OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_WRITE or      OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_BOTH, the server SHOULD delete the file's      directory entry.  However, until last CLOSE of the file, the      server MAY continue to allow access to the file via its      filehandle.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_BADCHAR      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BADNAME      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_FILE_OPEN      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NAMETOOLONG      NFS4ERR_NOENT      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOTDIR      NFS4ERR_NOTEMPTY      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_ROFS      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE14.2.27.  Operation 29: RENAME - Rename Directory Entry   SYNOPSIS     (sfh), oldname, (cfh), newname -> source_change_info,     target_change_info   ARGUMENT     struct RENAME4args {             /* SAVED_FH: source directory */             component4      oldname;             /* CURRENT_FH: target directory */             component4      newname;     };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 197]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   RESULT     struct RENAME4resok {             change_info4    source_cinfo;             change_info4    target_cinfo;     };     union RENAME4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4_OK:              RENAME4resok   resok4;      default:              void;     };   DESCRIPTION   The RENAME operation renames the object identified by oldname in the   source directory corresponding to the saved filehandle, as set by the   SAVEFH operation, to newname in the target directory corresponding to   the current filehandle.  The operation is required to be atomic to   the client.  Source and target directories must reside on the same   filesystem on the server.  On success, the current filehandle will   continue to be the target directory.   If the target directory already contains an entry with the name,   newname, the source object must be compatible with the target:   either both are non-directories or both are directories and the   target must be empty.  If compatible, the existing target is removed   before the rename occurs (See the IMPLEMENTATION subsection of the   section "Operation 28: REMOVE - Remove Filesystem Object" for client   and server actions whenever a target is removed).  If they are not   compatible or if the target is a directory but not empty, the server   will return the error, NFS4ERR_EXIST.   If oldname and newname both refer to the same file (they might be   hard links of each other), then RENAME should perform no action and   return success.   For both directories involved in the RENAME, the server returns   change_info4 information.  With the atomic field of the change_info4   struct, the server will indicate if the before and after change   attributes were obtained atomically with respect to the rename.   If the oldname refers to a named attribute and the saved and current   filehandles refer to different filesystem objects, the server will   return NFS4ERR_XDEV just as if the saved and current filehandles   represented directories on different filesystems.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 198]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   If the oldname or newname has a length of 0 (zero), or if oldname or   newname does not obey the UTF-8 definition, the error NFS4ERR_INVAL   will be returned.   IMPLEMENTATION   The RENAME operation must be atomic to the client.  The statement   "source and target directories must reside on the same filesystem on   the server" means that the fsid fields in the attributes for the   directories are the same. If they reside on different filesystems,   the error, NFS4ERR_XDEV, is returned.   Based on the value of the fh_expire_type attribute for the object,   the filehandle may or may not expire on a RENAME.  However, server   implementors are strongly encouraged to attempt to keep filehandles   from expiring in this fashion.   On some servers, the file names "." and ".." are illegal as either   oldname or newname, and will result in the error NFS4ERR_BADNAME.  In   addition, on many servers the case of oldname or newname being an   alias for the source directory will be checked for.  Such servers   will return the error NFS4ERR_INVAL in these cases.   If either of the source or target filehandles are not directories,   the server will return NFS4ERR_NOTDIR.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_BADCHAR      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BADNAME      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_DQUOT      NFS4ERR_EXIST      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_FILE_OPEN      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NAMETOOLONG      NFS4ERR_NOENT      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOSPC      NFS4ERR_NOTDIR      NFS4ERR_NOTEMPTY      NFS4ERR_RESOURCEShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 199]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003      NFS4ERR_ROFS      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC      NFS4ERR_XDEV14.2.28.  Operation 30: RENEW - Renew a Lease   SYNOPSIS     clientid -> ()   ARGUMENT     struct RENEW4args {             clientid4       clientid;     };   RESULT     struct RENEW4res {             nfsstat4        status;     };   DESCRIPTION   The RENEW operation is used by the client to renew leases which it   currently holds at a server.  In processing the RENEW request, the   server renews all leases associated with the client.  The associated   leases are determined by the clientid provided via the SETCLIENTID   operation.   IMPLEMENTATION   When the client holds delegations, it needs to use RENEW to detect   when the server has determined that the callback path is down.  When   the server has made such a determination, only the RENEW operation   will renew the lease on delegations.  If the server determines the   callback path is down, it returns NFS4ERR_CB_PATH_DOWN.  Even though   it returns NFS4ERR_CB_PATH_DOWN, the server MUST renew the lease on   the record locks and share reservations that the client has   established on the server.  If for some reason the lock and share   reservation lease cannot be renewed, then the server MUST return an   error other than NFS4ERR_CB_PATH_DOWN, even if the callback path is   also down.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 200]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   The client that issues RENEW MUST choose the principal, RPC security   flavor, and if applicable, GSS-API mechanism and service via one of   the following algorithms:   o  The client uses the same principal, RPC security flavor -- and if      the flavor was RPCSEC_GSS -- the same mechanism and service that      was used when the client id was established via      SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM.   o  The client uses any principal, RPC security flavor mechanism and      service combination that currently has an OPEN file on the server.      I.e.,  the same principal had a successful OPEN operation, the      file is still open by that principal, and the flavor, mechanism,      and service of RENEW match that of the previous OPEN.   The server MUST reject a RENEW that does not use one the   aforementioned algorithms, with the error NFS4ERR_ACCESS.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_ADMIN_REVOKED      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_CB_PATH_DOWN      NFS4ERR_EXPIRED      NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID14.2.29.  Operation 31: RESTOREFH - Restore Saved Filehandle   SYNOPSIS     (sfh) -> (cfh)   ARGUMENT     /* SAVED_FH: */     void;   RESULT     struct RESTOREFH4res {             /* CURRENT_FH: value of saved fh */             nfsstat4        status;     };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 201]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   DESCRIPTION   Set the current filehandle to the value in the saved filehandle.  If   there is no saved filehandle then return the error NFS4ERR_RESTOREFH.   IMPLEMENTATION   Operations like OPEN and LOOKUP use the current filehandle to   represent a directory and replace it with a new filehandle.  Assuming   the previous filehandle was saved with a SAVEFH operator, the   previous filehandle can be restored as the current filehandle.  This   is commonly used to obtain post-operation attributes for the   directory, e.g.,         PUTFH (directory filehandle)         SAVEFH         GETATTR attrbits     (pre-op dir attrs)         CREATE optbits "foo" attrs         GETATTR attrbits     (file attributes)         RESTOREFH         GETATTR attrbits     (post-op dir attrs)   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_RESTOREFH      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC14.2.30.  Operation 32: SAVEFH - Save Current Filehandle   SYNOPSIS     (cfh) -> (sfh)   ARGUMENT     /* CURRENT_FH: */     void;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 202]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   RESULT     struct SAVEFH4res {             /* SAVED_FH: value of current fh */             nfsstat4        status;     };   DESCRIPTION   Save the current filehandle.  If a previous filehandle was saved then   it is no longer accessible.  The saved filehandle can be restored as   the current filehandle with the RESTOREFH operator.   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE14.2.31.  Operation 33: SECINFO - Obtain Available Security   SYNOPSIS     (cfh), name -> { secinfo }   ARGUMENT     struct SECINFO4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: directory */             component4     name;     };   RESULT     enum rpc_gss_svc_t {/* FromRFC 2203 */             RPC_GSS_SVC_NONE        = 1,             RPC_GSS_SVC_INTEGRITY   = 2,             RPC_GSS_SVC_PRIVACY     = 3     };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 203]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003     struct rpcsec_gss_info {             sec_oid4        oid;             qop4            qop;             rpc_gss_svc_t   service;     };     union secinfo4 switch (uint32_t flavor) {      case RPCSEC_GSS:              rpcsec_gss_info        flavor_info;      default:              void;     };     typedef secinfo4 SECINFO4resok<>;     union SECINFO4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4_OK:              SECINFO4resok resok4;      default:              void;     };   DESCRIPTION   The SECINFO operation is used by the client to obtain a list of valid   RPC authentication flavors for a specific directory filehandle, file   name pair.  SECINFO should apply the same access methodology used for   LOOKUP when evaluating the name.  Therefore, if the requester does   not have the appropriate access to LOOKUP the name then SECINFO must   behave the same way and return NFS4ERR_ACCESS.   The result will contain an array which represents the security   mechanisms available, with an order corresponding to server's   preferences, the most preferred being first in the array. The client   is free to pick whatever security mechanism it both desires and   supports, or to pick in the server's preference order the first one   it supports.  The array entries are represented by the secinfo4   structure.  The field 'flavor' will contain a value of AUTH_NONE,   AUTH_SYS (as defined in [RFC1831]), or RPCSEC_GSS (as defined in   [RFC2203]).   For the flavors AUTH_NONE and AUTH_SYS, no additional security   information is returned.  For a return value of RPCSEC_GSS, a   security triple is returned that contains the mechanism object id (as   defined in [RFC2743]), the quality of protection (as defined in   [RFC2743]) and the service type (as defined in [RFC2203]).  It is   possible for SECINFO to return multiple entries with flavor equal to   RPCSEC_GSS with different security triple values.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 204]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   If the name has a length of 0 (zero), or if name does not obey the   UTF-8 definition, the error NFS4ERR_INVAL will be returned.   IMPLEMENTATION   The SECINFO operation is expected to be used by the NFS client when   the error value of NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC is returned from another NFS   operation.  This signifies to the client that the server's security   policy is different from what the client is currently using.  At this   point, the client is expected to obtain a list of possible security   flavors and choose what best suits its policies.   As mentioned, the server's security policies will determine when a   client request receives NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC.  The operations which may   receive this error are: LINK, LOOKUP, OPEN, PUTFH, PUTPUBFH,   PUTROOTFH, RESTOREFH, RENAME, and indirectly READDIR.  LINK and   RENAME will only receive this error if the security used for the   operation is inappropriate for saved filehandle.  With the exception   of READDIR, these operations represent the point at which the client   can instantiate a filehandle into the "current filehandle" at the   server.  The filehandle is either provided by the client (PUTFH,   PUTPUBFH, PUTROOTFH) or generated as a result of a name to filehandle   translation (LOOKUP and OPEN).  RESTOREFH is different because the   filehandle is a result of a previous SAVEFH.  Even though the   filehandle, for RESTOREFH, might have previously passed the server's   inspection for a security match, the server will check it again on   RESTOREFH to ensure that the security policy has not changed.   If the client wants to resolve an error return of NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC,   the following will occur:   o  For LOOKUP and OPEN, the client will use SECINFO with the same      current filehandle and name as provided in the original LOOKUP or      OPEN to enumerate the available security triples.   o  For LINK, PUTFH, RENAME, and RESTOREFH, the client will use      SECINFO and provide the parent directory filehandle and object      name which corresponds to the filehandle originally provided by      the PUTFH RESTOREFH, or for LINK and RENAME, the SAVEFH.   o  For PUTROOTFH and PUTPUBFH, the client will be unable to use the      SECINFO operation since SECINFO requires a current filehandle and      none exist for these two operations.  Therefore, the client must      iterate through the security triples available at the client and      reattempt the PUTROOTFH or PUTPUBFH operation. In the unfortunate      event none of the MANDATORY security triples are supported by theShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 205]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003      client and server, the client SHOULD try using others that support      integrity. Failing that, the client can try using AUTH_NONE, but      because such forms lack integrity checks, this puts the client at      risk.  Nonetheless, the server SHOULD allow the client to use      whatever security form the client requests and the server      supports, since the risks of doing so are on the client.   The READDIR operation will not directly return the NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC   error.  However, if the READDIR request included a request for   attributes, it is possible that the READDIR request's security triple   does not match that of a directory entry.  If this is the case and   the client has requested the rdattr_error attribute, the server will   return the NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC error in rdattr_error for the entry.   See the section "Security Considerations" for a discussion on the   recommendations for security flavor used by SECINFO.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_BADCHAR      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BADNAME      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NAMETOOLONG      NFS4ERR_NOENT      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOTDIR      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE14.2.32.  Operation 34: SETATTR - Set Attributes   SYNOPSIS     (cfh), stateid, attrmask, attr_vals -> attrsset   ARGUMENT     struct SETATTR4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: target object */             stateid4        stateid;             fattr4          obj_attributes;     };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 206]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   RESULT     struct SETATTR4res {             nfsstat4        status;             bitmap4         attrsset;     };   DESCRIPTION   The SETATTR operation changes one or more of the attributes of a   filesystem object.  The new attributes are specified with a bitmap   and the attributes that follow the bitmap in bit order.   The stateid argument for SETATTR is used to provide file locking   context that is necessary for SETATTR requests that set the size   attribute.  Since setting the size attribute modifies the file's   data, it has the same locking requirements as a corresponding WRITE.   Any SETATTR that sets the size attribute is incompatible with a share   reservation that specifies DENY_WRITE.  The area between the old   end-of-file and the new end-of-file is considered to be modified just   as would have been the case had the area in question been specified   as the target of WRITE, for the purpose of checking conflicts with   record locks, for those cases in which a server is implementing   mandatory record locking behavior.  A valid stateid should always be   specified.  When the file size attribute is not set, the special   stateid consisting of all bits zero should be passed.   On either success or failure of the operation, the server will return   the attrsset bitmask to represent what (if any) attributes were   successfully set.  The attrsset in the response is a subset of the   bitmap4 that is part of the obj_attributes in the argument.   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION   If the request specifies the owner attribute to be set, the server   should allow the operation to succeed if the current owner of the   object matches the value specified in the request.  Some servers may   be implemented in a way as to prohibit the setting of the owner   attribute unless the requester has privilege to do so.  If the server   is lenient in this one case of matching owner values, the client   implementation may be simplified in cases of creation of an object   followed by a SETATTR.   The file size attribute is used to request changes to the size of a   file. A value of 0 (zero) causes the file to be truncated, a value   less than the current size of the file causes data from new size toShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 207]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   the end of the file to be discarded, and a size greater than the   current size of the file causes logically zeroed data bytes to be   added to the end of the file.  Servers are free to implement this   using holes or actual zero data bytes. Clients should not make any   assumptions regarding a server's implementation of this feature,   beyond that the bytes returned will be zeroed.  Servers must support   extending the file size via SETATTR.   SETATTR is not guaranteed atomic.  A failed SETATTR may partially   change a file's attributes.   Changing the size of a file with SETATTR indirectly changes the   time_modify.  A client must account for this as size changes can   result in data deletion.   The attributes time_access_set and time_modify_set are write-only   attributes constructed as a switched union so the client can direct   the server in setting the time values.  If the switched union   specifies SET_TO_CLIENT_TIME4, the client has provided an nfstime4 to   be used for the operation.  If the switch union does not specify   SET_TO_CLIENT_TIME4, the server is to use its current time for the   SETATTR operation.   If server and client times differ, programs that compare client time   to file times can break. A time maintenance protocol should be used   to limit client/server time skew.   Use of a COMPOUND containing a VERIFY operation specifying only the   change attribute, immediately followed by a SETATTR, provides a means   whereby a client may specify a request that emulates the   functionality of the SETATTR guard mechanism of NFS version 3.  Since   the function of the guard mechanism is to avoid changes to the file   attributes based on stale information, delays between checking of the   guard condition and the setting of the attributes have the potential   to compromise this function, as would the corresponding delay in the   NFS version 4 emulation.  Therefore, NFS version 4 servers should   take care to avoid such delays, to the degree possible, when   executing such a request.   If the server does not support an attribute as requested by the   client, the server should return NFS4ERR_ATTRNOTSUPP.   A mask of the attributes actually set is returned by SETATTR in all   cases.  That mask must not include attributes bits not requested to   be set by the client, and must be equal to the mask of attributes   requested to be set only if the SETATTR completes without error.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 208]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_ADMIN_REVOKED      NFS4ERR_ATTRNOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_BADCHAR      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BADOWNER      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_DQUOT      NFS4ERR_EXPIRED      NFS4ERR_FBIG      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_GRACE      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_ISDIR      NFS4ERR_LOCKED      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOSPC      NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_OPENMODE      NFS4ERR_PERM      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_ROFS      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID14.2.33.  Operation 35: SETCLIENTID - Negotiate Clientid   SYNOPSIS     client, callback, callback_ident -> clientid, setclientid_confirm   ARGUMENT     struct SETCLIENTID4args {             nfs_client_id4  client;             cb_client4      callback;             uint32_t        callback_ident;     };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 209]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   RESULT     struct SETCLIENTID4resok {             clientid4       clientid;             verifier4       setclientid_confirm;     };     union SETCLIENTID4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4_OK:              SETCLIENTID4resok      resok4;      case NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE:              clientaddr4    client_using;      default:              void;     };   DESCRIPTION   The client uses the SETCLIENTID operation to notify the server of its   intention to use a particular client identifier, callback, and   callback_ident for subsequent requests that entail creating lock,   share reservation, and delegation state on the server.  Upon   successful completion the server will return a shorthand clientid   which, if confirmed via a separate step, will be used in subsequent   file locking and file open requests. Confirmation of the clientid   must be done via the SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM operation to return the   clientid and setclientid_confirm values, as verifiers, to the server.   The reason why two verifiers are necessary is that it is possible to   use SETCLIENTID and SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM to modify the callback and   callback_ident information but not the shorthand clientid.  In that   event, the setclientid_confirm value is effectively the only   verifier.   The callback information provided in this operation will be used if   the client is provided an open delegation at a future point.   Therefore, the client must correctly reflect the program and port   numbers for the callback program at the time SETCLIENTID is used.   The callback_ident value is used by the server on the callback.  The   client can leverage the callback_ident to eliminate the need for more   than one callback RPC program number, while still being able to   determine which server is initiating the callback.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 210]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   IMPLEMENTATION   To understand how to implement SETCLIENTID, make the following   notations. Let:   x be the value of the client.id subfield of the SETCLIENTID4args     structure.   v be the value of the client.verifier subfield of the     SETCLIENTID4args structure.   c be the value of the clientid field returned in the     SETCLIENTID4resok structure.   k represent the value combination of the fields callback and     callback_ident fields of the SETCLIENTID4args structure.   s be the setclientid_confirm value returned in the     SETCLIENTID4resok structure.   { v, x, c, k, s }     be a quintuple for a client record. A client record is     confirmed if there has been a SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM operation to     confirm it.  Otherwise it is unconfirmed. An unconfirmed     record is established by a SETCLIENTID call.   Since SETCLIENTID is a non-idempotent operation, let us assume that   the server is implementing the duplicate request cache (DRC).   When the server gets a SETCLIENTID { v, x, k } request, it processes   it in the following manner.   o  It first looks up the request in the DRC. If there is a hit, it      returns the result cached in the DRC.  The server does NOT remove      client state (locks, shares, delegations) nor does it modify any      recorded callback and callback_ident information for client { x }.      For any DRC miss, the server takes the client id string x, and      searches for client records for x that the server may have      recorded from previous SETCLIENTID calls. For any confirmed record      with the same id string x, if the recorded principal does not      match that of SETCLIENTID call, then the server returns a      NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE error.      For brevity of discussion, the remaining description of the      processing assumes that there was a DRC miss, and that where the      server has previously recorded a confirmed record for client x,      the aforementioned principal check has successfully passed.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 211]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   o  The server checks if it has recorded a confirmed record for { v,      x, c, l, s }, where l may or may not equal k. If so, and since the      id verifier v of the request matches that which is confirmed and      recorded, the server treats this as a probable callback      information update and records an unconfirmed { v, x, c, k, t }      and leaves the confirmed { v, x, c, l, s } in place, such that t      != s. It does not matter if k equals l or not.  Any pre-existing      unconfirmed { v, x, c, *, * } is removed.      The server returns { c, t }. It is indeed returning the old      clientid4 value c, because the client apparently only wants to      update callback value k to value l.  It's possible this request is      one from the Byzantine router that has stale callback information,      but this is not a problem.  The callback information update is      only confirmed if followed up by a SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM { c, t }.      The server awaits confirmation of k via      SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM { c, t }.      The server does NOT remove client (lock/share/delegation) state      for x.   o  The server has previously recorded a confirmed { u, x, c, l, s }      record such that v != u, l may or may not equal k, and has not      recorded any unconfirmed { *, x, *, *, * } record for x.  The      server records an unconfirmed { v, x, d, k, t } (d != c, t != s).      The server returns { d, t }.      The server awaits confirmation of { d, k } via SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM      { d, t }.      The server does NOT remove client (lock/share/delegation) state      for x.   o  The server has previously recorded a confirmed { u, x, c, l, s }      record such that v != u, l may or may not equal k, and recorded an      unconfirmed { w, x, d, m, t } record such that c != d, t != s, m      may or may not equal k, m may or may not equal l, and k may or may      not equal l. Whether w == v or w != v makes no difference.  The      server simply removes the unconfirmed { w, x, d, m, t } record and      replaces it with an unconfirmed { v, x, e, k, r } record, such      that e != d, e != c, r != t, r != s.      The server returns { e, r }.      The server awaits confirmation of { e, k } via      SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM { e, r }.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 212]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003      The server does NOT remove client (lock/share/delegation) state      for x.   o  The server has no confirmed { *, x, *, *, * } for x. It may or may      not have recorded an unconfirmed { u, x, c, l, s }, where l may or      may not equal k, and u may or may not equal v.  Any unconfirmed      record { u, x, c, l, * }, regardless whether u == v or l == k, is      replaced with an unconfirmed record { v, x, d, k, t } where d !=      c, t != s.      The server returns { d, t }.      The server awaits confirmation of { d, k } via SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM      { d, t }.  The server does NOT remove client      (lock/share/delegation) state for x.   The server generates the clientid and setclientid_confirm values and   must take care to ensure that these values are extremely unlikely to   ever be regenerated.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT14.2.34.  Operation 36: SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM - Confirm Clientid   SYNOPSIS     clientid, verifier -> -   ARGUMENT     struct SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM4args {             clientid4       clientid;             verifier4       setclientid_confirm;     };   RESULT     struct SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM4res {             nfsstat4        status;     };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 213]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   DESCRIPTION   This operation is used by the client to confirm the results from a   previous call to SETCLIENTID.  The client provides the server   supplied (from a SETCLIENTID response) clientid.  The server responds   with a simple status of success or failure.   IMPLEMENTATION   The client must use the SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM operation to confirm the   following two distinct cases:   o  The client's use of a new shorthand client identifier (as returned      from the server in the response to SETCLIENTID), a new callback      value (as specified in the arguments to SETCLIENTID) and a new      callback_ident (as specified in the arguments to SETCLIENTID)      value.  The client's use of SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM in this case also      confirms the removal of any of the client's previous relevant      leased state. Relevant leased client state includes record locks,      share reservations, and where the server does not support the      CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV claim type, delegations.  If the server      supports CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV, then SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM MUST NOT      remove delegations for this client; relevant leased client state      would then just include record locks and share reservations.   o  The client's re-use of an old, previously confirmed, shorthand      client identifier, a new callback value, and a new callback_ident      value.  The client's use of SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM in this case MUST      NOT result in the removal of any previous leased state (locks,      share reservations, and delegations)   We use the same notation and definitions for v, x, c, k, s, and   unconfirmed and confirmed client records as introduced in the   description of the SETCLIENTID operation. The arguments to   SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM are indicated by the notation { c, s }, where c   is a value of type clientid4, and s is a value of type verifier4   corresponding to the setclientid_confirm field.   As with SETCLIENTID, SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM is a non-idempotent   operation, and we assume that the server is implementing the   duplicate request cache (DRC).   When the server gets a SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM { c, s } request, it   processes it in the following manner.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 214]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   o  It first looks up the request in the DRC. If there is a hit, it      returns the result cached in the DRC.  The server does not remove      any relevant leased client state nor does it modify any recorded      callback and callback_ident information for client { x } as      represented by the shorthand value c.   For a DRC miss, the server checks for client records that match the   shorthand value c.  The processing cases are as follows:   o  The server has recorded an unconfirmed { v, x, c, k, s } record      and a confirmed { v, x, c, l, t } record, such that s != t.  If      the principals of the records do not match that of the      SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM, the server returns NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE, and no      relevant leased client state is removed and no recorded callback      and callback_ident information for client { x } is changed.      Otherwise, the confirmed { v, x, c, l, t } record is removed and      the unconfirmed { v, x, c, k, s } is marked as confirmed, thereby      modifying recorded and confirmed callback and callback_ident      information for client { x }.      The server does not remove any relevant leased client state.      The server returns NFS4_OK.   o  The server has not recorded an unconfirmed { v, x, c, *, * } and      has recorded a confirmed { v, x, c, *, s }. If the principals of      the record and of SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM do not match, the server      returns NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE without removing any relevant leased      client state and without changing recorded callback and      callback_ident values for client { x }.      If the principals match, then what has likely happened is that the      client never got the response from the SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM, and      the DRC entry has been purged. Whatever the scenario, since the      principals match, as well as { c, s } matching a confirmed record,      the server leaves client x's relevant leased client state intact,      leaves its callback and callback_ident values unmodified, and      returns NFS4_OK.   o  The server has not recorded a confirmed { *, *, c, *, * }, and has      recorded an unconfirmed { *, x, c, k, s }.  Even if this is a      retry from client, nonetheless the client's first      SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM attempt was not received by the server.  Retry      or not, the server doesn't know, but it processes it as if were a      first try.  If the principal of the unconfirmed { *, x, c, k, s }      record mismatches that of the SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM request the      server returns NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE without removing any relevant      leased client state.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 215]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003      Otherwise, the server records a confirmed { *, x, c, k, s }. If      there is also a confirmed { *, x, d, *, t }, the server MUST      remove the client x's relevant leased client state, and overwrite      the callback state with k. The confirmed record { *, x, d, *, t }      is removed.      Server returns NFS4_OK.   o  The server has no record of a confirmed or unconfirmed { *, *, c,      *, s }.  The server returns NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID.  The server      does not remove any relevant leased client state, nor does it      modify any recorded callback and callback_ident information for      any client.   The server needs to cache unconfirmed { v, x, c, k, s } client   records and await for some time their confirmation.  As should be   clear from the record processing discussions for SETCLIENTID and   SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM, there are cases where the server does not   deterministically remove unconfirmed client records.  To avoid   running out of resources, the server is not required to hold   unconfirmed records indefinitely.  One strategy the server might use   is to set a limit on how many unconfirmed client records it will   maintain, and then when the limit would be exceeded, remove the   oldest record. Another strategy might be to remove an unconfirmed   record when some amount of time has elapsed. The choice of the amount   of time is fairly arbitrary but it is surely no higher than the   server's lease time period. Consider that leases need to be renewed   before the lease time expires via an operation from the client.  If   the client cannot issue a SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM after a SETCLIENTID   before a period of time equal to that of a lease expires, then the   client is unlikely to be able maintain state on the server during   steady state operation.   If the client does send a SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM for an unconfirmed   record that the server has already deleted, the client will get   NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID back.  If so, the client should then start   over, and send SETCLIENTID to reestablish an unconfirmed client   record and get back an unconfirmed clientid and setclientid_confirm   verifier.  The client should then send the SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM to   confirm the clientid.   SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM does not establish or renew a lease.  However, if   SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM removes relevant leased client state, and that   state does not include existing delegations, the server MUST allow   the client a period of time no less than the value of lease_time   attribute, to reclaim, (via the CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV claim type of the   OPEN operation) its delegations before removing unreclaimed   delegations.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 216]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID14.2.35.  Operation 37: VERIFY - Verify Same Attributes   SYNOPSIS     (cfh), fattr -> -   ARGUMENT     struct VERIFY4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: object */             fattr4          obj_attributes;     };   RESULT     struct VERIFY4res {             nfsstat4        status;     };   DESCRIPTION   The VERIFY operation is used to verify that attributes have a value   assumed by the client before proceeding with following operations in   the compound request.  If any of the attributes do not match then the   error NFS4ERR_NOT_SAME must be returned.  The current filehandle   retains its value after successful completion of the operation.   IMPLEMENTATION   One possible use of the VERIFY operation is the following compound   sequence.  With this the client is attempting to verify that the file   being removed will match what the client expects to be removed.  This   sequence can help prevent the unintended deletion of a file.         PUTFH (directory filehandle)         LOOKUP (file name)         VERIFY (filehandle == fh)         PUTFH (directory filehandle)         REMOVE (file name)Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 217]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   This sequence does not prevent a second client from removing and   creating a new file in the middle of this sequence but it does help   avoid the unintended result.   In the case that a recommended attribute is specified in the VERIFY   operation and the server does not support that attribute for the   filesystem object, the error NFS4ERR_ATTRNOTSUPP is returned to the   client.   When the attribute rdattr_error or any write-only attribute (e.g.,   time_modify_set) is specified, the error NFS4ERR_INVAL is returned to   the client.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_ATTRNOTSUPP      NFS4ERR_BADCHAR      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOT_SAME      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE14.2.36.  Operation 38: WRITE - Write to File   SYNOPSIS     (cfh), stateid, offset, stable, data -> count, committed, writeverf   ARGUMENT     enum stable_how4 {             UNSTABLE4       = 0,             DATA_SYNC4      = 1,             FILE_SYNC4      = 2     };     struct WRITE4args {             /* CURRENT_FH: file */             stateid4        stateid;             offset4         offset;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 218]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003             stable_how4     stable;             opaque          data<>;     };   RESULT     struct WRITE4resok {             count4          count;             stable_how4     committed;             verifier4       writeverf;     };     union WRITE4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4_OK:              WRITE4resok    resok4;      default:              void;     };   DESCRIPTION   The WRITE operation is used to write data to a regular file.  The   target file is specified by the current filehandle.  The offset   specifies the offset where the data should be written.  An offset of   0 (zero) specifies that the write should start at the beginning of   the file.  The count, as encoded as part of the opaque data   parameter, represents the number of bytes of data that are to be   written.  If the count is 0 (zero), the WRITE will succeed and return   a count of 0 (zero) subject to permissions checking.  The server may   choose to write fewer bytes than requested by the client.   Part of the write request is a specification of how the write is to   be performed.  The client specifies with the stable parameter the   method of how the data is to be processed by the server.  If stable   is FILE_SYNC4, the server must commit the data written plus all   filesystem metadata to stable storage before returning results.  This   corresponds to the NFS version 2 protocol semantics.  Any other   behavior constitutes a protocol violation.  If stable is DATA_SYNC4,   then the server must commit all of the data to stable storage and   enough of the metadata to retrieve the data before returning.  The   server implementor is free to implement DATA_SYNC4 in the same   fashion as FILE_SYNC4, but with a possible performance drop.  If   stable is UNSTABLE4, the server is free to commit any part of the   data and the metadata to stable storage, including all or none,   before returning a reply to the client. There is no guarantee whether   or when any uncommitted data will subsequently be committed to stable   storage. The only guarantees made by the server are that it will notShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 219]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   destroy any data without changing the value of verf and that it will   not commit the data and metadata at a level less than that requested   by the client.   The stateid value for a WRITE request represents a value returned   from a previous record lock or share reservation request.  The   stateid is used by the server to verify that the associated share   reservation and any record locks are still valid and to update lease   timeouts for the client.   Upon successful completion, the following results are returned.  The   count result is the number of bytes of data written to the file. The   server may write fewer bytes than requested. If so, the actual number   of bytes written starting at location, offset, is returned.   The server also returns an indication of the level of commitment of   the data and metadata via committed. If the server committed all data   and metadata to stable storage, committed should be set to   FILE_SYNC4. If the level of commitment was at least as strong as   DATA_SYNC4, then committed should be set to DATA_SYNC4.  Otherwise,   committed must be returned as UNSTABLE4. If stable was FILE4_SYNC,   then committed must also be FILE_SYNC4: anything else constitutes a   protocol violation. If stable was DATA_SYNC4, then committed may be   FILE_SYNC4 or DATA_SYNC4: anything else constitutes a protocol   violation. If stable was UNSTABLE4, then committed may be either   FILE_SYNC4, DATA_SYNC4, or UNSTABLE4.   The final portion of the result is the write verifier.  The write   verifier is a cookie that the client can use to determine whether the   server has changed instance (boot) state between a call to WRITE and   a subsequent call to either WRITE or COMMIT.  This cookie must be   consistent during a single instance of the NFS version 4 protocol   service and must be unique between instances of the NFS version 4   protocol server, where uncommitted data may be lost.   If a client writes data to the server with the stable argument set to   UNSTABLE4 and the reply yields a committed response of DATA_SYNC4 or   UNSTABLE4, the client will follow up some time in the future with a   COMMIT operation to synchronize outstanding asynchronous data and   metadata with the server's stable storage, barring client error. It   is possible that due to client crash or other error that a subsequent   COMMIT will not be received by the server.   For a WRITE with a stateid value of all bits 0, the server MAY allow   the WRITE to be serviced subject to mandatory file locks or the   current share deny modes for the file.  For a WRITE with a stateidShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 220]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   value of all bits 1, the server MUST NOT allow the WRITE operation to   bypass locking checks at the server and are treated exactly the same   as if a stateid of all bits 0 were used.   On success, the current filehandle retains its value.   IMPLEMENTATION   It is possible for the server to write fewer bytes of data than   requested by the client.  In this case, the server should not return   an error unless no data was written at all.  If the server writes   less than the number of bytes specified, the client should issue   another WRITE to write the remaining data.   It is assumed that the act of writing data to a file will cause the   time_modified of the file to be updated.  However, the time_modified   of the file should not be changed unless the contents of the file are   changed.  Thus, a WRITE request with count set to 0 should not cause   the time_modified of the file to be updated.   The definition of stable storage has been historically a point of   contention.  The following expected properties of stable storage may   help in resolving design issues in the implementation. Stable storage   is persistent storage that survives:      1. Repeated power failures.      2. Hardware failures (of any board, power supply, etc.).      3. Repeated software crashes, including reboot cycle.   This definition does not address failure of the stable storage module   itself.   The verifier is defined to allow a client to detect different   instances of an NFS version 4 protocol server over which cached,   uncommitted data may be lost. In the most likely case, the verifier   allows the client to detect server reboots.  This information is   required so that the client can safely determine whether the server   could have lost cached data.  If the server fails unexpectedly and   the client has uncommitted data from previous WRITE requests (done   with the stable argument set to UNSTABLE4 and in which the result   committed was returned as UNSTABLE4 as well) it may not have flushed   cached data to stable storage. The burden of recovery is on the   client and the client will need to retransmit the data to the server.   A suggested verifier would be to use the time that the server was   booted or the time the server was last started (if restarting the   server without a reboot results in lost buffers).Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 221]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   The committed field in the results allows the client to do more   effective caching.  If the server is committing all WRITE requests to   stable storage, then it should return with committed set to   FILE_SYNC4, regardless of the value of the stable field in the   arguments. A server that uses an NVRAM accelerator may choose to   implement this policy.  The client can use this to increase the   effectiveness of the cache by discarding cached data that has already   been committed on the server.   Some implementations may return NFS4ERR_NOSPC instead of   NFS4ERR_DQUOT when a user's quota is exceeded.  In the case that the   current filehandle is a directory, the server will return   NFS4ERR_ISDIR.  If the current filehandle is not a regular file or a   directory, the server will return NFS4ERR_INVAL.   If mandatory file locking is on for the file, and corresponding   record of the data to be written file is read or write locked by an   owner that is not associated with the stateid, the server will return   NFS4ERR_LOCKED. If so, the client must check if the owner   corresponding to the stateid used with the WRITE operation has a   conflicting read lock that overlaps with the region that was to be   written. If the stateid's owner has no conflicting read lock, then   the client should try to get the appropriate write record lock via   the LOCK operation before re-attempting the WRITE. When the WRITE   completes, the client should release the record lock via LOCKU.   If the stateid's owner had a conflicting read lock, then the client   has no choice but to return an error to the application that   attempted the WRITE. The reason is that since the stateid's owner had   a read lock, the server either attempted to temporarily effectively   upgrade this read lock to a write lock, or the server has no upgrade   capability. If the server attempted to upgrade the read lock and   failed, it is pointless for the client to re-attempt the upgrade via   the LOCK operation, because there might be another client also trying   to upgrade.  If two clients are blocked trying upgrade the same lock,   the clients deadlock.  If the server has no upgrade capability, then   it is pointless to try a LOCK operation to upgrade.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ACCESS      NFS4ERR_ADMIN_REVOKED      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_DELAY      NFS4ERR_DQUOT      NFS4ERR_EXPIREDShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 222]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003      NFS4ERR_FBIG      NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED      NFS4ERR_GRACE      NFS4ERR_INVAL      NFS4ERR_IO      NFS4ERR_ISDIR      NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED      NFS4ERR_LOCKED      NFS4ERR_MOVED      NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE      NFS4ERR_NOSPC      NFS4ERR_NXIO      NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_OPENMODE      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_ROFS      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE      NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID14.2.37.  Operation 39: RELEASE_LOCKOWNER - Release Lockowner State   SYNOPSIS     lockowner -> ()   ARGUMENT     struct RELEASE_LOCKOWNER4args {             lock_owner4     lock_owner;     };   RESULT     struct RELEASE_LOCKOWNER4res {             nfsstat4        status;     };   DESCRIPTION   This operation is used to notify the server that the lock_owner is no   longer in use by the client.  This allows the server to release   cached state related to the specified lock_owner.  If file locks,   associated with the lock_owner, are held at the server, the error   NFS4ERR_LOCKS_HELD will be returned and no further action will be   taken.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 223]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   IMPLEMENTATION   The client may choose to use this operation to ease the amount of   server state that is held.  Depending on behavior of applications at   the client, it may be important for the client to use this operation   since the server has certain obligations with respect to holding a   reference to a lock_owner as long as the associated file is open.   Therefore, if the client knows for certain that the lock_owner will   no longer be used under the context of the associated open_owner4, it   should use RELEASE_LOCKOWNER.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_ADMIN_REVOKED      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_EXPIRED      NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED      NFS4ERR_LOCKS_HELD      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT      NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID14.2.38.  Operation 10044: ILLEGAL - Illegal operation   SYNOPSIS     <null> -> ()   ARGUMENT             void;   RESULT             struct ILLEGAL4res {                     nfsstat4        status;             };   DESCRIPTION   This operation is a placeholder for encoding a result to handle the   case of the client sending an operation code within COMPOUND that is   not supported. See the COMPOUND procedure description for more   details.   The status field of ILLEGAL4res MUST be set to NFS4ERR_OP_ILLEGAL.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 224]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   IMPLEMENTATION   A client will probably not send an operation with code OP_ILLEGAL but   if it does, the response will be ILLEGAL4res just as it would be with   any other invalid operation code. Note that if the server gets an   illegal operation code that is not OP_ILLEGAL, and if the server   checks for legal operation codes during the XDR decode phase, then   the ILLEGAL4res would not be returned.   ERRORS   NFS4ERR_OP_ILLEGAL15.  NFS version 4 Callback Procedures   The procedures used for callbacks are defined in the following   sections.  In the interest of clarity, the terms "client" and   "server" refer to NFS clients and servers, despite the fact that for   an individual callback RPC, the sense of these terms would be   precisely the opposite.15.1.  Procedure 0: CB_NULL - No Operation   SYNOPSIS     <null>   ARGUMENT     void;   RESULT     void;   DESCRIPTION   Standard NULL procedure.  Void argument, void response.  Even though   there is no direct functionality associated with this procedure, the   server will use CB_NULL to confirm the existence of a path for RPCs   from server to client.   ERRORS   None.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 225]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 200315.2.  Procedure 1: CB_COMPOUND - Compound Operations   SYNOPSIS     compoundargs -> compoundres   ARGUMENT     enum nfs_cb_opnum4 {             OP_CB_GETATTR           = 3,             OP_CB_RECALL            = 4,             OP_CB_ILLEGAL           = 10044     };     union nfs_cb_argop4 switch (unsigned argop) {      case OP_CB_GETATTR:    CB_GETATTR4args opcbgetattr;      case OP_CB_RECALL:     CB_RECALL4args  opcbrecall;      case OP_CB_ILLEGAL:    void            opcbillegal;     };     struct CB_COMPOUND4args {             utf8str_cs      tag;             uint32_t        minorversion;             uint32_t        callback_ident;             nfs_cb_argop4   argarray<>;     };   RESULT     union nfs_cb_resop4 switch (unsigned resop){      case OP_CB_GETATTR:    CB_GETATTR4res  opcbgetattr;      case OP_CB_RECALL:     CB_RECALL4res   opcbrecall;     };     struct CB_COMPOUND4res {             nfsstat4 status;             utf8str_cs      tag;             nfs_cb_resop4   resarray<>;     };   DESCRIPTION   The CB_COMPOUND procedure is used to combine one or more of the   callback procedures into a single RPC request.  The main callback RPC   program has two main procedures: CB_NULL and CB_COMPOUND.  All other   operations use the CB_COMPOUND procedure as a wrapper.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 226]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   In the processing of the CB_COMPOUND procedure, the client may find   that it does not have the available resources to execute any or all   of the operations within the CB_COMPOUND sequence.  In this case, the   error NFS4ERR_RESOURCE will be returned for the particular operation   within the CB_COMPOUND procedure where the resource exhaustion   occurred.  This assumes that all previous operations within the   CB_COMPOUND sequence have been evaluated successfully.   Contained within the CB_COMPOUND results is a 'status' field.  This   status must be equivalent to the status of the last operation that   was executed within the CB_COMPOUND procedure.  Therefore, if an   operation incurred an error then the 'status' value will be the same   error value as is being returned for the operation that failed.   For the definition of the "tag" field, see the section "Procedure 1:   COMPOUND - Compound Operations".   The value of callback_ident is supplied by the client during   SETCLIENTID.  The server must use the client supplied callback_ident   during the CB_COMPOUND to allow the client to properly identify the   server.   Illegal operation codes are handled in the same way as they are   handled for the COMPOUND procedure.   IMPLEMENTATION   The CB_COMPOUND procedure is used to combine individual operations   into a single RPC request.  The client interprets each of the   operations in turn.  If an operation is executed by the client and   the status of that operation is NFS4_OK, then the next operation in   the CB_COMPOUND procedure is executed.  The client continues this   process until there are no more operations to be executed or one of   the operations has a status value other than NFS4_OK.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_OP_ILLEGAL      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULTShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 227]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 200315.2.1.  Operation 3: CB_GETATTR - Get Attributes   SYNOPSIS     fh, attr_request -> attrmask, attr_vals   ARGUMENT     struct CB_GETATTR4args {             nfs_fh4 fh;             bitmap4 attr_request;     };   RESULT     struct CB_GETATTR4resok {             fattr4  obj_attributes;     };     union CB_GETATTR4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {      case NFS4_OK:              CB_GETATTR4resok       resok4;      default:              void;     };DESCRIPTION   The CB_GETATTR operation is used by the server to obtain the   current modified state of a file that has been write delegated.   The attributes size and change are the only ones guaranteed to be   serviced by the client.  See the section "Handling of CB_GETATTR"   for a full description of how the client and server are to interact   with the use of CB_GETATTR.   If the filehandle specified is not one for which the client holds a   write open delegation, an NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE error is returned.   IMPLEMENTATION   The client returns attrmask bits and the associated attribute   values only for the change attribute, and attributes that it may   change (time_modify, and size).Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 228]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT15.2.2.  Operation 4: CB_RECALL - Recall an Open Delegation   SYNOPSIS     stateid, truncate, fh -> ()   ARGUMENT     struct CB_RECALL4args {             stateid4        stateid;             bool            truncate;             nfs_fh4         fh;     };   RESULT     struct CB_RECALL4res {             nfsstat4        status;     };   DESCRIPTION   The CB_RECALL operation is used to begin the process of recalling an   open delegation and returning it to the server.   The truncate flag is used to optimize recall for a file which is   about to be truncated to zero.  When it is set, the client is freed   of obligation to propagate modified data for the file to the server,   since this data is irrelevant.   If the handle specified is not one for which the client holds an open   delegation, an NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE error is returned.   If the stateid specified is not one corresponding to an open   delegation for the file specified by the filehandle, an   NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID is returned.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 229]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   IMPLEMENTATION   The client should reply to the callback immediately.  Replying does   not complete the recall except when an error was returned.  The   recall is not complete until the delegation is returned using a   DELEGRETURN.   ERRORS      NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE      NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID      NFS4ERR_BADXDR      NFS4ERR_RESOURCE      NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT15.2.3.  Operation 10044: CB_ILLEGAL - Illegal Callback Operation   SYNOPSIS     <null> -> ()   ARGUMENT       void;   RESULT             struct CB_ILLEGAL4res {                     nfsstat4        status;             };   DESCRIPTION   This operation is a placeholder for encoding a result to handle the   case of the client sending an operation code within COMPOUND that is   not supported. See the COMPOUND procedure description for more   details.   The status field of CB_ILLEGAL4res MUST be set to NFS4ERR_OP_ILLEGAL.   IMPLEMENTATION   A server will probably not send an operation with code OP_CB_ILLEGAL   but if it does, the response will be CB_ILLEGAL4res just as it would   be with any other invalid operation code. Note that if the clientShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 230]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   gets an illegal operation code that is not OP_ILLEGAL, and if the   client checks for legal operation codes during the XDR decode phase,   then the CB_ILLEGAL4res would not be returned.   ERRORS   NFS4ERR_OP_ILLEGAL16.  Security Considerations   NFS has historically used a model where, from an authentication   perspective, the client was the entire machine, or at least the   source IP address of the machine.  The NFS server relied on the NFS   client to make the proper authentication of the end-user.  The NFS   server in turn shared its files only to specific clients, as   identified by the client's source IP address.  Given this model, the   AUTH_SYS RPC security flavor simply identified the end-user using the   client to the NFS server.  When processing NFS responses, the client   ensured that the responses came from the same IP address and port   number that the request was sent to.  While such a model is easy to   implement and simple to deploy and use, it is certainly not a safe   model.  Thus, NFSv4 mandates that implementations support a security   model that uses end to end authentication, where an end-user on a   client mutually authenticates (via cryptographic schemes that do not   expose passwords or keys in the clear on the network) to a principal   on an NFS server.  Consideration should also be given to the   integrity and privacy of NFS requests and responses.  The issues of   end to end mutual authentication, integrity, and privacy are   discussed as part of the section on "RPC and Security Flavor".   Note that while NFSv4 mandates an end to end mutual authentication   model, the "classic" model of machine authentication via IP address   checking and AUTH_SYS identification can still be supported with the   caveat that the AUTH_SYS flavor is neither MANDATORY nor RECOMMENDED   by this specification, and so interoperability via AUTH_SYS is not   assured.   For reasons of reduced administration overhead, better performance   and/or reduction of CPU utilization, users of NFS version 4   implementations may choose to not use security mechanisms that enable   integrity protection on each remote procedure call and response. The   use of mechanisms without integrity leaves the customer vulnerable to   an attacker in between the NFS client and server that modifies the   RPC request and/or the response. While implementations are free to   provide the option to use weaker security mechanisms, there are two   operations in particular that warrant the implementation overriding   user choices.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 231]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   The first such operation is SECINFO.  It is recommended that the   client issue the SECINFO call such that it is protected with a   security flavor that has integrity protection, such as RPCSEC_GSS   with a security triple that uses either rpc_gss_svc_integrity or   rpc_gss_svc_privacy (rpc_gss_svc_privacy includes integrity   protection) service. Without integrity protection encapsulating   SECINFO and therefore its results, an attacker in the middle could   modify results such that the client might select a weaker algorithm   in the set allowed by server, making the client and/or server   vulnerable to further attacks.   The second operation that should definitely use integrity protection   is any GETATTR for the fs_locations attribute. The attack has two   steps.  First the attacker modifies the unprotected results of some   operation to return NFS4ERR_MOVED. Second, when the client follows up   with a GETATTR for the fs_locations attribute, the attacker modifies   the results to cause the client migrate its traffic to a server   controlled by the attacker.   Because the operations SETCLIENTID/SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM are   responsible for the release of client state, it is imperative that   the principal used for these operations is checked against and match   the previous use of these operations.  See the section "Client ID"   for further discussion.17.  IANA Considerations17.1.  Named Attribute Definition   The NFS version 4 protocol provides for the association of named   attributes to files.  The name space identifiers for these attributes   are defined as string names.  The protocol does not define the   specific assignment of the name space for these file attributes.   Even though the name space is not specifically controlled to prevent   collisions, an IANA registry has been created for the registration of   NFS version 4 named attributes.  Registration will be achieved   through the publication of an Informational RFC and will require not   only the name of the attribute but the syntax and semantics of the   named attribute contents; the intent is to promote interoperability   where common interests exist.  While application developers are   allowed to define and use attributes as needed, they are encouraged   to register the attributes with IANA.17.2.  ONC RPC Network Identifiers (netids)   The section "Structured Data Types" discussed the r_netid field and   the corresponding r_addr field of a clientaddr4 structure.  The NFS   version 4 protocol depends on the syntax and semantics of theseShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 232]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   fields to effectively communicate callback information between client   and server.  Therefore, an IANA registry has been created to include   the values defined in this document and to allow for future expansion   based on transport usage/availability.  Additions to this ONC RPC   Network Identifier registry must be done with the publication of an   RFC.   The initial values for this registry are as follows (some of this   text is replicated fromsection 2.2 for clarity):   The Network Identifier (or r_netid for short) is used to specify a   transport protocol and associated universal address (or r_addr for   short).  The syntax of the Network Identifier is a US-ASCII string.   The initial definitions for r_netid are:      "tcp"   - TCP over IP version 4      "udp"   - UDP over IP version 4      "tcp6"  - TCP over IP version 6      "udp6"  - UDP over IP version 6   Note: the '"' marks are used for delimiting the strings for this   document and are not part of the Network Identifier string.   For the "tcp" and "udp" Network Identifiers the Universal Address or   r_addr (for IPv4) is a US-ASCII string and is of the form:   h1.h2.h3.h4.p1.p2   The prefix, "h1.h2.h3.h4", is the standard textual form for   representing an IPv4 address, which is always four octets long.   Assuming big-endian ordering, h1, h2, h3, and h4, are respectively,   the first through fourth octets each converted to ASCII-decimal.   Assuming big-endian ordering, p1 and p2 are, respectively, the first   and second octets each converted to ASCII-decimal.  For example, if a   host, in big-endian order, has an address of 0x0A010307 and there is   a service listening on, in big endian order, port 0x020F (decimal   527), then complete universal address is "10.1.3.7.2.15".   For the "tcp6" and "udp6" Network Identifiers the Universal Address   or r_addr (for IPv6) is a US-ASCII string and is of the form:      x1:x2:x3:x4:x5:x6:x7:x8.p1.p2Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 233]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   The suffix "p1.p2" is the service port, and is computed the same way   as with universal addresses for "tcp" and "udp".  The prefix,   "x1:x2:x3:x4:x5:x6:x7:x8", is the standard textual form for   representing an IPv6 address as defined inSection 2.2 of [RFC2373].   Additionally, the two alternative forms specified inSection 2.2 of   [RFC2373] are also acceptable.   As mentioned, the registration of new Network Identifiers will   require the publication of an Information RFC with similar detail as   listed above for the Network Identifier itself and corresponding   Universal Address.18.  RPC definition file   /*    *  Copyright (C) The Internet Society (1998,1999,2000,2001,2002).    *  All Rights Reserved.    */   /*    *      nfs4_prot.x    *    */   %#pragma ident  "%W%"   /*    * Basic typedefs forRFC 1832 data type definitions    */   typedef int             int32_t;   typedef unsigned int    uint32_t;   typedef hyper           int64_t;   typedef unsigned hyper  uint64_t;   /*    * Sizes    */   const NFS4_FHSIZE               = 128;   const NFS4_VERIFIER_SIZE        = 8;   const NFS4_OPAQUE_LIMIT         = 1024;   /*    * File types    */   enum nfs_ftype4 {           NF4REG          = 1,    /* Regular File */           NF4DIR          = 2,    /* Directory */           NF4BLK          = 3,    /* Special File - block device */Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 234]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003           NF4CHR          = 4,    /* Special File - character device */           NF4LNK          = 5,    /* Symbolic Link */           NF4SOCK         = 6,    /* Special File - socket */           NF4FIFO         = 7,    /* Special File - fifo */           NF4ATTRDIR      = 8,    /* Attribute Directory */           NF4NAMEDATTR    = 9     /* Named Attribute */   };   /*    * Error status    */   enum nfsstat4 {           NFS4_OK                 = 0,    /* everything is okay      */           NFS4ERR_PERM            = 1,    /* caller not privileged   */           NFS4ERR_NOENT           = 2,    /* no such file/directory  */           NFS4ERR_IO              = 5,    /* hard I/O error          */           NFS4ERR_NXIO            = 6,    /* no such device          */           NFS4ERR_ACCESS          = 13,   /* access denied           */           NFS4ERR_EXIST           = 17,   /* file already exists     */           NFS4ERR_XDEV            = 18,   /* different filesystems   */           /* Unused/reserved        19 */           NFS4ERR_NOTDIR          = 20,   /* should be a directory   */           NFS4ERR_ISDIR           = 21,   /* should not be directory */           NFS4ERR_INVAL           = 22,   /* invalid argument        */           NFS4ERR_FBIG            = 27,   /* file exceeds server max */           NFS4ERR_NOSPC           = 28,   /* no space on filesystem  */           NFS4ERR_ROFS            = 30,   /* read-only filesystem    */           NFS4ERR_MLINK           = 31,   /* too many hard links     */           NFS4ERR_NAMETOOLONG     = 63,   /* name exceeds server max */           NFS4ERR_NOTEMPTY        = 66,   /* directory not empty     */           NFS4ERR_DQUOT           = 69,   /* hard quota limit reached*/           NFS4ERR_STALE           = 70,   /* file no longer exists   */           NFS4ERR_BADHANDLE       = 10001,/* Illegal filehandle      */           NFS4ERR_BAD_COOKIE      = 10003,/* READDIR cookie is stale */           NFS4ERR_NOTSUPP         = 10004,/* operation not supported */           NFS4ERR_TOOSMALL        = 10005,/* response limit exceeded */           NFS4ERR_SERVERFAULT     = 10006,/* undefined server error  */           NFS4ERR_BADTYPE         = 10007,/* type invalid for CREATE */           NFS4ERR_DELAY           = 10008,/* file "busy" - retry     */           NFS4ERR_SAME            = 10009,/* nverify says attrs same */           NFS4ERR_DENIED          = 10010,/* lock unavailable        */           NFS4ERR_EXPIRED         = 10011,/* lock lease expired      */           NFS4ERR_LOCKED          = 10012,/* I/O failed due to lock  */           NFS4ERR_GRACE           = 10013,/* in grace period         */           NFS4ERR_FHEXPIRED       = 10014,/* filehandle expired      */           NFS4ERR_SHARE_DENIED    = 10015,/* share reserve denied    */           NFS4ERR_WRONGSEC        = 10016,/* wrong security flavor   */           NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE      = 10017,/* clientid in use         */Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 235]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003           NFS4ERR_RESOURCE        = 10018,/* resource exhaustion     */           NFS4ERR_MOVED           = 10019,/* filesystem relocated    */           NFS4ERR_NOFILEHANDLE    = 10020,/* current FH is not set   */           NFS4ERR_MINOR_VERS_MISMATCH = 10021,/* minor vers not supp */           NFS4ERR_STALE_CLIENTID  = 10022,/* server has rebooted     */           NFS4ERR_STALE_STATEID   = 10023,/* server has rebooted     */           NFS4ERR_OLD_STATEID     = 10024,/* state is out of sync    */           NFS4ERR_BAD_STATEID     = 10025,/* incorrect stateid       */           NFS4ERR_BAD_SEQID       = 10026,/* request is out of seq.  */           NFS4ERR_NOT_SAME        = 10027,/* verify - attrs not same */           NFS4ERR_LOCK_RANGE      = 10028,/* lock range not supported*/           NFS4ERR_SYMLINK         = 10029,/* should be file/directory*/           NFS4ERR_RESTOREFH       = 10030,/* no saved filehandle     */           NFS4ERR_LEASE_MOVED     = 10031,/* some filesystem moved   */           NFS4ERR_ATTRNOTSUPP     = 10032,/* recommended attr not sup*/           NFS4ERR_NO_GRACE        = 10033,/* reclaim outside of grace*/           NFS4ERR_RECLAIM_BAD     = 10034,/* reclaim error at server */           NFS4ERR_RECLAIM_CONFLICT = 10035,/* conflict on reclaim    */           NFS4ERR_BADXDR          = 10036,/* XDR decode failed       */           NFS4ERR_LOCKS_HELD      = 10037,/* file locks held at CLOSE*/           NFS4ERR_OPENMODE        = 10038,/* conflict in OPEN and I/O*/           NFS4ERR_BADOWNER        = 10039,/* owner translation bad   */           NFS4ERR_BADCHAR         = 10040,/* utf-8 char not supported*/           NFS4ERR_BADNAME         = 10041,/* name not supported      */           NFS4ERR_BAD_RANGE       = 10042,/* lock range not supported*/           NFS4ERR_LOCK_NOTSUPP    = 10043,/* no atomic up/downgrade  */           NFS4ERR_OP_ILLEGAL      = 10044,/* undefined operation     */           NFS4ERR_DEADLOCK        = 10045,/* file locking deadlock   */           NFS4ERR_FILE_OPEN       = 10046,/* open file blocks op.    */           NFS4ERR_ADMIN_REVOKED   = 10047,/* lockowner state revoked */           NFS4ERR_CB_PATH_DOWN    = 10048 /* callback path down      */   };   /*    * Basic data types    */   typedef uint32_t        bitmap4<>;   typedef uint64_t        offset4;   typedef uint32_t        count4;   typedef uint64_t        length4;   typedef uint64_t        clientid4;   typedef uint32_t        seqid4;   typedef opaque          utf8string<>;   typedef utf8string      utf8str_cis;   typedef utf8string      utf8str_cs;   typedef utf8string      utf8str_mixed;   typedef utf8str_cs      component4;   typedef component4      pathname4<>;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 236]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   typedef uint64_t        nfs_lockid4;   typedef uint64_t        nfs_cookie4;   typedef utf8str_cs      linktext4;   typedef opaque          sec_oid4<>;   typedef uint32_t        qop4;   typedef uint32_t        mode4;   typedef uint64_t        changeid4;   typedef opaque          verifier4[NFS4_VERIFIER_SIZE];   /*    * Timeval    */   struct nfstime4 {           int64_t         seconds;           uint32_t        nseconds;   };   enum time_how4 {           SET_TO_SERVER_TIME4 = 0,           SET_TO_CLIENT_TIME4 = 1   };   union settime4 switch (time_how4 set_it) {    case SET_TO_CLIENT_TIME4:            nfstime4       time;    default:            void;   };   /*    * File access handle    */   typedef opaque  nfs_fh4<NFS4_FHSIZE>;   /*    * File attribute definitions    */   /*    * FSID structure for major/minor    */   struct fsid4 {           uint64_t        major;           uint64_t        minor;   };   /*Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 237]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003    * Filesystem locations attribute for relocation/migration    */   struct fs_location4 {           utf8str_cis     server<>;           pathname4       rootpath;   };   struct fs_locations4 {           pathname4       fs_root;           fs_location4    locations<>;   };   /*    * Various Access Control Entry definitions    */   /*    * Mask that indicates which Access Control Entries are supported.    * Values for the fattr4_aclsupport attribute.    */   const ACL4_SUPPORT_ALLOW_ACL    = 0x00000001;   const ACL4_SUPPORT_DENY_ACL     = 0x00000002;   const ACL4_SUPPORT_AUDIT_ACL    = 0x00000004;   const ACL4_SUPPORT_ALARM_ACL    = 0x00000008;   typedef uint32_t        acetype4;   /*    * acetype4 values, others can be added as needed.    */   const ACE4_ACCESS_ALLOWED_ACE_TYPE      = 0x00000000;   const ACE4_ACCESS_DENIED_ACE_TYPE       = 0x00000001;   const ACE4_SYSTEM_AUDIT_ACE_TYPE        = 0x00000002;   const ACE4_SYSTEM_ALARM_ACE_TYPE        = 0x00000003;   /*    * ACE flag    */   typedef uint32_t aceflag4;   /*    * ACE flag values    */   const ACE4_FILE_INHERIT_ACE             = 0x00000001;   const ACE4_DIRECTORY_INHERIT_ACE        = 0x00000002;   const ACE4_NO_PROPAGATE_INHERIT_ACE     = 0x00000004;   const ACE4_INHERIT_ONLY_ACE             = 0x00000008;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 238]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   const ACE4_SUCCESSFUL_ACCESS_ACE_FLAG   = 0x00000010;   const ACE4_FAILED_ACCESS_ACE_FLAG       = 0x00000020;   const ACE4_IDENTIFIER_GROUP             = 0x00000040;   /*    * ACE mask    */   typedef uint32_t        acemask4;   /*    * ACE mask values    */   const ACE4_READ_DATA            = 0x00000001;   const ACE4_LIST_DIRECTORY       = 0x00000001;   const ACE4_WRITE_DATA           = 0x00000002;   const ACE4_ADD_FILE             = 0x00000002;   const ACE4_APPEND_DATA          = 0x00000004;   const ACE4_ADD_SUBDIRECTORY     = 0x00000004;   const ACE4_READ_NAMED_ATTRS     = 0x00000008;   const ACE4_WRITE_NAMED_ATTRS    = 0x00000010;   const ACE4_EXECUTE              = 0x00000020;   const ACE4_DELETE_CHILD         = 0x00000040;   const ACE4_READ_ATTRIBUTES      = 0x00000080;   const ACE4_WRITE_ATTRIBUTES     = 0x00000100;   const ACE4_DELETE               = 0x00010000;   const ACE4_READ_ACL             = 0x00020000;   const ACE4_WRITE_ACL            = 0x00040000;   const ACE4_WRITE_OWNER          = 0x00080000;   const ACE4_SYNCHRONIZE          = 0x00100000;   /*    * ACE4_GENERIC_READ -- defined as combination of    *      ACE4_READ_ACL |    *      ACE4_READ_DATA |    *      ACE4_READ_ATTRIBUTES |    *      ACE4_SYNCHRONIZE    */   const ACE4_GENERIC_READ = 0x00120081;   /*    * ACE4_GENERIC_WRITE -- defined as combination of    *      ACE4_READ_ACL |    *      ACE4_WRITE_DATA |    *      ACE4_WRITE_ATTRIBUTES |    *      ACE4_WRITE_ACL |Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 239]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003    *      ACE4_APPEND_DATA |    *      ACE4_SYNCHRONIZE    */   const ACE4_GENERIC_WRITE = 0x00160106;   /*    * ACE4_GENERIC_EXECUTE -- defined as combination of    *      ACE4_READ_ACL    *      ACE4_READ_ATTRIBUTES    *      ACE4_EXECUTE    *      ACE4_SYNCHRONIZE    */   const ACE4_GENERIC_EXECUTE = 0x001200A0;   /*    * Access Control Entry definition    */   struct nfsace4 {           acetype4        type;           aceflag4        flag;           acemask4        access_mask;           utf8str_mixed   who;   };   /*    * Field definitions for the fattr4_mode attribute    */   const MODE4_SUID = 0x800;  /* set user id on execution */   const MODE4_SGID = 0x400;  /* set group id on execution */   const MODE4_SVTX = 0x200;  /* save text even after use */   const MODE4_RUSR = 0x100;  /* read permission: owner */   const MODE4_WUSR = 0x080;  /* write permission: owner */   const MODE4_XUSR = 0x040;  /* execute permission: owner */   const MODE4_RGRP = 0x020;  /* read permission: group */   const MODE4_WGRP = 0x010;  /* write permission: group */   const MODE4_XGRP = 0x008;  /* execute permission: group */   const MODE4_ROTH = 0x004;  /* read permission: other */   const MODE4_WOTH = 0x002;  /* write permission: other */   const MODE4_XOTH = 0x001;  /* execute permission: other */   /*    * Special data/attribute associated with    * file types NF4BLK and NF4CHR.    */   struct specdata4 {           uint32_t        specdata1;      /* major device number */Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 240]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003           uint32_t        specdata2;      /* minor device number */   };   /*    * Values for fattr4_fh_expire_type    */   const   FH4_PERSISTENT          = 0x00000000;   const   FH4_NOEXPIRE_WITH_OPEN  = 0x00000001;   const   FH4_VOLATILE_ANY        = 0x00000002;   const   FH4_VOL_MIGRATION       = 0x00000004;   const   FH4_VOL_RENAME          = 0x00000008;   typedef bitmap4         fattr4_supported_attrs;   typedef nfs_ftype4      fattr4_type;   typedef uint32_t        fattr4_fh_expire_type;   typedef changeid4       fattr4_change;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_size;   typedef bool            fattr4_link_support;   typedef bool            fattr4_symlink_support;   typedef bool            fattr4_named_attr;   typedef fsid4           fattr4_fsid;   typedef bool            fattr4_unique_handles;   typedef uint32_t        fattr4_lease_time;   typedef nfsstat4        fattr4_rdattr_error;   typedef nfsace4         fattr4_acl<>;   typedef uint32_t        fattr4_aclsupport;   typedef bool            fattr4_archive;   typedef bool            fattr4_cansettime;   typedef bool            fattr4_case_insensitive;   typedef bool            fattr4_case_preserving;   typedef bool            fattr4_chown_restricted;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_fileid;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_files_avail;   typedef nfs_fh4         fattr4_filehandle;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_files_free;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_files_total;   typedef fs_locations4   fattr4_fs_locations;   typedef bool            fattr4_hidden;   typedef bool            fattr4_homogeneous;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_maxfilesize;   typedef uint32_t        fattr4_maxlink;   typedef uint32_t        fattr4_maxname;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_maxread;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_maxwrite;   typedef utf8str_cs      fattr4_mimetype;   typedef mode4           fattr4_mode;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 241]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_mounted_on_fileid;   typedef bool            fattr4_no_trunc;   typedef uint32_t        fattr4_numlinks;   typedef utf8str_mixed   fattr4_owner;   typedef utf8str_mixed   fattr4_owner_group;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_quota_avail_hard;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_quota_avail_soft;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_quota_used;   typedef specdata4       fattr4_rawdev;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_space_avail;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_space_free;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_space_total;   typedef uint64_t        fattr4_space_used;   typedef bool            fattr4_system;   typedef nfstime4        fattr4_time_access;   typedef settime4        fattr4_time_access_set;   typedef nfstime4        fattr4_time_backup;   typedef nfstime4        fattr4_time_create;   typedef nfstime4        fattr4_time_delta;   typedef nfstime4        fattr4_time_metadata;   typedef nfstime4        fattr4_time_modify;   typedef settime4        fattr4_time_modify_set;   /*    * Mandatory Attributes    */   const FATTR4_SUPPORTED_ATTRS    = 0;   const FATTR4_TYPE               = 1;   const FATTR4_FH_EXPIRE_TYPE     = 2;   const FATTR4_CHANGE             = 3;   const FATTR4_SIZE               = 4;   const FATTR4_LINK_SUPPORT       = 5;   const FATTR4_SYMLINK_SUPPORT    = 6;   const FATTR4_NAMED_ATTR         = 7;   const FATTR4_FSID               = 8;   const FATTR4_UNIQUE_HANDLES     = 9;   const FATTR4_LEASE_TIME         = 10;   const FATTR4_RDATTR_ERROR       = 11;   const FATTR4_FILEHANDLE         = 19;   /*    * Recommended Attributes    */   const FATTR4_ACL                = 12;   const FATTR4_ACLSUPPORT         = 13;   const FATTR4_ARCHIVE            = 14;   const FATTR4_CANSETTIME         = 15;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 242]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   const FATTR4_CASE_INSENSITIVE   = 16;   const FATTR4_CASE_PRESERVING    = 17;   const FATTR4_CHOWN_RESTRICTED   = 18;   const FATTR4_FILEID             = 20;   const FATTR4_FILES_AVAIL        = 21;   const FATTR4_FILES_FREE         = 22;   const FATTR4_FILES_TOTAL        = 23;   const FATTR4_FS_LOCATIONS       = 24;   const FATTR4_HIDDEN             = 25;   const FATTR4_HOMOGENEOUS        = 26;   const FATTR4_MAXFILESIZE        = 27;   const FATTR4_MAXLINK            = 28;   const FATTR4_MAXNAME            = 29;   const FATTR4_MAXREAD            = 30;   const FATTR4_MAXWRITE           = 31;   const FATTR4_MIMETYPE           = 32;   const FATTR4_MODE               = 33;   const FATTR4_NO_TRUNC           = 34;   const FATTR4_NUMLINKS           = 35;   const FATTR4_OWNER              = 36;   const FATTR4_OWNER_GROUP        = 37;   const FATTR4_QUOTA_AVAIL_HARD   = 38;   const FATTR4_QUOTA_AVAIL_SOFT   = 39;   const FATTR4_QUOTA_USED         = 40;   const FATTR4_RAWDEV             = 41;   const FATTR4_SPACE_AVAIL        = 42;   const FATTR4_SPACE_FREE         = 43;   const FATTR4_SPACE_TOTAL        = 44;   const FATTR4_SPACE_USED         = 45;   const FATTR4_SYSTEM             = 46;   const FATTR4_TIME_ACCESS        = 47;   const FATTR4_TIME_ACCESS_SET    = 48;   const FATTR4_TIME_BACKUP        = 49;   const FATTR4_TIME_CREATE        = 50;   const FATTR4_TIME_DELTA         = 51;   const FATTR4_TIME_METADATA      = 52;   const FATTR4_TIME_MODIFY        = 53;   const FATTR4_TIME_MODIFY_SET    = 54;   const FATTR4_MOUNTED_ON_FILEID  = 55;   typedef opaque  attrlist4<>;   /*    * File attribute container    */   struct fattr4 {           bitmap4         attrmask;           attrlist4       attr_vals;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 243]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   };   /*    * Change info for the client    */   struct change_info4 {           bool            atomic;           changeid4       before;           changeid4       after;   };   struct clientaddr4 {           /* see struct rpcb inRFC 1833 */           string r_netid<>;               /* network id */           string r_addr<>;                /* universal address */   };   /*    * Callback program info as provided by the client    */   struct cb_client4 {           uint32_t        cb_program;           clientaddr4     cb_location;   };   /*    * Stateid    */   struct stateid4 {           uint32_t        seqid;           opaque          other[12];   };   /*    * Client ID    */   struct nfs_client_id4 {           verifier4       verifier;           opaque          id<NFS4_OPAQUE_LIMIT>;   };   struct open_owner4 {           clientid4       clientid;           opaque          owner<NFS4_OPAQUE_LIMIT>;   };   struct lock_owner4 {           clientid4       clientid;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 244]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003           opaque          owner<NFS4_OPAQUE_LIMIT>;   };   enum nfs_lock_type4 {           READ_LT         = 1,           WRITE_LT        = 2,           READW_LT        = 3,    /* blocking read */           WRITEW_LT       = 4     /* blocking write */   };   /*    * ACCESS: Check access permission    */   const ACCESS4_READ      = 0x00000001;   const ACCESS4_LOOKUP    = 0x00000002;   const ACCESS4_MODIFY    = 0x00000004;   const ACCESS4_EXTEND    = 0x00000008;   const ACCESS4_DELETE    = 0x00000010;   const ACCESS4_EXECUTE   = 0x00000020;   struct ACCESS4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: object */           uint32_t        access;   };   struct ACCESS4resok {           uint32_t        supported;           uint32_t        access;   };   union ACCESS4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            ACCESS4resok   resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * CLOSE: Close a file and release share reservations    */   struct CLOSE4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: object */           seqid4          seqid;           stateid4        open_stateid;   };   union CLOSE4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 245]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003            stateid4       open_stateid;    default:            void;   };   /*    * COMMIT: Commit cached data on server to stable storage    */   struct COMMIT4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: file */           offset4         offset;           count4          count;   };   struct COMMIT4resok {           verifier4       writeverf;   };   union COMMIT4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            COMMIT4resok   resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * CREATE: Create a non-regular file    */   union createtype4 switch (nfs_ftype4 type) {    case NF4LNK:            linktext4      linkdata;    case NF4BLK:    case NF4CHR:            specdata4      devdata;    case NF4SOCK:    case NF4FIFO:    case NF4DIR:            void;    default:            void;          /* server should return NFS4ERR_BADTYPE */   };   struct CREATE4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: directory for creation */           createtype4     objtype;           component4      objname;           fattr4          createattrs;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 246]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   };   struct CREATE4resok {           change_info4    cinfo;           bitmap4         attrset;        /* attributes set */   };   union CREATE4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            CREATE4resok resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * DELEGPURGE: Purge Delegations Awaiting Recovery    */   struct DELEGPURGE4args {           clientid4       clientid;   };   struct DELEGPURGE4res {           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * DELEGRETURN: Return a delegation    */   struct DELEGRETURN4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: delegated file */           stateid4        deleg_stateid;   };   struct DELEGRETURN4res {           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * GETATTR: Get file attributes    */   struct GETATTR4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: directory or file */           bitmap4         attr_request;   };   struct GETATTR4resok {           fattr4          obj_attributes;   };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 247]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   union GETATTR4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            GETATTR4resok  resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * GETFH: Get current filehandle    */   struct GETFH4resok {           nfs_fh4         object;   };   union GETFH4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:           GETFH4resok     resok4;    default:           void;   };   /*    * LINK: Create link to an object    */   struct LINK4args {           /* SAVED_FH: source object */           /* CURRENT_FH: target directory */           component4      newname;   };   struct LINK4resok {           change_info4    cinfo;   };   union LINK4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            LINK4resok resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * For LOCK, transition from open_owner to new lock_owner    */   struct open_to_lock_owner4 {           seqid4          open_seqid;           stateid4        open_stateid;           seqid4          lock_seqid;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 248]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003           lock_owner4     lock_owner;   };   /*    * For LOCK, existing lock_owner continues to request file locks    */   struct exist_lock_owner4 {           stateid4        lock_stateid;           seqid4          lock_seqid;   };   union locker4 switch (bool new_lock_owner) {    case TRUE:           open_to_lock_owner4     open_owner;    case FALSE:           exist_lock_owner4       lock_owner;   };   /*    * LOCK/LOCKT/LOCKU: Record lock management    */   struct LOCK4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: file */           nfs_lock_type4  locktype;           bool            reclaim;           offset4         offset;           length4         length;           locker4         locker;   };   struct LOCK4denied {           offset4         offset;           length4         length;           nfs_lock_type4  locktype;           lock_owner4     owner;   };   struct LOCK4resok {           stateid4        lock_stateid;   };   union LOCK4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            LOCK4resok     resok4;    case NFS4ERR_DENIED:            LOCK4denied    denied;    default:            void;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 249]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   };   struct LOCKT4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: file */           nfs_lock_type4  locktype;           offset4         offset;           length4         length;           lock_owner4     owner;   };   union LOCKT4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4ERR_DENIED:            LOCK4denied    denied;    case NFS4_OK:            void;    default:            void;   };   struct LOCKU4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: file */           nfs_lock_type4  locktype;           seqid4          seqid;           stateid4        lock_stateid;           offset4         offset;           length4         length;   };   union LOCKU4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case   NFS4_OK:            stateid4       lock_stateid;    default:            void;   };   /*    * LOOKUP: Lookup filename    */   struct LOOKUP4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: directory */           component4      objname;   };   struct LOOKUP4res {           /* CURRENT_FH: object */           nfsstat4        status;   };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 250]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   /*    * LOOKUPP: Lookup parent directory    */   struct LOOKUPP4res {           /* CURRENT_FH: directory */           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * NVERIFY: Verify attributes different    */   struct NVERIFY4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: object */           fattr4          obj_attributes;   };   struct NVERIFY4res {           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * Various definitions for OPEN    */   enum createmode4 {           UNCHECKED4      = 0,           GUARDED4        = 1,           EXCLUSIVE4      = 2   };   union createhow4 switch (createmode4 mode) {    case UNCHECKED4:    case GUARDED4:            fattr4         createattrs;    case EXCLUSIVE4:            verifier4      createverf;   };   enum opentype4 {           OPEN4_NOCREATE  = 0,           OPEN4_CREATE    = 1   };   union openflag4 switch (opentype4 opentype) {    case OPEN4_CREATE:            createhow4     how;    default:            void;   };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 251]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   /* Next definitions used for OPEN delegation */   enum limit_by4 {           NFS_LIMIT_SIZE          = 1,           NFS_LIMIT_BLOCKS        = 2           /* others as needed */   };   struct nfs_modified_limit4 {           uint32_t        num_blocks;           uint32_t        bytes_per_block;   };   union nfs_space_limit4 switch (limit_by4 limitby) {    /* limit specified as file size */    case NFS_LIMIT_SIZE:            uint64_t               filesize;    /* limit specified by number of blocks */    case NFS_LIMIT_BLOCKS:            nfs_modified_limit4    mod_blocks;   } ;   /*    * Share Access and Deny constants for open argument    */   const OPEN4_SHARE_ACCESS_READ   = 0x00000001;   const OPEN4_SHARE_ACCESS_WRITE  = 0x00000002;   const OPEN4_SHARE_ACCESS_BOTH   = 0x00000003;   const OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_NONE     = 0x00000000;   const OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_READ     = 0x00000001;   const OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_WRITE    = 0x00000002;   const OPEN4_SHARE_DENY_BOTH     = 0x00000003;   enum open_delegation_type4 {           OPEN_DELEGATE_NONE      = 0,           OPEN_DELEGATE_READ      = 1,           OPEN_DELEGATE_WRITE     = 2   };   enum open_claim_type4 {           CLAIM_NULL              = 0,           CLAIM_PREVIOUS          = 1,           CLAIM_DELEGATE_CUR      = 2,           CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV     = 3   };   struct open_claim_delegate_cur4 {           stateid4        delegate_stateid;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 252]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003           component4      file;   };   union open_claim4 switch (open_claim_type4 claim) {    /*     * No special rights to file. Ordinary OPEN of the specified file.     */    case CLAIM_NULL:           /* CURRENT_FH: directory */           component4      file;    /*     * Right to the file established by an open previous to server     * reboot.  File identified by filehandle obtained at that time     * rather than by name.     */    case CLAIM_PREVIOUS:           /* CURRENT_FH: file being reclaimed */           open_delegation_type4   delegate_type;    /*     * Right to file based on a delegation granted by the server.     * File is specified by name.     */    case CLAIM_DELEGATE_CUR:           /* CURRENT_FH: directory */           open_claim_delegate_cur4        delegate_cur_info;    /* Right to file based on a delegation granted to a previous boot     * instance of the client.  File is specified by name.     */    case CLAIM_DELEGATE_PREV:            /* CURRENT_FH: directory */           component4      file_delegate_prev;   };   /*    * OPEN: Open a file, potentially receiving an open delegation    */   struct OPEN4args {           seqid4          seqid;           uint32_t        share_access;           uint32_t        share_deny;           open_owner4     owner;           openflag4       openhow;           open_claim4     claim;   };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 253]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   struct open_read_delegation4 {           stateid4        stateid;        /* Stateid for delegation*/           bool            recall;         /* Pre-recalled flag for                                              delegations obtained                                              by reclaim                                              (CLAIM_PREVIOUS) */           nfsace4         permissions;    /* Defines users who don't                                              need an ACCESS call to                                              open for read */   };   struct open_write_delegation4 {           stateid4        stateid;        /* Stateid for delegation */           bool            recall;         /* Pre-recalled flag for                                              delegations obtained                                              by reclaim                                              (CLAIM_PREVIOUS) */           nfs_space_limit4 space_limit;   /* Defines condition that                                              the client must check to                                              determine whether the                                              file needs to be flushed                                              to the server on close.                                              */           nfsace4         permissions;    /* Defines users who don't                                              need an ACCESS call as                                              part of a delegated                                              open. */   };   union open_delegation4   switch (open_delegation_type4 delegation_type) {           case OPEN_DELEGATE_NONE:                   void;           case OPEN_DELEGATE_READ:                   open_read_delegation4 read;           case OPEN_DELEGATE_WRITE:                   open_write_delegation4 write;   };   /*    * Result flags    */   /* Client must confirm open */   const OPEN4_RESULT_CONFIRM      = 0x00000002;   /* Type of file locking behavior at the server */   const OPEN4_RESULT_LOCKTYPE_POSIX = 0x00000004;   struct OPEN4resok {           stateid4        stateid;        /* Stateid for open */Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 254]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003           change_info4    cinfo;          /* Directory Change Info */           uint32_t        rflags;         /* Result flags */           bitmap4         attrset;        /* attribute set for create*/           open_delegation4 delegation;    /* Info on any open                                              delegation */   };   union OPEN4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:           /* CURRENT_FH: opened file */           OPEN4resok      resok4;    default:           void;   };   /*    * OPENATTR: open named attributes directory    */   struct OPENATTR4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: object */           bool    createdir;   };   struct OPENATTR4res {           /* CURRENT_FH: named attr directory */           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * OPEN_CONFIRM: confirm the open    */   struct OPEN_CONFIRM4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: opened file */           stateid4        open_stateid;           seqid4          seqid;   };   struct OPEN_CONFIRM4resok {           stateid4        open_stateid;   };   union OPEN_CONFIRM4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {       case NFS4_OK:               OPEN_CONFIRM4resok     resok4;    default:            void;   };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 255]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   /*    * OPEN_DOWNGRADE: downgrade the access/deny for a file    */   struct OPEN_DOWNGRADE4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: opened file */           stateid4        open_stateid;           seqid4          seqid;           uint32_t        share_access;           uint32_t        share_deny;   };   struct OPEN_DOWNGRADE4resok {           stateid4        open_stateid;   };   union OPEN_DOWNGRADE4res switch(nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:           OPEN_DOWNGRADE4resok    resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * PUTFH: Set current filehandle    */   struct PUTFH4args {           nfs_fh4         object;   };   struct PUTFH4res {           /* CURRENT_FH: */           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * PUTPUBFH: Set public filehandle    */   struct PUTPUBFH4res {           /* CURRENT_FH: public fh */           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * PUTROOTFH: Set root filehandle    */   struct PUTROOTFH4res {           /* CURRENT_FH: root fh */Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 256]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * READ: Read from file    */   struct READ4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: file */           stateid4        stateid;           offset4         offset;           count4          count;   };   struct READ4resok {           bool            eof;           opaque          data<>;   };   union READ4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            READ4resok     resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * READDIR: Read directory    */   struct READDIR4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: directory */           nfs_cookie4     cookie;           verifier4       cookieverf;           count4          dircount;           count4          maxcount;           bitmap4         attr_request;   };   struct entry4 {           nfs_cookie4     cookie;           component4      name;           fattr4          attrs;           entry4          *nextentry;   };   struct dirlist4 {           entry4          *entries;           bool            eof;   };Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 257]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   struct READDIR4resok {           verifier4       cookieverf;           dirlist4        reply;   };   union READDIR4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            READDIR4resok  resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * READLINK: Read symbolic link    */   struct READLINK4resok {           linktext4       link;   };   union READLINK4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            READLINK4resok resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * REMOVE: Remove filesystem object    */   struct REMOVE4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: directory */           component4      target;   };   struct REMOVE4resok {           change_info4    cinfo;   };   union REMOVE4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            REMOVE4resok   resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 258]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003    * RENAME: Rename directory entry    */   struct RENAME4args {           /* SAVED_FH: source directory */           component4      oldname;           /* CURRENT_FH: target directory */           component4      newname;   };   struct RENAME4resok {           change_info4    source_cinfo;           change_info4    target_cinfo;   };   union RENAME4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:           RENAME4resok    resok4;    default:           void;   };   /*    * RENEW: Renew a Lease    */   struct RENEW4args {           clientid4       clientid;   };   struct RENEW4res {           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * RESTOREFH: Restore saved filehandle    */   struct RESTOREFH4res {           /* CURRENT_FH: value of saved fh */           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * SAVEFH: Save current filehandle    */   struct SAVEFH4res {           /* SAVED_FH: value of current fh */           nfsstat4        status;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 259]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   };   /*    * SECINFO: Obtain Available Security Mechanisms    */   struct SECINFO4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: directory */           component4      name;   };   /*    * FromRFC 2203    */   enum rpc_gss_svc_t {           RPC_GSS_SVC_NONE        = 1,           RPC_GSS_SVC_INTEGRITY   = 2,           RPC_GSS_SVC_PRIVACY     = 3   };   struct rpcsec_gss_info {           sec_oid4        oid;           qop4            qop;           rpc_gss_svc_t   service;   };   /* RPCSEC_GSS has a value of '6' - SeeRFC 2203 */   union secinfo4 switch (uint32_t flavor) {    case RPCSEC_GSS:            rpcsec_gss_info        flavor_info;    default:            void;   };   typedef secinfo4 SECINFO4resok<>;   union SECINFO4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            SECINFO4resok resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * SETATTR: Set attributes    */   struct SETATTR4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: target object */Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 260]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003           stateid4        stateid;           fattr4          obj_attributes;   };   struct SETATTR4res {           nfsstat4        status;           bitmap4         attrsset;   };   /*    * SETCLIENTID    */   struct SETCLIENTID4args {           nfs_client_id4  client;           cb_client4      callback;           uint32_t        callback_ident;   };   struct SETCLIENTID4resok {           clientid4       clientid;           verifier4       setclientid_confirm;   };   union SETCLIENTID4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            SETCLIENTID4resok      resok4;    case NFS4ERR_CLID_INUSE:            clientaddr4    client_using;    default:            void;   };   struct SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM4args {           clientid4       clientid;           verifier4       setclientid_confirm;   };   struct SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM4res {           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * VERIFY: Verify attributes same    */   struct VERIFY4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: object */           fattr4          obj_attributes;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 261]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   };   struct VERIFY4res {           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * WRITE: Write to file    */   enum stable_how4 {           UNSTABLE4       = 0,           DATA_SYNC4      = 1,           FILE_SYNC4      = 2   };   struct WRITE4args {           /* CURRENT_FH: file */           stateid4        stateid;           offset4         offset;           stable_how4     stable;           opaque          data<>;   };   struct WRITE4resok {           count4          count;           stable_how4     committed;           verifier4       writeverf;   };   union WRITE4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            WRITE4resok    resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * RELEASE_LOCKOWNER: Notify server to release lockowner    */   struct RELEASE_LOCKOWNER4args {           lock_owner4     lock_owner;   };   struct RELEASE_LOCKOWNER4res {           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 262]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003    * ILLEGAL: Response for illegal operation numbers    */   struct ILLEGAL4res {           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * Operation arrays    */   enum nfs_opnum4 {           OP_ACCESS               = 3,           OP_CLOSE                = 4,           OP_COMMIT               = 5,           OP_CREATE               = 6,           OP_DELEGPURGE           = 7,           OP_DELEGRETURN          = 8,           OP_GETATTR              = 9,           OP_GETFH                = 10,           OP_LINK                 = 11,           OP_LOCK                 = 12,           OP_LOCKT                = 13,           OP_LOCKU                = 14,           OP_LOOKUP               = 15,           OP_LOOKUPP              = 16,           OP_NVERIFY              = 17,           OP_OPEN                 = 18,           OP_OPENATTR             = 19,           OP_OPEN_CONFIRM         = 20,           OP_OPEN_DOWNGRADE       = 21,           OP_PUTFH                = 22,           OP_PUTPUBFH             = 23,           OP_PUTROOTFH            = 24,           OP_READ                 = 25,           OP_READDIR              = 26,           OP_READLINK             = 27,           OP_REMOVE               = 28,           OP_RENAME               = 29,           OP_RENEW                = 30,           OP_RESTOREFH            = 31,           OP_SAVEFH               = 32,           OP_SECINFO              = 33,           OP_SETATTR              = 34,           OP_SETCLIENTID          = 35,           OP_SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM  = 36,           OP_VERIFY               = 37,           OP_WRITE                = 38,           OP_RELEASE_LOCKOWNER    = 39,Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 263]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003           OP_ILLEGAL              = 10044   };   union nfs_argop4 switch (nfs_opnum4 argop) {    case OP_ACCESS:        ACCESS4args opaccess;    case OP_CLOSE:         CLOSE4args opclose;    case OP_COMMIT:        COMMIT4args opcommit;    case OP_CREATE:        CREATE4args opcreate;    case OP_DELEGPURGE:    DELEGPURGE4args opdelegpurge;    case OP_DELEGRETURN:   DELEGRETURN4args opdelegreturn;    case OP_GETATTR:       GETATTR4args opgetattr;    case OP_GETFH:         void;    case OP_LINK:          LINK4args oplink;    case OP_LOCK:          LOCK4args oplock;    case OP_LOCKT:         LOCKT4args oplockt;    case OP_LOCKU:         LOCKU4args oplocku;    case OP_LOOKUP:        LOOKUP4args oplookup;    case OP_LOOKUPP:       void;    case OP_NVERIFY:       NVERIFY4args opnverify;    case OP_OPEN:          OPEN4args opopen;    case OP_OPENATTR:      OPENATTR4args opopenattr;    case OP_OPEN_CONFIRM:  OPEN_CONFIRM4args opopen_confirm;    case OP_OPEN_DOWNGRADE:        OPEN_DOWNGRADE4args opopen_downgrade;    case OP_PUTFH:         PUTFH4args opputfh;    case OP_PUTPUBFH:      void;    case OP_PUTROOTFH:     void;    case OP_READ:          READ4args opread;    case OP_READDIR:       READDIR4args opreaddir;    case OP_READLINK:      void;    case OP_REMOVE:        REMOVE4args opremove;    case OP_RENAME:        RENAME4args oprename;    case OP_RENEW:         RENEW4args oprenew;    case OP_RESTOREFH:     void;    case OP_SAVEFH:        void;    case OP_SECINFO:       SECINFO4args opsecinfo;    case OP_SETATTR:       SETATTR4args opsetattr;    case OP_SETCLIENTID:   SETCLIENTID4args opsetclientid;    case OP_SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM:   SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM4args                                           opsetclientid_confirm;    case OP_VERIFY:        VERIFY4args opverify;    case OP_WRITE:         WRITE4args opwrite;    case OP_RELEASE_LOCKOWNER:     RELEASE_LOCKOWNER4args                                       oprelease_lockowner;    case OP_ILLEGAL:       void;   };   union nfs_resop4 switch (nfs_opnum4 resop){    case OP_ACCESS:        ACCESS4res opaccess;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 264]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003    case OP_CLOSE:         CLOSE4res opclose;    case OP_COMMIT:        COMMIT4res opcommit;    case OP_CREATE:        CREATE4res opcreate;    case OP_DELEGPURGE:    DELEGPURGE4res opdelegpurge;    case OP_DELEGRETURN:   DELEGRETURN4res opdelegreturn;    case OP_GETATTR:       GETATTR4res opgetattr;    case OP_GETFH:         GETFH4res opgetfh;    case OP_LINK:          LINK4res oplink;    case OP_LOCK:          LOCK4res oplock;    case OP_LOCKT:         LOCKT4res oplockt;    case OP_LOCKU:         LOCKU4res oplocku;    case OP_LOOKUP:        LOOKUP4res oplookup;    case OP_LOOKUPP:       LOOKUPP4res oplookupp;    case OP_NVERIFY:       NVERIFY4res opnverify;    case OP_OPEN:          OPEN4res opopen;    case OP_OPENATTR:      OPENATTR4res opopenattr;    case OP_OPEN_CONFIRM:  OPEN_CONFIRM4res opopen_confirm;    case OP_OPEN_DOWNGRADE:        OPEN_DOWNGRADE4res opopen_downgrade;    case OP_PUTFH:         PUTFH4res opputfh;    case OP_PUTPUBFH:      PUTPUBFH4res opputpubfh;    case OP_PUTROOTFH:     PUTROOTFH4res opputrootfh;    case OP_READ:          READ4res opread;    case OP_READDIR:       READDIR4res opreaddir;    case OP_READLINK:      READLINK4res opreadlink;    case OP_REMOVE:        REMOVE4res opremove;    case OP_RENAME:        RENAME4res oprename;    case OP_RENEW:         RENEW4res oprenew;    case OP_RESTOREFH:     RESTOREFH4res oprestorefh;    case OP_SAVEFH:        SAVEFH4res opsavefh;    case OP_SECINFO:       SECINFO4res opsecinfo;    case OP_SETATTR:       SETATTR4res opsetattr;    case OP_SETCLIENTID:   SETCLIENTID4res opsetclientid;    case OP_SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM:   SETCLIENTID_CONFIRM4res                                           opsetclientid_confirm;    case OP_VERIFY:        VERIFY4res opverify;    case OP_WRITE:         WRITE4res opwrite;    case OP_RELEASE_LOCKOWNER:     RELEASE_LOCKOWNER4res                                       oprelease_lockowner;    case OP_ILLEGAL:       ILLEGAL4res opillegal;   };   struct COMPOUND4args {           utf8str_cs      tag;           uint32_t        minorversion;           nfs_argop4      argarray<>;   };   struct COMPOUND4res {Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 265]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003           nfsstat4 status;           utf8str_cs      tag;           nfs_resop4      resarray<>;   };   /*    * Remote file service routines    */   program NFS4_PROGRAM {           version NFS_V4 {                   void                           NFSPROC4_NULL(void) = 0;                   COMPOUND4res                           NFSPROC4_COMPOUND(COMPOUND4args) = 1;           } = 4;   } = 100003;   /*    * NFS4 Callback Procedure Definitions and Program    */   /*    * CB_GETATTR: Get Current Attributes    */   struct CB_GETATTR4args {           nfs_fh4 fh;           bitmap4 attr_request;   };   struct CB_GETATTR4resok {           fattr4  obj_attributes;   };   union CB_GETATTR4res switch (nfsstat4 status) {    case NFS4_OK:            CB_GETATTR4resok       resok4;    default:            void;   };   /*    * CB_RECALL: Recall an Open Delegation    */   struct CB_RECALL4args {Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 266]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003           stateid4        stateid;           bool            truncate;           nfs_fh4         fh;   };   struct CB_RECALL4res {           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * CB_ILLEGAL: Response for illegal operation numbers    */   struct CB_ILLEGAL4res {           nfsstat4        status;   };   /*    * Various definitions for CB_COMPOUND    */   enum nfs_cb_opnum4 {           OP_CB_GETATTR           = 3,           OP_CB_RECALL            = 4,           OP_CB_ILLEGAL           = 10044   };   union nfs_cb_argop4 switch (unsigned argop) {    case OP_CB_GETATTR:    CB_GETATTR4args opcbgetattr;    case OP_CB_RECALL:     CB_RECALL4args  opcbrecall;    case OP_CB_ILLEGAL:    void;   };   union nfs_cb_resop4 switch (unsigned resop){    case OP_CB_GETATTR:    CB_GETATTR4res  opcbgetattr;    case OP_CB_RECALL:     CB_RECALL4res   opcbrecall;    case OP_CB_ILLEGAL:    CB_ILLEGAL4res  opcbillegal;   };   struct CB_COMPOUND4args {           utf8str_cs      tag;           uint32_t        minorversion;           uint32_t        callback_ident;           nfs_cb_argop4   argarray<>;   };   struct CB_COMPOUND4res {           nfsstat4 status;           utf8str_cs      tag;           nfs_cb_resop4   resarray<>;Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 267]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   };   /*    * Program number is in the transient range since the client    * will assign the exact transient program number and provide    * that to the server via the SETCLIENTID operation.    */   program NFS4_CALLBACK {           version NFS_CB {                   void                           CB_NULL(void) = 0;                   CB_COMPOUND4res                           CB_COMPOUND(CB_COMPOUND4args) = 1;           } = 1;   } = 0x40000000;19.  Acknowledgements   The authors thank and acknowledge:   Neil Brown for his extensive review and comments of various   documents. Rick Macklem at the University of Guelph, Mike Frisch,   Sergey Klyushin, and Dan Trufasiu of Hummingbird Ltd., and Andy   Adamson, Bruce Fields, Jim Rees, and Kendrick Smith from the CITI   organization at the University of Michigan, for their implementation   efforts and feedback on the protocol specification. Mike Kupfer for   his review of the file locking and ACL mechanisms.  Alan Yoder for   his input to ACL mechanisms. Peter Astrand for his close review of   the protocol specification. Ran Atkinson for his constant reminder   that users do matter.20.  Normative References   [ISO10646]                "ISO/IEC 10646-1:1993. International                             Standard -- Information technology --                             Universal Multiple-Octet Coded Character                             Set (UCS) -- Part 1: Architecture and Basic                             Multilingual Plane."   [RFC793]                  Postel, J., "Transmission Control                             Protocol", STD 7,RFC 793, September 1981.   [RFC1831]                 Srinivasan, R., "RPC: Remote Procedure Call                             Protocol Specification Version 2",RFC1831, August 1995.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 268]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   [RFC1832]                 Srinivasan, R., "XDR: External Data                             Representation Standard",RFC 1832, August                             1995.   [RFC2373]                 Hinden, R. and S. Deering, "IP Version 6                             Addressing Architecture",RFC 2373, July                             1998.   [RFC1964]                 Linn, J., "The Kerberos Version 5 GSS-API                             Mechanism",RFC 1964, June 1996.   [RFC2025]                 Adams, C., "The Simple Public-Key GSS-API                             Mechanism (SPKM)",RFC 2025, October 1996.   [RFC2119]                 Bradner, S., "Key words for use in RFCs to                             Indicate Requirement Levels",BCP 14,RFC2119, March 1997.   [RFC2203]                 Eisler, M., Chiu, A. and L. Ling,                             "RPCSEC_GSS Protocol Specification",RFC2203, September 1997.   [RFC2277]                 Alvestrand, H., "IETF Policy on Character                             Sets and Languages",BCP 19,RFC 2277,                             January 1998.   [RFC2279]                 Yergeau, F., "UTF-8, a transformation                             format of ISO 10646",RFC 2279, January                             1998.   [RFC2623]                 Eisler, M., "NFS Version 2 and Version 3                             Security Issues and the NFS Protocol's Use                             of RPCSEC_GSS and Kerberos V5",RFC 2623,                             June 1999.   [RFC2743]                 Linn, J., "Generic Security Service                             Application Program Interface, Version 2,                             Update 1",RFC 2743, January 2000.   [RFC2847]                 Eisler, M., "LIPKEY - A Low Infrastructure                             Public Key Mechanism Using SPKM",RFC 2847,                             June 2000.   [RFC3010]                 Shepler, S., Callaghan, B., Robinson, D.,                             Thurlow, R., Beame, C., Eisler, M. and D.                             Noveck, "NFS version 4 Protocol",RFC 3010,                             December 2000.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 269]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   [RFC3454]                 Hoffman, P. and P. Blanchet, "Preparation                             of Internationalized Strings                             ("stringprep")",RFC 3454, December 2002.   [Unicode1]                The Unicode Consortium, "The Unicode                             Standard, Version 3.0", Addison-Wesley                             Developers Press, Reading, MA, 2000. ISBN                             0-201-61633-5.                             More information available at:http://www.unicode.org/   [Unicode2]                "Unsupported Scripts" Unicode, Inc., The                             Unicode Consortium, P.O. Box 700519, San                             Jose, CA 95710-0519 USA, September 1999.http://www.unicode.org/unicode/standard/unsupported.html21.  Informative References   [Floyd]                   S. Floyd, V. Jacobson, "The Synchronization                             of Periodic Routing Messages," IEEE/ACM                             Transactions on Networking, 2(2), pp. 122-                             136, April 1994.   [Gray]                    C. Gray, D. Cheriton, "Leases: An Efficient                             Fault-Tolerant Mechanism for Distributed                             File Cache Consistency," Proceedings of the                             Twelfth Symposium on Operating Systems                             Principles, p. 202-210, December 1989.   [Juszczak]                Juszczak, Chet, "Improving the Performance                             and Correctness of an NFS Server," USENIX                             Conference Proceedings, USENIX Association,                             Berkeley, CA, June 1990, pages 53-63.                             Describes reply cache implementation that                             avoids work in the server by handling                             duplicate requests. More important, though                             listed as a side-effect, the reply cache                             aids in the avoidance of destructive non-                             idempotent operation re-application --                             improving correctness.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 270]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   [Kazar]                   Kazar, Michael Leon, "Synchronization and                             Caching Issues in the Andrew File System,"                             USENIX Conference Proceedings, USENIX                             Association, Berkeley, CA, Dallas Winter                             1988, pages 27-36.  A description of the                             cache consistency scheme in AFS.                             Contrasted with other distributed file                             systems.   [Macklem]                 Macklem, Rick, "Lessons Learned Tuning the                             4.3BSD Reno Implementation of the NFS                             Protocol," Winter USENIX Conference                             Proceedings, USENIX Association, Berkeley,                             CA, January 1991.  Describes performance                             work in tuning the 4.3BSD Reno NFS                             implementation. Describes performance                             improvement (reduced CPU loading) through                             elimination of data copies.   [Mogul]                   Mogul, Jeffrey C., "A Recovery Protocol for                             Spritely NFS," USENIX File System Workshop                             Proceedings, Ann Arbor, MI, USENIX                             Association, Berkeley, CA, May 1992.                             Second paper on Spritely NFS proposes a                             lease-based scheme for recovering state of                             consistency protocol.   [Nowicki]                 Nowicki, Bill, "Transport Issues in the                             Network File System," ACM SIGCOMM                             newsletter Computer Communication Review,                             April 1989.  A brief description of the                             basis for the dynamic retransmission work.   [Pawlowski]               Pawlowski, Brian, Ron Hixon, Mark Stein,                             Joseph Tumminaro, "Network Computing in the                             UNIX and IBM Mainframe Environment,"                             Uniforum `89 Conf.  Proc., (1989)                             Description of an NFS server implementation                             for IBM's MVS operating system.   [RFC1094]                 Sun Microsystems, Inc., "NFS: Network File                             System Protocol Specification",RFC 1094,                             March 1989.   [RFC1345]                 Simonsen, K., "Character Mnemonics &                             Character Sets",RFC 1345, June 1992.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 271]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   [RFC1813]                 Callaghan, B., Pawlowski, B. and P.                             Staubach, "NFS Version 3 Protocol                             Specification",RFC 1813, June 1995.   [RFC3232]                 Reynolds, J., Editor, "Assigned Numbers:RFC 1700 is Replaced by an On-line                             Database",RFC 3232, January 2002.   [RFC1833]                 Srinivasan, R., "Binding Protocols for ONC                             RPC Version 2",RFC 1833, August 1995.   [RFC2054]                 Callaghan, B., "WebNFS Client                             Specification",RFC 2054, October 1996.   [RFC2055]                 Callaghan, B., "WebNFS Server                             Specification",RFC 2055,  October 1996.   [RFC2152]                 Goldsmith, D. and M. Davis, "UTF-7 A Mail-                             Safe Transformation Format of Unicode",RFC2152, May 1997.   [RFC2224]                 Callaghan, B., "NFS URL Scheme",RFC 2224,                             October 1997.   [RFC2624]                 Shepler, S., "NFS Version 4 Design                             Considerations",RFC 2624, June 1999.   [RFC2755]                 Chiu, A., Eisler, M. and B. Callaghan,                             "Security Negotiation for WebNFS" ,RFC2755, June 2000.   [Sandberg]                Sandberg, R., D. Goldberg, S. Kleiman, D.                             Walsh, B.  Lyon, "Design and Implementation                             of the Sun Network Filesystem," USENIX                             Conference Proceedings, USENIX Association,                             Berkeley, CA, Summer 1985.  The basic paper                             describing the SunOS implementation of the                             NFS version 2 protocol, and discusses the                             goals, protocol specification and trade-                             offs.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 272]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 2003   [Srinivasan]              Srinivasan, V., Jeffrey C. Mogul, "Spritely                             NFS: Implementation and Performance of                             Cache Consistency Protocols", WRL Research                             Report 89/5, Digital Equipment Corporation                             Western Research Laboratory, 100 Hamilton                             Ave., Palo Alto, CA, 94301, May 1989.  This                             paper analyzes the effect of applying a                             Sprite-like consistency protocol applied to                             standard NFS. The issues of recovery in a                             stateful environment are covered in                             [Mogul].   [XNFS]                    The Open Group, Protocols for Interworking:                             XNFS, Version 3W, The Open Group, 1010 El                             Camino Real Suite 380, Menlo Park, CA                             94025, ISBN 1-85912-184-5, February 1998.                             HTML version available:http://www.opengroup.org22.  Authors' Information22.1.  Editor's Address   Spencer Shepler   Sun Microsystems, Inc.   7808 Moonflower Drive   Austin, Texas  78750   Phone: +1 512-349-9376   EMail: spencer.shepler@sun.comShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 273]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 200322.2.  Authors' Addresses   Carl Beame   Hummingbird Ltd.   EMail: beame@bws.com   Brent Callaghan   Sun Microsystems, Inc.   17 Network Circle   Menlo Park, CA  94025   Phone: +1 650-786-5067   EMail: brent.callaghan@sun.com   Mike Eisler   5765 Chase Point Circle   Colorado Springs, CO  80919   Phone: +1 719-599-9026   EMail: mike@eisler.com   David Noveck   Network Appliance   375 Totten Pond Road   Waltham, MA  02451   Phone: +1 781-768-5347   EMail: dnoveck@netapp.com   David Robinson   Sun Microsystems, Inc.   5300 Riata Park Court   Austin, TX  78727   Phone: +1 650-786-5088   EMail: david.robinson@sun.com   Robert Thurlow   Sun Microsystems, Inc.   500 Eldorado Blvd.   Broomfield, CO  80021   Phone: +1 650-786-5096   EMail: robert.thurlow@sun.comShepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 274]

RFC 3530                 NFS version 4 Protocol               April 200323.  Full Copyright Statement   Copyright (C) The Internet Society (2003).  All Rights Reserved.   This document and translations of it may be copied and furnished to   others, and derivative works that comment on or otherwise explain it   or assist in its implementation may be prepared, copied, published   and distributed, in whole or in part, without restriction of any   kind, provided that the above copyright notice and this paragraph are   included on all such copies and derivative works.  However, this   document itself may not be modified in any way, such as by removing   the copyright notice or references to the Internet Society or other   Internet organizations, except as needed for the purpose of   developing Internet standards in which case the procedures for   copyrights defined in the Internet Standards process must be   followed, or as required to translate it into languages other than   English.   The limited permissions granted above are perpetual and will not be   revoked by the Internet Society or its successors or assigns.   This document and the information contained herein is provided on an   "AS IS" basis and THE INTERNET SOCIETY AND THE INTERNET ENGINEERING   TASK FORCE DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING   BUT NOT LIMITED TO ANY WARRANTY THAT THE USE OF THE INFORMATION   HEREIN WILL NOT INFRINGE ANY RIGHTS OR ANY IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF   MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.Acknowledgement   Funding for the RFC Editor function is currently provided by the   Internet Society.Shepler, et al.             Standards Track                   [Page 275]

[8]ページ先頭

©2009-2025 Movatter.jp